Contents

Apple Mac OS X Server v30 User's Guide PDF

1 of 275
1 of 275

Summary of Content for Apple Mac OS X Server v30 User's Guide PDF

Mac OS X Server User Management For Version 10.5 Leopard

K

Apple Inc. 2007 Apple Inc. All rights reserved.

The owner or authorized user of a valid copy of Mac OS X Server software may reproduce this publication for the purpose of learning to use such software. No part of this publication may be reproduced or transmitted for commercial purposes, such as selling copies of this publication or for providing paid-for support services.

Every effort has been made to ensure that the information in this manual is accurate. Apple Inc. is not responsible for printing or clerical errors.

Apple 1 Infinite Loop Cupertino, CA 95014-2084 408-996-1010 www.apple.com

Use of the keyboard Apple logo (Option-Shift-K) for commercial purposes without the prior written consent of Apple may constitute trademark infringement and unfair competition in violation of federal and state laws.

Apple, the Apple logo, AirPort, AppleShare, Bonjour, FireWire, iCal, iTunes, Mac, Mac OS, MacBook, Macintosh, QuickTime, SuperDrive, Xgrid, Xsan, and Xserve are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. Apple Remote Desktop, Extensions Manager, Finder, iWork, and Safari are trademarks of Apple Inc. Mac is a service mark of Apple Inc.

Adobe and PostScript are trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated.

The Bluetooth

word mark and logos are registered trademarks owned by the Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and any use of such marks by Apple is under license.

Java and all Java-based trademarks and logos are trademarks or registered trademarks of Sun Microsystems, Inc. in the U.S. and other countries.

UNIX is a registered trademark of The Open Group.

Other company and product names mentioned herein are trademarks of their respective companies. Mention of third-party products is for informational purposes only and constitutes neither an endorsement nor a recommendation. Apple assumes no responsibility with regard to the performance of these products.

019-0938/2007-09-01

3

1 Contents

Preface 13 About This Guide 13

Whats New in Workgroup Manager

14

Whats in This Guide

15

Using Onscreen Help

16

Mac OS X Server Administration Guides

17

Viewing PDF Guides Onscreen

17

Printing PDF Guides

18

Getting Documentation Updates

18

Getting Additional Information

Chapter 1 19 User Management Overview 19

Tools for User Management

19

Workgroup Manager

20

Server Admin

21

Server Preferences

21

NetBoot

21

NetInstall

22

Command-Line Tools

22

Accounts

23

Administrator Accounts

24

User Accounts

25

Group Accounts

25

Computer Accounts

26

Computer Groups

26

The User Experience

26

Authentication and Identity Validation

27

Information Access Control

Chapter 2 31 Getting Started with User Management 31

Setup Overview

34

Planning Strategies for User Management

34

Analyzing Your Environment

4

Contents

35

Identifying Directory Services Requirements

35

Determining Server and Storage Requirements

36

Choosing a Home Folder Structure

37

Devising a Home Folder Distribution Strategy

38

Identifying Groups

38

Determining Administrator Requirements

Chapter 3 41 Getting Started with Workgroup Manager 41

Configuring the Administrators Computer and Account

41

Setting Up an Administrator Computer

42

Creating a Domain Administrator Account

42

Using Workgroup Manager

42

Using Mac OS X Server v10.5 to Administer Earlier Versions of Mac OS X

43

Connecting and Authenticating to Directory Domains in Workgroup Manager

44

Major Workgroup Manager Tasks

45

Modifying Workgroup Manager Preferences

46

Finding and Listing Accounts

46

Working with Account Lists in Workgroup Manager

46

Listing Accounts in the Local Directory Domain

47

Listing Accounts in Search Policy Directory Domains

48

Listing Accounts in Available Directory Domains

48

Refreshing Account Lists

48

Finding Specific Accounts in a List

49

Using Advanced Search

50

Sorting Users and Groups

50

Shortcuts for Working with Accounts

50

Using Presets

51

Editing Multiple Accounts Simultaneously

53

Importing and Exporting Account Information

Chapter 4 55 Setting Up User Accounts 55

About User Accounts

55

Where User Accounts Are Stored

56

Predefined User Accounts

57

Administering User Accounts

57

Creating User Accounts

58

Editing User Account Information

59

Working with Read-Only User Accounts

59

Working with Guest Users

60

Working with Windows User Accounts

60

Deleting a User Account

60

Disabling a User Account

Contents

5

61

Working with Presets

61

Creating a Preset for User Accounts

62

Using Presets to Create Accounts

62

Renaming Presets

62

Editing Presets

63

Deleting a Preset

63

Working with Basic Settings

63

Modifying User Names

64

Modifying Short Names

65

Choosing Stable Short Names

66

Avoiding Duplicate Names

67

Modifying User IDs

68

Assigning a Password to a User

68

Assigning Administrator Privileges for a Server

69

Choosing a Users Login Picture

70

Working with Privileges

70

Removing Administrative Privileges from a User

70

Giving a User Limited Administrative Capabilities

72

Giving a User Full Administrative Capabilities

72

Working with Advanced Settings

72

Enabling a Users Calendar

73

Allowing a User to Log In to More Than One Computer At a Time

73

Choosing a Default Shell

74

Choosing a Password Type and Setting Password Options

75

Creating a Master List of Keywords

75

Applying Keywords to User Accounts

76

Editing Comments

77

Working with Group Settings

77

Choosing a Users Primary Group

78

Reviewing a Users Group Memberships

78

Adding a User to a Group

79

Removing a User from a Group

79

Working with Home Settings

80

Working with Mail Settings

80

Enabling Mail Service Account Options

81

Disabling a Users Mail Service

81

Forwarding a Users Mail

81

Working with Print Quota Settings

82

Enabling a Users Access to All Available Print Queues

82

Enabling a Users Access to Specific Print Queues

83

Removing a Print Quota For a Queue

6

Contents

83

Resetting a Users Print Quota

84

Disabling a Users Access to Print Queues That Enforce Quotas

84 Working with Info Settings 85 Working with Windows Settings 85 Changing a Windows Users Profile Location 86 Changing a Windows Users Login Script Location 87 Changing a Windows Users Home Folder Drive Letter 87 Changing a Windows Users Home Folder Location 87 Working with GUIDs 87 Viewing GUIDs

Chapter 5 89 Setting Up Group Accounts 89 About Group Accounts 89 How Group Accounts Track Membership 90 Where Group Accounts Are Stored 90 Predefined Group Accounts 91 Administering Group Accounts 91 Creating Group Accounts 92 Creating a Preset for Group Accounts 92 Editing Group Account Information 93 Creating Hierarchical Groups 94 Upgrading Legacy Groups 94 Working with Read-Only Groups 95 Deleting a Group 95 Working with Basic Settings for Groups 95 Naming a Group 96 Defining a Group ID 97 Choosing a Groups Login Picture 98 Enabling a Groups Web Services 99 Working with Member Settings for Groups 99 Adding Users or Groups to a Group

100 Removing Group Members 100 Working with Group Folder Settings 101 Specifying No Group Folder 101 Creating a Group Folder 103 Designating a Group Folder for Use by Multiple Groups

Chapter 6 105 Setting Up Computers and Computer Groups 105 About Computer Accounts 106 Creating Computer Accounts 107 Working with Guest Computers 107 Working with Windows Computers

Contents 7

108 About Computer Groups 108 Differences Between Computer Groups and Computer Lists 108 Administering Computer Groups 108 Creating a Computer Group 109 Creating a Preset for Computer Groups 110 Using a Computer Group Preset 111 Adding Computers or Computer Groups to a Computer Group 111 Removing Computers and Computer Groups from a Computer Group 112 Deleting a Computer Group 112 Upgrading Computer Lists to Computer Groups

Chapter 7 113 Setting Up Home Folders 113 About Home Folders 114 Hosting Home Folders for Mac OS X Clients 114 Hosting Home Folders for Other Clients 115 Distributing Home Folders Across Multiple Servers 116 Administering Share Points 116 Setting Up a Share Point 117 Setting Up an Automountable AFP Share Point for Home Folders 118 Setting Up an Automountable NFS Share Point for Home Folders 119 Setting Up an SMB Share Point 121 Administering Home Folders 121 Specifying No Home Folder 122 Creating a Home Folder for a Local User 123 Creating a Network Home Folder 124 Creating a Custom Location for Home Folders 127 Setting Up a Home Folder for a Windows User 129 Setting Disk Quotas 130 Setting Disk Quotas for Windows Users to Avoid Data Loss 130 Using Presets to Choose Default Home Folders 130 Moving Home Folders 130 Deleting Home Folders

Chapter 8 131 Managing Portable Computers 131 About Mobile Accounts 132 About Portable Home Directories 133 Logging In to Mobile Accounts 134 Resolving Sync Conflicts 134 About External Accounts 135 Logging In to External Accounts 136 Considerations and Strategies for Deploying Mobile Accounts 136 Advantages of Using Mobile Accounts

8 Contents

137 Considerations for Using Mobile Accounts 139 Strategies for Syncing Content 140 Setting Up Mobile Accounts for Use on Portable Computers 140 Configuring Portable Computers 141 Managing Mobile Clients Without Using Mobile Accounts 141 Unknown Mac OS X Portable Computers 142 Using Mac OS X Portable Computers with One Primary Local User 142 Using Mac OS X Portable Computers with Multiple Users 144 Securing Mobile Clients 144 Optimizing the File Server for Mobile Accounts

Chapter 9 147 Client Management Overview 148 Using Network-Visible Resources 149 Customizing the User Experience 149 The Power of Preferences 150 Designing the Login Experience 151 Choosing a Workgroup 152 Working with Synced Homes 152 Improving Workflow

Chapter 10 155 Managing Preferences 155 Using Workgroup Manager to Manage Preferences 156 Understanding Managed Preference Interactions 159 Understanding Hierarchical Preference Management 159 Setting the Permanence of Management 160 Caching Preferences 160 Preference Management Basics 161 Managing User Preferences 162 Managing Group Preferences 162 Managing Computer Preferences 163 Managing Computer Group Preferences 163 Disabling Management for Specific Preferences 164 Managing Access to Applications 165 Controlling User Access to Specific Applications and Folders 167 Allowing Specific Dashboard Widgets 168 Disabling Front Row 168 Allowing Legacy Users to Open Specific Applications and Folders 169 Managing Classic Preferences 170 Selecting Classic Startup Options 171 Choosing a Classic System Folder 171 Allowing Special Actions During Restart 172 Controlling Access to Classic Apple Menu Items

Contents 9

173 Adjusting Classic Sleep Settings 174 Maintaining Consistent User Preferences for Classic 174 Managing Dock Preferences 174 Controlling the Users Dock 175 Providing Easy Access to Group Folders 176 Adding Items to a Users Dock 177 Preventing Users from Adding or Deleting Dock Items 177 Managing Energy Saver Preferences 178 Using Sleep and Wake Settings for Desktop Computers 179 Setting Energy Saver Settings for Portable Computers 180 Displaying Battery Status to Users 181 Scheduling Automatic Startup, Shutdown, or Sleep 182 Managing Finder Preferences 182 Setting Up Simple Finder 183 Keeping Disks and Servers from Appearing on the Users Desktop 183 Controlling the Behavior of Finder Windows 184 Hiding the Alert Message When a User Empties the Trash 184 Making Filename Extensions Visible 185 Controlling User Access to Remote Servers 185 Controlling User Access to an iDisk 185 Preventing Users from Ejecting Discs 186 Hiding the Burn Disc Command in the Finder 186 Controlling User Access to Folders 187 Removing Restart and Shut Down from the Apple Menu 187 Adjusting the Appearance and Arrangement of Desktop Items 188 Adjusting the Appearance of Finder Window Contents 189 Managing Login Preferences 189 Changing the Appearance of the Login Window 191 Configuring Miscellaneous Login Options 192 Choosing Who Can Log In 193 Customizing the Workgroups Displayed at Login 194 Enabling the Use of Login and Logout Scripts 196 Choosing a Login or Logout Script 197 Automatically Opening Items After a User Logs In 198 Providing Access to a Users Network Home Folder 199 Providing Easy Access to the Group Share Point 200 Managing Media Access Preferences 200 Controlling Access to CDs, DVDs, and Recordable Discs 201 Controlling Access to Hard Drives, Disks, and Disk Images 201 Ejecting Removable Media Automatically When a User Logs Out 202 Managing Mobility Preferences

10 Contents

202 Creating a Mobile Account 203 Preventing the Creation of a Mobile Account 204 Manually Removing Mobile Accounts from Computers 205 Enabling FileVault for Mobile Accounts 207 Selecting the Location of a Mobile Account 208 Creating External Accounts 209 Setting Expiration Periods for Mobile Accounts 210 Choosing Folders to Sync at Login and Logout, or in the Background 211 Stopping Files from Syncing for a Mobile Account 212 Setting the Background Sync Frequency 212 Showing Mobile Account Status in the Users Menu Bar 213 Managing Network Preferences 213 Configuring Proxy Servers by Port 214 Allowing Users to Bypass Proxy Servers for Specific Domains 215 Enabling Passive FTP Mode 215 Disabling Internet Sharing 216 Disabling AirPort 216 Disabling Bluetooth 217 Managing Parental Controls Preferences 217 Hiding Profanity in Dictionary 217 Preventing Access to Adult Websites 218 Allowing Access Only to Specific Websites 219 Setting Time Limits and Curfews on Computer Usage 220 Managing Printing Preferences 221 Making Printers Available to Users 221 Preventing Users from Modifying the Printer List 222 Restricting Access to Printers Connected to a Computer 222 Setting a Default Printer 223 Restricting Access to Printers 223 Adding a Page Footer to All Printouts 224 Managing Software Update Preferences 224 Managing Access to System Preferences 225 Managing Time Machine Preferences 227 Managing Universal Access Preferences 227 Adjusting the Users Display Settings 228 Setting a Visual Alert 228 Adjusting Keyboard Accessibility Options 230 Adjusting Mouse and Pointer Responsiveness 230 Enabling Universal Access Shortcuts 231 Allowing Devices for Users with Special Needs 231 Using the Preference Editor with Preference Manifests

Contents 11

232 Adding to the Preference Editors List 234 Editing Application Preferences with the Preference Editor 235 Removing an Applications Managed Preferences in the Preference Editor 236 Using the Preference Editor to Manage Core Services 237 Using the Preference Editor to Manage Safari

Chapter 11 239 Solving Problems 239 Diagnosing Common Network Issues 239 Testing Your Networks Time and Time Zones 240 Testing Your DNS Service 241 Testing Your DHCP Service 242 Solving Account Problems 242 If You Want to Use Earlier Versions of Workgroup Manager 242 If You Cant Edit an Account Using Workgroup Manager 242 If Users Cant See Their Names in the Login Window 242 If You Cant Unlock an LDAP Directory 243 If You Cant Modify a Users Open Directory Password 243 If You Cant Change a Users Password Type to Open Directory 243 If You Cant Assign Server Administrator Privileges 243 If Users Cant Log In or Authenticate 244 If Users Relying on a Password Server Cant Log In 245 If Users Cant Log In with Accounts in a Shared Directory Domain 245 If Users Cant Access Their Home Folders 245 If Users Cant Change Their Passwords 245 If Users Cant Authenticate Using Single Sign-On or Kerberos 245 Problems with a Primary or Backup Domain Controller 245 If a Windows User Cant Log in to the Windows Domain 246 If a Windows User Has No Home Folder 246 If a Windows Users Profile Settings Revert to Defaults 246 If a Windows User Loses the Contents of the My Documents Folder 247 Solving Preference Management Problems 247 Testing Your Managed Client Settings 247 If Users Dont See a List of Workgroups at Login 247 If Users Cant Open Files 248 If Users Cant Add Printers to a Printer List 248 If Login Items Added by a User Dont Open 249 If Items Placed in the Dock by a User Are Missing 249 If a Users Dock Has Duplicate Items 249 If Users See a Question Mark in the Dock 250 If Users See a Message About an Unexpected Error 250 If You Cant Manage Network Views

12 Contents

Appendix 251 Importing and Exporting Account Information 251 Understanding What You Can Import and Export 252 Limitations for Importing and Exporting Passwords 252 Maintaining GUIDs When Importing from Earlier Versions of Mac OS X Server 253 Archiving the Open Directory Master 253 Using Workgroup Manager to Import Accounts 254 Using Workgroup Manager to Export Accounts 255 Using XML Files Created with Mac OS X Server v10.1 or Earlier 256 Using XML Files Created with AppleShare IP 6.3

Glossary 257

Index 267

13

Pr ef

ac eAbout This Guide

This guide explains how to use Workgroup Manager to set up and manage accounts and preferences for clients.

Mac OS X Server includes Workgroup Manager, a user management tool you can use to create and manage accounts.

When managing accounts, you can define core account settings like name, password, home folder location, and group membership. You can also manage preferences, allowing you to customize the users experience, granting or restricting access to his or her own computers settings and to network resources.

Workgroup Manager works closely with a directory domain. Directory domains are like databases but are specifically designed for storing account information and handling authentication.

Whats New in Workgroup Manager Computer accounts and computer groups. You can create computer accounts for

individual computers. By managing computer accounts individually, you can fully customize preference management settings for those computers. You can create computer groups composed of these individual computer accounts, or of hierarchical groups. Managed preferences for a parent computer group in a hierarchical group also apply to child computer groups.

The addition of computer accounts and computer groups eases administration and increases flexibility. For more information, see Chapter 6, Setting Up Computers and Computer Groups.

Improved mobile accounts. Mobile accounts are now more secure, efficient, and portable. You can protect mobile accounts with FileVault. You can set account expiry options so that local home folders are deleted after a period of inactivity. You can also create mobile accounts on an external drive, so users can still access a synced home folder with cached managed preferences even when they dont have their computers.

14 Preface About This Guide

You can enable these features by managing Mobility preferences. For more information, see Chapter 8, Managing Portable Computers.

New managed preferences. Preferences now let you manage Parental Controls, Dashboard, Front Row, and Time Machine. Existing preferences have been enhanced, using embedded and detached signatures to prevent the launching of unapproved applications, giving you more control over the login window, and letting you create page footers on printed documents. For more information, see Chapter 10, Managing Preferences.

Whats in This Guide This guide includes the following chapters: Chapter 1, User Management Overview, highlights important concepts, introduces

user management tools, and tells you where to find additional information about user management and related topics.

Chapter 2, Getting Started with User Management, provides planning and setup information to create a user management environment.

Chapter 3, Getting Started with Workgroup Manager, describes how to set up Workgroup Manager and use its core features.

Chapters 4, 5, and 6 explain how to use Workgroup Manager to set up users, groups, computers, and computer groups.

Chapter 7, Setting Up Home Folders, covers creating home folders. Chapter 8, Managing Portable Computers, details considerations for managing

portable computers. Chapter 9, Client Management Overview, introduces client management tools and

concepts, such as how to customize a users work environment and provide user access to network resources.

Chapter 10, Managing Preferences, describes how to use Workgroup Manager to control preference settings for users, groups, computers, and computer groups that use Mac OS X.

Chapter 11, Solving Problems, helps you address issues involving account creation, home folder maintenance, preference management, and client setup, and also helps you solve problems encountered by managed clients.

In addition, the appendix, Importing and Exporting Account Information, provides information youll need when you want to transfer account information to or from an external file.

Finally, the glossary defines terms youll encounter as you read this guide.

Note: Because Apple periodically releases new versions and updates to its software, images shown in this book may be different from what you see on your screen.

Preface About This Guide 15

Using Onscreen Help You can get task instructions onscreen in the Help Viewer application while youre managing Leopard Server. You can view help on a server or an administrator computer. (An administrator computer is a Mac OS X computer with Leopard Server administration software installed on it.)

To get help for an advanced configuration of Leopard Server: m Open Server Admin or Workgroup Manager and then:

Use the Help menu to search for a task you want to perform. Choose Help > Server Admin Help or Help > Workgroup Manager Help to browse

and search the help topics.

The onscreen help contains instructions taken from Server Administration and other advanced administration guides described in Mac OS X Server Administration Guides, next.

To see the most recent server help topics: m Make sure the server or administrator computer is connected to the Internet while

youre getting help.

Help Viewer automatically retrieves and caches the most recent server help topics from the Internet. When not connected to the Internet, Help Viewer displays cached help topics.

16 Preface About This Guide

Mac OS X Server Administration Guides Getting Started covers installation and setup for standard and workgroup configurations of Mac OS X Server. For advanced configurations, Server Administration covers planning, installation, setup, and general server administration. A suite of additional guides, listed below, covers advanced planning, setup, and management of individual services. You can get these guides in PDF format from the Mac OS X Server documentation website:

www.apple.com/server/documentation

This guide ... tells you how to:

Getting Started and Installation & Setup Worksheet

Install Mac OS X Server and set it up for the first time.

Command-Line Administration Install, set up, and manage Mac OS X Server using UNIX command- line tools and configuration files.

File Services Administration Share selected server volumes or folders among server clients using the AFP, NFS, FTP, and SMB protocols.

iCal Service Administration Set up and manage iCal shared calendar service.

iChat Service Administration Set up and manage iChat instant messaging service.

Mac OS X Security Configuration Make Mac OS X computers (clients) more secure, as required by enterprise and government customers.

Mac OS X Server Security Configuration

Make Mac OS X Server and the computer its installed on more secure, as required by enterprise and government customers.

Mail Service Administration Set up and manage IMAP, POP, and SMTP mail services on the server.

Network Services Administration Set up, configure, and administer DHCP, DNS, VPN, NTP, IP firewall, NAT, and RADIUS services on the server.

Open Directory Administration Set up and manage directory and authentication services, and configure clients to access directory services.

Podcast Producer Administration Set up and manage Podcast Producer service to record, process, and distribute podcasts.

Print Service Administration Host shared printers and manage their associated queues and print jobs.

QuickTime Streaming and Broadcasting Administration

Capture and encode QuickTime content. Set up and manage QuickTime streaming service to deliver media streams live or on demand.

Server Administration Perform advanced installation and setup of server software, and manage options that apply to multiple services or to the server as a whole.

System Imaging and Software Update Administration

Use NetBoot, NetInstall, and Software Update to automate the management of operating system and other software used by client computers.

Upgrading and Migrating Use data and service settings from an earlier version of Mac OS X Server or Windows NT.

Preface About This Guide 17

Viewing PDF Guides Onscreen While reading the PDF version of a guide onscreen: Show bookmarks to see the guides outline, and click a bookmark to jump to the

corresponding section. Search for a word or phrase to see a list of places where it appears in the document.

Click a listed place to see the page where it occurs. Click a cross-reference to jump to the referenced section. Click a web link to visit the

website in your browser.

Printing PDF Guides If you want to print a guide, you can take these steps to save paper and ink: Save ink or toner by not printing the cover page. Save color ink on a color printer by looking in the panes of the Print dialog for an

option to print in grays or black and white. Reduce the bulk of the printed document and save paper by printing more than one

page per sheet of paper. In the Print dialog, change Scale to 115% (155% for Getting Started). Then choose Layout from the untitled pop-up menu. If your printer supports two-sided (duplex) printing, select one of the Two-Sided options. Otherwise, choose 2 from the Pages per Sheet pop-up menu, and optionally choose Single Hairline from the Border menu. (If youre using Mac OS X version 10.4 or earlier, the Scale setting is in the Page Setup dialog and the Layout settings are in the Print dialog.)

You may want to enlarge the printed pages even if you dont print double sided, because the PDF page size is smaller than standard printer paper. In the Print dialog or Page Setup dialog, try changing Scale to 115% (155% for Getting Started, which has CD- size pages).

User Management Create and manage user accounts, groups, and computers. Set up managed preferences for Mac OS X clients.

Web Technologies Administration Set up and manage web technologies, including web, blog, webmail, wiki, MySQL, PHP, Ruby on Rails, and WebDAV.

Xgrid Administration and High Performance Computing

Set up and manage computational clusters of Xserve systems and Mac computers.

Mac OS X Server Glossary Learn about terms used for server and storage products.

This guide ... tells you how to:

18 Preface About This Guide

Getting Documentation Updates Periodically, Apple posts revised help pages and new editions of guides. Some revised help pages update the latest editions of the guides. To view new onscreen help topics for a server application, make sure your server or

administrator computer is connected to the Internet and click Latest help topics or Staying current in the main help page for the application.

To download the latest guides in PDF format, go to the Mac OS X Server documentation website: www.apple.com/server/documentation

Getting Additional Information For more information, consult these resources: Read Me documentsimportant updates and special information. Look for them on

the server discs. Mac OS X Server website (www.apple.com/server/macosx)gateway to extensive

product and technology information. Mac OS X Server Support website (www.apple.com/support/macosxserver)access to

hundreds of articles from Apples support organization. Apple Discussions website (discussions.apple.com)a way to share questions,

knowledge, and advice with other administrators. Apple Mailing Lists website (www.lists.apple.com)subscribe to mailing lists so you

can communicate with other administrators using email.

1

19

1 User Management Overview

This chapter introduces user management concepts and describes the applications used to manage accounts and privileges.

User management encompasses everything from setting up accounts for network access and creating home folders, to fine-tuning the user experience by managing preferences and settings for users, groups, computers and computer groups. Mac OS X Server provides tools for accomplishing these tasks and more.

Tools for User Management User management tools and technologies in Mac OS X Server include Workgroup Manager, Server Admin, NetBoot, and NetInstall.

Workgroup Manager Workgroup Manager is a powerful tool that delivers features for comprehensive management of Macintosh clients.

You can use Workgroup Manager on a computer with Mac OS X or Mac OS X Server installed.

Workgroup Manager provides a centralized method of managing Mac OS X computers, controlling access to software and removable media, and providing a consistent, personalized experience for users at different levels, whether theyre beginners in a classroom or advanced users in an office.

You use Workgroup Manager to create user accounts and set up groups to provide convenient access to resources. You can: Use account settings and managed preferences to achieve the level of administrative

control you need, while making the user experience more efficient Manage Finder, login, media access, and print settings Control access to computers and restrict the applications allowed to run on them

20 Chapter 1 User Management Overview

Using Workgroup Manager with Mac OS X Server services, you can: Customize the work environments of network users by organizing their desktop

resources and personal files Enable services that require user accounts, such as mail, file sharing, iChat service,

and web service Share system resources, such as printers and computers, maximizing their availability

and ensuring that disk space and printer usage remains equitably shared

To get started with Workgroup Manager, see Chapter 3, Getting Started with Workgroup Manager.

Server Admin The Server Admin application provides access to various tools and services that play a role in server management.

After installing the Mac OS X Server software, use Server Admin to set up directory services and establish your network. Then use Workgroup Manager to create and manage accounts. After that, use Server Admin to set up additional services to provide mail service, host websites, share printers, and create share points (which allow users to share folders and files).

For information about how to use the many services managed through Server Admin, see the service administration guides. The following table lists common server administration tasks and includes the location of related documentation.

For a complete list of Mac OS X Server documentation, see Mac OS X Server Administration Guides on page 16.

To See this document

Assign permissions to folders and files in a share point

File Services Administration

Share printers among users Print Service Administration

Set up websites or WebDAV support on the server

Web Technologies Administration

Provide email service for users Mail Service Administration

Broadcast multimedia from the server in real time

QuickTime Streaming Server Administration

Provide identical operating system and applications folders for client computers

System Imaging and Software Update Administration

Install applications across a network System Imaging and Software Update Administration

Share information among multiple Mac OS X Server systems or Mac OS X computers

Open Directory Administration

Chapter 1 User Management Overview 21

Server Preferences If you use the standard or workgroup configuration of Mac OS X Server, you can use Server Preferences to configure key features of collaboration and file services. Its streamlined approach allows novice system administrators to quickly configure a server without requiring much technical knowledge.

You can also use Server Preferences to configure user and group accounts (such as setting passwords, enabling services, and assigning group membership). However, you cant use Server Preferences to manage preferences.

For more information, see Getting Started and Server Preferences Help.

NetBoot Mac OS X computers can start up from a network-based NetBoot image, providing quick and easy configuration of department, classroom, and individual systems, as well as web and application servers, throughout a network.

When you update a NetBoot image, all computers using NetBoot have instant access to the new configuration. To customize the computer setup for different groups of clients, you can set up multiple NetBoot images. These features provide quick setup and a customized user experience.

NetBoot simplifies administration and reduces the support normally associated with large-scale deployments of network-based Macintosh computers. Its ideal for an organization with client computers that are identically configured. For example, NetBoot can be a powerful solution for a data center that needs multiple, identically configured web and application servers.

With NetBoot, you can quickly configure and update client computers by updating a NetBoot image stored on the server. NetBoot images contain the operating system and application folders for all clients on the server, so that changes made on the server are reflected on the clients when they restart. Systems that are compromised or otherwise altered can be instantly restored by restarting them.

You use System Image Utility to create and modify NetBoot images, and then use NetBoot to deploy NetBoot images.

For more information about these tools, or about installing an operating system over a network, see System Imaging and Software Update Administration.

NetInstall NetInstall is a centralized software installation service that lets you use installation images to selectively and automatically install, restore, or upgrade network-based Macintosh systems. Those images can contain the latest version of Mac OS X, a software update, site-licensed or custom applications, or configuration scripts.

22 Chapter 1 User Management Overview

You can use NetInstall to upgrade operating systems, install software updates and custom software packages, or re-image desktop and portable computers. You can create custom installation packages for various departments in an organization, such as marketing, engineering, and sales.

Using NetInstall, its not necessary to use CDs or DVDs to configure a computer. All installation files and packages reside on the server.

Use NetInstall to run pre- and post-installation scripts to perform system commands before or after the installation of a software package or system image.

To create NetInstall packages, use System Image Utility or PackageMaker. Then use NetBoot to deploy NetInstall packages. For more information about using these tools with NetInstall, see System Imaging and Software Update Administration.

Command-Line Tools Mac OS X Server v10.5 includes several client-management command-line tools. For example, the dscl tool allows you to view and edit account settings and manage preferences, while the mcxquery tool reports the managed preferences that are effective for a particular user.

Use the mcxquery tool to review how combined and overridden managed preferences interact at the user, group, computer, or computer group level. The tool also determines which directory domain stores those managed preference settings.

For more information about client-management command-line tools, see Command- Line Administration.

Accounts To manage accounts, you use an administrator account. With an administrator account, you can set up and manage the following account types: User accounts Group accounts Computer accounts Computer groups

When creating a user account, you must specify a user name and password, which is needed to prove the users identity. You can also specify a user identification number (user ID), which is useful for folder and file permissions. Other user account information is used by various services to determine what the user is authorized to do and to personalize the users environment.

In addition to the accounts you create, Mac OS X Server also has predefined user and group accounts, some of which are reserved for use by Mac OS X.

Chapter 1 User Management Overview 23

Administrator Accounts Users with server administration or directory domain administration privileges are known as administrators. An administrator can be a server administrator, domain administrator, or both.

Server administrator privileges determine whether a user can change the settings of a particular server.

Domain administrator privileges determine the extent to which an administrator can change account settings for users, groups, computers, and computer groups in the directory domain.

Server Administration Server administration privileges determine the functions available to a user when logged in to a particular Mac OS X Server. For example, a server administrator can use Directory Utility to make changes to a servers search policy.

When you assign server administration privileges to a user, the user is added to the admin group in the servers local directory domain. Many Mac OS X applications such as Server Admin, Directory Utility, and System Preferencesuse the admin group to determine whether a particular user can perform certain administrative activities with the application.

Local Mac OS X Computer Administration Any user who belongs to the admin group in the local directory domain of any Mac OS X computer has administrator privileges on that computer.

Limited Administration You can control the extent to which a limited administrator can use Workgroup Manager to change account data stored in a domain. For example, you can set up directory domain privileges so your network administrator can add and remove user accounts, but allow limited administrators to change the information for particular users. Or, you can designate multiple limited administrators to manage different groups.

For more information, see Giving a User Limited Administrative Capabilities on page 70.

Directory Domain Administration When you create a directory domain in Mac OS X Server, a domain administrator account is created and added to the admin group in the domain. If you plan to connect your directory domain to other directory domains, make sure you choose a unique name and user ID for each domain.

24 Chapter 1 User Management Overview

When you assign full directory domain administration privileges to a user, the user is added to the admin group in the directory domain. This does not grant the user local admin privileges on the servers hosting this directory domain or on any other servers or clients bound to this directory domain.

Each directory domain has a domain administrator account, and a domain administrator can create additional domain administrators in the same domain. Any user with a user account in a directory domain can be made a directory domain administrator (an administrator of that domain).

For more information, see Giving a User Full Administrative Capabilities on page 72.

User Accounts Depending on how you set up server and user accounts, you can use Mac OS X Server to support users who log in using Mac OS X computers, Windows computers, or UNIX computers.

Most users have an individual account used to authenticate them and control their access to services. When you want to personalize a users environment, you define user, group, computer, or computer group preferences for that user.

The term managed client or managed user refers to a user who has administrator- controlled preferences associated with his or her account. Managed client is also used to refer to computers or computer groups that have preferences defined for them.

To learn more about how to set up user accounts, see Chapter 4, Setting Up User Accounts. To specify the preferences for user accounts, see Chapter 10, Managing Preferences.

Guest Account You can provide services for users who cant be authenticated because they dont have a valid user name or password. These users are known as guest users. If your computers run Mac OS X v10.5 or later, you can enable a guest account, which is specifically designed for guest users.

The guest account allows anonymous access to a computer. The guest account has a local home folder that has its contents erased when the user logs in or out of the guest account.

The guest account is best used for common-access computers, such as those in a library or open lab where you may not need to log user access and where the user maintains his or her files separate from the local computer.

Chapter 1 User Management Overview 25

For some services, like Apple Filing Protocol (AFP), you can let guest users access files. Instead of authenticating with a name and a password, a guest user connects as a guest, not as a registered user. Guests are restricted to files and folders with permissions set to Everyone.

Group Accounts To ease user administration, you can create group accounts. A group is a collection of users who have similar needs. For example, you can add all English teachers to one group and allow that group to access certain files or folders on a volume.

Groups simplify the administration of shared resources. Instead of granting access to various resources for each user who needs access, you can add users to a group and then grant access to everyone in the group.

Use group account settings to control user access to folders and files. For more information, see Folder and File Access by Other Users on page 28.

A group can be a member of another group. A group that contains another group is called a parent group. The group contained in the parent group is called a hierarchical group. Hierarchical groups are useful for inheriting access permissions and managed preferences.

To learn more about how to set up group accounts, see Chapter 5, Setting Up Group Accounts. To specify preferences for group accounts, see Chapter 10, Managing Preferences.

Workgroups When you define preferences for a group, it becomes a workgroup. A workgroup lets you manage the work environment of group members.

Workgroup preferences are stored in the group account. For a description of workgroup preferences, see Chapter 10, Managing Preferences.

Group Folders When you define a group, you can also specify a folder for storing files that you want group members to share. The location of the folder is stored in the group account.

You can give users permission to write to a group folder, or to change group folder attributes in the Finder.

Computer Accounts Computer accounts allow you to identify and manage individual computers.

To create a computer account, you need the computers Ethernet ID. When creating the account, you can also associate it with an IP address. After creating the account, you can manage its preferences or add it to a computer group.

26 Chapter 1 User Management Overview

For more information about setting up computer accounts, see Chapter 6, Setting Up Computers and Computer Groups. To specify preferences for Mac OS X computer accounts, see Chapter 10, Managing Preferences.

Guest Computers Most computers on your network should have a computer account. If an unknown computer (one that doesnt have a computer account) connects to your network and attempts to access services, that computer is treated as a guest. Settings chosen for the Guest Computer account apply to unknown guest computers.

Computer Groups A computer group is composed of one or more computer accounts or computer groups. By combining these into a single computer group, you can apply the same managed preferences to all its members.

To learn more about how to set up computer groups for Mac OS X client computers, see Chapter 6, Setting Up Computers and Computer Groups. To specify preferences for Mac OS X computer groups, see Chapter 10, Managing Preferences.

The User Experience After you create an account for a user, the user can access server resources according to the permissions you set.

The user experience depends on the type of user, permissions set, type of client computer in use (such as Windows or UNIX), whether the user is a member of a group, and whether preference management is implemented at the user, group, or computer level.

For more information about the Mac OS X user experience, see Chapter 9, Client Management Overview. Basic information about authentication, identity validation, and information-access control is given in the following sections.

Authentication and Identity Validation Before a user can log in or connect to a Mac OS X computer, he or she must enter a name and password associated with a user account accessible by the computer.

A Mac OS X computer can access user accounts that are stored in a directory domain of the computers search policy: A directory domain stores information about users and resources. It is like a database

that a computer accesses to retrieve configuration information. A search policy is a list of directory domains that the computer searches when it

needs configuration information, starting with the local directory domain on the users computer.

Chapter 1 User Management Overview 27

The following illustration shows a user logging in to an account in a directory domain in the computers search policy.

After login, the user can connect to a remote server to access its services (if the users account is located in the servers search policy).

If Mac OS X finds a user account containing the name entered by the user, it attempts to validate the password associated with the account. If the password is validated, the user is authenticated and the login or connection process is completed.

Mac OS X Server validates passwords using Kerberos, Open Directory Password Server, shadow passwords, and crypt passwords.

For more information about types of directory domains and instructions for configuring search policies, see Open Directory Administration. This guide also discusses authentication methods and provides instructions for setting up user authentication options.

Information Access Control To control access to information, a universal ID called a globally unique identifier (GUID) provides user and group identity for access control list (ACL) permissions.

An ACL is a list of access control entries (ACEs), each specifying the permissions to be granted or denied to a group or user, and how these permissions are propagated throughout a folder hierarchy. The GUID also associates a user with group and hierarchical group memberships.

Log in to Mac OS X

Directory domains in search policy

Connect to Mac OS X Server

Directory domains in search policy

28 Chapter 1 User Management Overview

Prior to Mac OS X v10.4, Mac OS X used user ID and POSIX permissions to track folder and file permissions. In Mac OS X, folders or files include POSIX permissions for entities such as: Owner Group Everyone else

Because GUIDs are 128-bit values, duplicate GUIDs are extremely unlikely. Unlike ACL permissions, POSIX permissions can cause file-ownership and group-membership issues when multiple users have identical short names or user IDs. When using GUIDs, users with the same short name or user ID can have different ACL permissions.

The introduction of GUIDs does not change or remove POSIX permissions, so it does not affect the interoperability of Mac OS X with legacy UNIX systems or other operating systems.

Folder and File Owner Access When a folder or file is created, the file system stores the user ID of the user who created the file or folder as its owner. By default, when a user with that user ID accesses the folder or file, he or she can read and write to it. Also, any process started by the user who creates the file or folder can read and write to any files associated with that same user ID.

If you change a user ID, the user may not be able to modify or access files and folders he or she created. Likewise, if the user logs in as a user whose user ID is different from the user ID he or she used to create the files and folders, the user no longer has owner permissions for those files and folders.

Folder and File Access by Other Users The use of GUIDs in conjuction with ACLs determines the files that users and groups can access. Also, the user ID, in conjunction with a group ID, is used to control access.

Every user belongs to a primary group. The primary group ID for a user is stored in the users account. When a user accesses a folder or file and the user isnt the owner, the file system checks the files group permissions, and the following occurs: If the users primary group ID matches the ID of the group associated with the file,

the user inherits group permissions. If the users primary group ID doesnt match the files group ID, Mac OS X searches for

the group account that has permission to access the file. When the group is found, all members of that group and subsequent hierarchical groups are given permission to that file.

If neither of these cases apply, the users access permissions default to the generic everyone.

Chapter 1 User Management Overview 29

ACLs and POSIX Permissions Every file and folder has POSIX permissions. Unless an administrator assigns ACL permissions, POSIX permissions continue to define user access. If you assign ACL permissions, they take precedence over standard POSIX permissions.

If a file has ACL permissions, but none apply to the user, the POSIX permissions determine user access. If a file has multiple ACEs that apply to a user, the first applicable ACE takes precedence, and subsequent ACEs are ignored.

For more information about ACL and POSIX permissions, see File Services Administration.

SIDs and Windows Interoperability Mac OS X computers work seamlessly with Windows computers because Mac OS X assigns a security identifier (SID) to a process or file when it assigns a GUID to the process or file. A SID is a Windows identifier that has similar functionality to a GUID on a Mac OS X computer.

When Windows users access share points using Server Message Block (SMB), they transfer SIDs, not GUIDs. When Mac OS X Server receives SIDs, it retrieves the user accounts with the corresponding GUIDs.

Windows servers use Active Directory as their directory domain. If a user account is moved to a different Active Directory domain, it receives a new SID but not a new GUID. The user still has access permissions assigned to old SIDs because Active Directory keeps track of SID history in user accounts.

30 Chapter 1 User Management Overview

2

31

2 Getting Started with User Management

This chapter provides information about planning and setting up a user management environment.

To create an effective user management environment, you must carefully plan your network. Then, when deploying the network, you must systematically and methodically set up your network resources.

Setup Overview This section provides an overview of user management setup tasks, including the sequence of stages an administrator follows to create a managed environment. Not all steps are necessary in every case.

For a more comprehensive approach to planning, security, server setup, installation and deployment, management, and monitoring, see Server Administration.

Step 1: Before you begin, do some planning Analyze your users needs to determine which directory service configuration and home folder setup is the most suitable. For more information, see Planning Strategies for User Management on page 34.

Step 2: Set up the server infrastructure Before deploying client computers, make sure one or more computers with Mac OS X Server installed is set up for hosting accounts and share points. New servers come with Mac OS X Server software preinstalled.

Set up the server so it hosts or provides access to shared directory domains. Shared directory domains (also called shared directories) contain user, group, and computer information you want multiple computers to access. Users whose accounts reside in a shared directory are referred to as network users.

There are different kinds of shared directories. You can use Workgroup Manager to add or modify accounts that reside in read/write directory domains such as an Open Directory domain or the local directory domain.

32 Chapter 2 Getting Started with User Management

Make sure that read-only directory domains (such as LDAPv2, read-only LDAPv3, or BSD flat files) are configured to support Mac OS X Server and that they provide necessary account data. To make the directory compatible, you must add, modify, and reorganize directory information.

Mac OS X offers various options for authenticating users (including Windows users) whose accounts are stored in directory domains on Mac OS X Server. In addition, Mac OS X accesses accounts in existing directories on your network, such as an Active Directory hosted on a Windows server.

To make resources visible throughout the network so users can access them from different computers, use file services. Important network-visible resources include network home folders, group folders, and other shared folders.

If some users use Windows computers, you can configure the server to provide them with file services, domain login, and home folders.

The following administration guides describe infrastructure setup in detail: For installation requirements and guidelines, see Getting Started. For information about advanced installation and setup of server software, see Server

Administration. For information about directory services and authentication, see Open Directory

Administration. For information about how to set up file services, see File Services Administration.

Step 3: Set up an administrator computer Because servers are usually kept in a secure, locked location, administrators typically conduct user management tasks remotely from a Mac OS X computer. Such a computer is referred to as an administrator computer.

Before you can use an administrator computer to create and manage accounts in a shared directory, you must have a user account in the shared directory and you must be a domain administrator. A domain administrator can use Workgroup Manager to add and change accounts in an Open Directory domain or another read/write directory domain.

To set up an administrator computer and create domain administrator accounts, see Chapter 3, Getting Started with Workgroup Manager.

Step 4: Set up a home folder share point Home folders for accounts stored in shared directories can reside in a network share point accessible by the users computer.

You can set up network home folders so they can be accessed using either AFP or NFS, or you can set up home folders for exclusive use by Windows users using SMB.

Chapter 2 Getting Started with User Management 33

For information about setting up home folders using AFP, NFS, or SMB, see Chapter 7, Setting Up Home Folders.

Step 5: Create user accounts and home folders You can use Workgroup Manager to create user accounts in directories that reside on Mac OS X Server or in other read/write directory domains. The following sections contain instructions for creating accounts and folders: To create user accounts, see Chapter 4, Setting Up User Accounts. To create mobile user accounts, see Chapter 8, Managing Portable Computers. To set up home folders, see Chapter 7, Setting Up Home Folders.

Step 6: Set up client computers Mac OS X Server supports users of Mac OS X, Windows, and UNIX client computers.

For Mac OS X computers, configure the search policy of the computers so it locates shared directory domains. For instructions, see Open Directory Administration.

For setup instructions for mobile Mac OS X computers that use AirPort to communicate with Mac OS X Server, see Designing AirPort Extreme Networks at http://www.apple.com/support/manuals/airport/.

You can join Windows workstations to the Mac OS X Server primary domain controller (PDC), which is similar to the way you configure Windows workstations to join a Windows NT server domain.

If you have more than a few Macintosh client computers to set up, consider using NetInstall to create a system image that automates client computer setup. For instructions, see System Imaging and Software Update Administration.

To prevent unauthorized access to client computers, secure them from local and network threats. For information, see Mac OS X Security Configuration.

Step 7: Define user account preferences You manage the work environment of Macintosh users whose accounts reside in a shared domain by defining user account preferences. For information about Mac OS X user preferences, see Chapter 9, Client Management Overview, and Chapter 10, Managing Preferences.

Step 8: Create group accounts and group folders Use Workgroup Manager to create group accounts in directories that reside on Mac OS X Server and in other read/write directory domains.

You can create group folders to distribute documents and organize group member applications. You can also set up ACLs and other access privileges to restrict a groups access to folders or files:

34 Chapter 2 Getting Started with User Management

For information about how to work with Mac OS X group accounts and group folders, see Chapter 5, Setting Up Group Accounts.

For information about how to add a group folder to the dock to make it more accessible to users, see Chapter 10, Managing Preferences.

For information about setting up ACLs, see File Services Administration.

Step 9: Define group account preferences You can manage preferences for a group account. A group account with managed preferences is called a workgroup. For information about Mac OS X workgroups, see Chapter 9, Client Management Overview, and Chapter 10, Managing Preferences.

Step 10: Define computer accounts, computer groups, and preferences Use computer accounts or computer groups to manage Macintosh client computers. For information about creating Mac OS X computer accounts or computer groups,

see Chapter 6, Setting Up Computers and Computer Groups. For information about computer group preferences, see Chapter 9, Client

Management Overview, and Chapter 10, Managing Preferences.

Step 11: Perform ongoing account maintenance As users come and go, and the requirements for your servers change, you must update account information: For information about how to use Workgroup Manager to display accounts,

see Chapter 3, Getting Started with Workgroup Manager. For information about how to perform common tasks such as creating accounts,

disabling accounts, adding and removing users from groups, and deleting accounts, see Chapter 4 through Chapter 6.

For solutions to common problems, see Chapter 11, Solving Problems.

Planning Strategies for User Management The following are planning activities to undertake before you implement user management.

Analyzing Your Environment Your environment defines your user management settings, including: Size and distribution of your network Number of users who access your network Type of computers used (Mac OS X or Windows) How client computers are used Which computers are mobile Which users should have administrator privileges Which users should have access to particular computers

Chapter 2 Getting Started with User Management 35

What services and resources users need (such as mail or access to data storage) How to divide users into groups (for example, by class topic or job function) How to group computers (such as all computers in a public lab)

Identifying Directory Services Requirements Identify the directories where youll store user and group accounts, computers, and computer groups: Set up an Open Directory master and replicas to host a Lightweight Directory Access

Protocol (LDAP) directory for storing other user accounts, group accounts, computers, and computer groups on your network. For information about password handling options, see Open Directory Administration.

If you have an earlier version of an Apple server, you might be able to migrate existing records. For available options, see Updating and Migrating.

If you have an LDAP or Active Directory server set up, you might be able to use existing account records. For details about accessing existing directories, see Open Directory Administration. For information about working with Open Directory groups and computer groups, see Chapter 5, Setting Up Group Accounts, and Chapter 6, Setting Up Computers and Computer Groups.

Note: If all domains are not finalized when youre ready to start adding user and group accounts, add the accounts to any directory domain that exists on your server (the local directory domain is always available). You can move users and groups to another directory domain later by using your servers export and import functions.

Passwords are not retained when exporting and importing account information. For more information, see the appendix, Importing and Exporting Account Information.

Determining Server and Storage Requirements When planning for server needs, you must first acquire the following information: The number of concurrently connected computers, which affects network traffic and

server response times The number of user accounts, which affects the amount of storage space required to

store user files

Directory services, including authentication and user management, require one Open Directory master or replica for every 1000 computers, regardless of the number of total user accounts. For example, if you have 400 computers and 2000 users, you need one Open Directory master for authentication and account management. If you have 1800 computers and 2500 users, you need one Open Directory master and one Open Directory replica.

36 Chapter 2 Getting Started with User Management

If you use network home folders, they require one dedicated home folder server for every 150 concurrent connections. If you use mobile accounts with portable home directories, you need one dedicated home folder server for every 300 concurrent connections.

For example, if you have 400 computers and 2000 users on network home folders, you need three dedicated home folders servers. If those users are deployed with portable home folders, you need two dedicated home folder servers.

If you have 1800 computers and 2500 users, you should have 12 dedicated home folder servers for network home folders and 6 dedicated servers for portable home directories.

Group folders require one server for every 450 concurrent connections. For example, if you have 400 computers, you need one group folder server. For 1800 computers, you need four group folder servers.

Storage requirements vary because users have varying storage needs. Some users may store very few files in their home folders, while other users fill theirs. A simple guideline is to start with 1 gigabyte (GB) of storage per user account, but allow for expansion.

Dont establish disk quotas or other space restrictions unless you have closely examined your users' storage needs. For example, 2000 user accounts might only need 2 terabytes (TB) of storage over the course of several years. However, if you give that same 2000 users their own computers with 60 GB drives, they could use as much as 120 TB of storage. In this case, every user fills his or her own drive, and portable home directory syncing mirrors files from his or her local home folder to the network file server.

Choosing a Home Folder Structure When deploying computers, one of the most crucial decisions is choosing how and where to host home folders.

There are three types of home folders: a local home folder, a network home folder, and a portable home directory. These home folders are typically tied, respectively, to local, network, and mobile accounts.

When considering your home folder structure, keep the following in mind: Users with local accounts typically have local home folders.

When users save files in local home folders, the files are stored locally. To save the files over the network, users must connect to the network and upload the file.

Using local home folders provides the least amount of control over a users managed preferences, and is also not inherently tied to a network account.

Users with network accounts typically have network home folders.

Chapter 2 Getting Started with User Management 37

When users save files in network home folders, the files are stored on the server. Additionally, when users access home folders, even for common tasks like caching webpages, the users computers must retrieve these files from the server.

Using network home folders provides complete control over a users managed preferences. When users are not connected to the network, they cant access their accounts or home folders.

Users with mobile accounts have both local and network home folders, which combine to form portable home directories. When users save files, the files are stored in a local home folder. The portable home directory is a synced subset of a users local and network home folders. You can configure which folders to sync and how frequently to sync them.

Mobile accounts also cache authentication information and managed preferences. If you sync key folders, a user can work on and off the network, and experience a seamless work environment.

If you choose not to sync portable home directories, mobile accounts are then very similar to local accounts, except that mobile accounts have managed preferences.

Users with mobile accounts who access their accounts on computers running Mac OS X v10.5 or later can use portable home directories with an external drive. When users connect external drives to a computer (including computers off of the network), they can still access their accounts. These types of mobile accounts are called external accounts.

An external account stores its local home folder on the external drive and doesnt create a local home folder on the computer its accessed from.

Except for the location of the local home folder, external accounts are treated like mobile accounts, with the same kinds of syncing, cached authentication, and managed preference benefits.

Note: If a users mobile account is hosted in an Active Directory domain, the mobile account does not have a portable home directory. However, it does have a local home folder and a network home folder, and caches authentication.

Mobile accounts and external accounts are described in detail in Chapter 8, Managing Portable Computers.

Devising a Home Folder Distribution Strategy Determine which users need home folders and identify the computers where you want these home folders to reside. For performance reasons, avoid using network home folders over network connections slower than 100 megabits per second (Mbit/s).

38 Chapter 2 Getting Started with User Management

A users network home folder doesnt need to be stored on the same server as the directory containing the users account. In fact, distributing directory domains and home folders across multiple servers can help balance your network load. This scenario is described in Distributing Home Folders Across Multiple Servers on page 115.

You may want to store home folders for users with last names beginning with A through F on one computer, G through J on another, and so on. Or, you may want to store home folders on a Mac OS X Server computer but store user and group accounts on an LDAP or Active Directory server.

Before creating users, pick a distribution strategy. If your distribution strategy fails while using it, you can move home folders, but doing so can require changing a large number of user records.

When determining the access protocol to use for home folders, AFP offers the greatest level of security. If you are hosting home folders on UNIX servers that do not support AFP, you may want to use NFS. If you are hosting home folders on Windows servers, you may want to use SMB.

For more information about how to use these protocols for home folders, see About Home Folders on page 113.

Identifying Groups Identify users with similar requirements and consider assigning them to groups. See Chapter 5, Setting Up Group Accounts.

Determining Administrator Requirements With Mac OS X v10.5, you dont need to give full domain administrator privileges to all users who need only some administrative control. Instead, you can give them limited administrative privileges.

Decide which users will have full administrative control over accounts and which users will perform only a few administrative duties.

The domain administrator has the greatest amount of control over other user accounts and privileges. The domain administrator can create user accounts, group accounts, computer accounts, and computer groups, and can assign settings, privileges, and managed preferences for them. He or she can also create other server administrator accounts, or give specific users (for example, teachers or technical staff ) administrator privileges in certain directory domains.

Limited administrators can perform common administrative tasks for specified users and groups. They can manage user preferences, edit managed preferences, edit user information, and edit group membership. Giving users limited administrative privileges helps them to be more self-sufficient, without putting your organization at risk.

Chapter 2 Getting Started with User Management 39

For example, you might want to give student lab assistants the ability to manage user passwords for a small group of students, while giving teachers the ability to manage user passwords, edit user information, and edit group information for all of their classes.

Because users can be given limited administrator privileges, consider which users require domain administrator privileges. A well-planned hierarchy of administrators and users with special administrator privileges helps you distribute system administration tasks and makes workflow and network management more efficient.

When you use Server Assistant to configure your server, specify a password for the owner/administrator. This password also becomes the root password for your server. Only a few server administrators need to know the root password, but sometimes its necessary when using command-line tools (such as CreateGroupFolder).

Administrators who dont need root access can use Workgroup Manager to create an administrator user with a password different from the root password.

Use the root password with caution and store it in a secure location. The root user has full access to the system, including system files. If necessary, you can use Workgroup Manager to change the root password.

40 Chapter 2 Getting Started with User Management

3

41

3 Getting Started with Workgroup Manager

This chapter provides instructions for setting up Workgroup Manager and using its core features.

Workgroup Manager is the primary application for managing client computers. You can use Workgroup Manager to create accounts and manage preferences.

Configuring the Administrators Computer and Account To use Workgroup Manager, you must first install the Mac OS X Server administration tools. Before you can manage client computers, you must configure a computer for use as an administrator computer and create a domain administrator account.

Setting Up an Administrator Computer When you install Workgroup Manager and other administration tools on a remote administrator computer, you do not need to physically access the server. Instead, use this administrator computer to connect to the server and perform administrative tasks remotely.

The computer should have Mac OS X v10.5 or later, at least 512 MB of RAM, and 1 GB of unused disk space.

For more about server and storage requirements, see Determining Server and Storage Requirements on page 35.

To create and modify accounts, you must also have a domain administrator account.

To set up an administrator computer: 1 Insert the Administration Tools disc and then start the installer,

ServerAdministrationSoftware.mpkg, located in the /Installers folder.

Make sure the server administration tools you install are the same version as the Mac OS X Server software installed on your servers. If you use older server administration tools with a newer server version, the tools can cause errors and corrupt data.

2 Follow the onscreen instructions.

42 Chapter 3 Getting Started with Workgroup Manager

3 If you are managing preferences that use specific paths to find files (such as Dock preferences), make sure the administrator computer has the same file system structure as each managed client computer.

This means that folder names, volumes, the location of applications, and so on should be the same.

Creating a Domain Administrator Account Before creating and editing accounts in a shared directory, you need a domain administrator account in the directory. A domain administrator can use Workgroup Manager to add and change accounts residing in an Open Directory domain, the local directory domain, or another read/write directory domain.

To create a domain administrator account: 1 On the administrator computer, open Workgroup Manager and then authenticate as

the administrator user created during server setup.

2 Access the shared directory by clicking the globe icon and choose the directory domain.

If youre not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Click New User, click Basic, and then provide basic information for the administrator.

4 Click Privileges and from the Administration capabilities pop-up menu choose Full.

5 Click Save.

From the Command Line You can also create a domain administrator account using the dscl and pwpolicy commands in Terminal. For more information, see the users and groups chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Using Workgroup Manager After installing the Mac OS X Server software and setting up a domain administrator account, you can access and use Workgroup Manager for user management.

This section provides an introduction to Workgroup Manager.

Using Mac OS X Server v10.5 to Administer Earlier Versions of Mac OS X Servers running Mac OS X Server v10.3 or v10.4 can be administered using v10.5 server administration tools. You can use Workgroup Manager on a computer running Mac OS X Server v10.5 to manage Mac OS X clients running Mac OS X v10.3.9 or later.

Chapter 3 Getting Started with Workgroup Manager 43

Connecting and Authenticating to Directory Domains in Workgroup Manager When you install your server or set up an administrator computer, Workgroup Manager is installed in /Applications/Server/. Use the Finder to open the application, or click its icon in the Dock or in the toolbar of the Server Admin application.

You can view a directory domain without authenticating by choosing Server > View Directories in Workgroup Manager. Initially, you have read-only access to information displayed in Workgroup Manager. To make changes in a directory, you must authenticate using a domain administrator account. This approach is most useful when youre administering different servers and working with different directory domains.

To connect and authenticate to directory domains: 1 Open Workgroup Manager and when the Workgroup Manager Connect window

appears click Browse, or enter the IP address or DNS name for a server that connects to directory domains.

2 Enter the user name and password for a domain administrator and click Connect.

3 To change directory domains while connected to a server, click the globe icon (see below) to select a domain, then authenticate as a domain administrator by clicking the lock icon.

4 To connect to a different server, choose Server > Connect.

Click the globe icon to select a directory domain

Click the lock to authenticate

44 Chapter 3 Getting Started with Workgroup Manager

Major Workgroup Manager Tasks After login, the Accounts pane appears (see below), showing a list of user accounts. Initially, the user accounts listed are those stored in the last directory domain of the servers search policy.

Here is how to get started with the primary Workgroup Manager tasks: To specify the directory that stores accounts you want to work with, click the globe

icon. To work with accounts in different directories at the same time or to work with

different views of accounts in a particular directory, open multiple Workgroup Manager windows by clicking the New Window icon in the toolbar or by choosing Server > New Workgroup Manager Window.

To administer accounts in the selected directory, click the Accounts icon in the toolbar; then click the Users, Groups, Computers, or Computer Groups button on the left side of the window to list the accounts that exist in the directories you are working with.

To filter the displayed account list, use the pop-up search menu above the accounts list.

To work with managed preferences, select an account (or several accounts) and then click the Preferences icon in the toolbar.

To import or export user and group accounts, choose Server > Import or Server > Export.

Accounts list

Type here to search or filter the list below

Users button

Click the globe icon to select a directory domain

Computers button

Computer Groups button

Currently selected domain

Click the lock to authenticate

Groups button

Chapter 3 Getting Started with Workgroup Manager 45

To view onscreen help, use the Help menu. The Help menu gives you access to help for administration tasks available through Workgroup Manager, as well as other Mac OS X Server topics.

To open Server Admin so you can monitor and work with services on a server, click the Server Admin icon in the Workgroup Manager toolbar. For information about Server Admin, see Server Administration.

Modifying Workgroup Manager Preferences You can change Workgroup Manager preferences to customize how records are displayed and to enable the Inspector, which is an advanced directory domain editor.

Workgroup Manager includes the following preferences.

To set Workgroup Manager preferences: 1 In Workgroup Manager, choose Workgroup Manager > Preferences.

2 Select the preferences you want to change.

3 To reset the warning messages youve marked as Dont show again, click Reset Dont show again messages.

4 Click OK.

Preference Description

Resolve DNS names when possible

(Default: on) Disabling this preference causes Workgroup Manager to stop resolving DNS names when writing data. If youre having DNS issues, disabling this can help mitigate the effect of those DNS issues (but you should fix those issues).

Show All Records tab and inspector

(Default: off ) Enabling this preference enables the Inspector. The Inspector allows you to see and edit directory data not otherwise visible in Workgroup Manager. For more information, see Open Directory Administration.

Limit search results to requested records

(Default: off ) When you dont enter anything in the search field, by default, Workgroup Manager lists all user records in the selected directory domain. Disabling this preference requires you to enter * (without quotes) to list all records, which can expedite working with large directory domains in Workgroup Manager (because Workgroup Manager doesnt automatically list all records).

List a maximum of # records (Default: off ) Enabling this preference limits the maximum number of search results to a number you specify. Enabling this preference and setting a reasonable maximum number can improve Workgroup Manager performance. However, setting the number too low can cause you to overlook the total number of matches.

46 Chapter 3 Getting Started with Workgroup Manager

Finding and Listing Accounts Workgroup Manager provides several methods for finding and listing user accounts, group accounts, computer accounts, and computer groups.

Working with Account Lists in Workgroup Manager In Workgroup Manager, user accounts, group accounts, computer accounts, and computer groups are listed on the left side of the Workgroup Manager window.

The following settings influence the contents and appearance of the list: Workgroup Manager preferences control the maximum number of records shown

and whether you want to enable the Inspector (which allows you to view or edit raw directory data). To set up Workgroup Manager preferences, choose Workgroup Manager > Preferences.

The list reflects the directory youve chosen from the globe icon. If you connect to the directory server, the accounts in the parent directory domain are listed. If you do not connect to the directory server, local accounts are listed. The listed domains are the local directory domain, all directory domains in the servers search policy, and all available directory domains (domains the server is configured to access, even if not in the search policy). For instructions on configuring a server to access directory domains, see Open Directory Administration.

After you choose directory domains, all accounts residing in those domains are listed.

You can list users, groups, computers or computer groups by clicking the Users, Groups, Computers, or Computer Groups buttons above the search filter.

To sort a list, click a column heading. An arrow shows the sort order (ascending or descending), which you can reverse by clicking the column heading again.

You can search for specific items in the list by typing in the field above the accounts list. To choose the search criteria, use the Search (magnifying glass) pop-up menu.

To work with accounts, select them. Settings for the selected accounts appear in the pane to the right of the list. Available settings vary, depending on which pane youre viewing.

Listing Accounts in the Local Directory Domain When you list accounts in the local directory domain, you list all local accounts. These local accounts can only be accessed by users of the local computer or server, not by users of client computers.

Services and programs running on a server can access the servers local directory domain. Programs running on a client computer, such as the client computers login window, cant access the servers local directory domain.

If a server hosts file services, users with accounts from the servers local directory domain can authenticate with the file services.

Chapter 3 Getting Started with Workgroup Manager 47

User accounts from the servers local directory domain cant be used to authenticate in the login window on client computers, because the login window is a process running on the client computer.

To list accounts in a servers local directory domain: 1 In Workgroup Manager, connect to the server hosting the domain; then click the globe

icon and choose Local.

For servers running Mac OS X Server v10.5 or later, the local directory domain is listed as /Local/Default.

2 Choose from the following:

To view user accounts, click the Users button. To view group accounts, click the Groups button. To view computer accounts, click the Computers button. To view computer groups, click the Computer Groups button.

3 To work with a particular account, select it.

Changing account settings or preferences requires server administrator privileges, so you may need to click the lock to authenticate.

Listing Accounts in Search Policy Directory Domains A computers search policy specifies which directory domains Open Directory can access. The search policy also specifies the order in which Open Directory accesses directory domains. By listing accounts in a search policy, you list the accounts on all directory domains in the search policy.

You cant edit accounts when listing accounts in a search policy.

For more information about how to set up search policies, see Open Directory Administration.

To list accounts in search policy domains of the server youre working with: 1 In Workgroup Manager, connect to a server that has a search policy containing the

directory domains of interest.

2 Click the globe icon and choose Search Policy.

3 Choose from the following:

To view user accounts, click the Users button. To view group accounts, click the Groups button. To view computer accounts, click the Computers button. To view computer groups, click the Computer Groups button.

48 Chapter 3 Getting Started with Workgroup Manager

Listing Accounts in Available Directory Domains Using Workgroup Manager, you can list user accounts, group accounts, computer accounts, and computer groups residing in any available directory domain accessible from the server youre connected to.

Available directory domains are not the same as directory domains in a search policy. A search policy consists of the directory domains a server searches routinely when it needs to retrieve accounts. However, the same server might be configured to access directory domains that havent been added to its search policy.

To learn how to configure access to directory domains, see Open Directory Administration.

To list accounts in a directory domain accessible from a server: 1 In Workgroup Manager, connect to a server where you can access the directory

domains.

2 Click the globe icon and then choose the domain where the users account resides.

If the directory domain is not listed, add it to the pop-up menu by choosing Other. In the dialog that appears, select the domain and then click OK.

3 Choose from the following:

To view user accounts, click the Users button. To view group accounts, click the Groups button. To view computer accounts, click the Computers button. To view computer groups, click the Computer Groups button.

4 To work with a particular account, select it.

Changing the account requires domain administrator privileges, so you might need to click the lock to authenticate.

Refreshing Account Lists If more than one administrator makes changes to directory domains, make sure youre viewing the current list of user accounts, group accounts, computer accounts, and computer groups by refreshing the lists.

To refresh account lists, click Refresh in the toolbar. Alternatively, click the globe icon and then choose the directory domain youre working in from the pop-up menu.

Finding Specific Accounts in a List After youve displayed a list of accounts in Workgroup Manager, you can filter the list to find particular users or groups.

You can choose from several filters: Name Contains

Chapter 3 Getting Started with Workgroup Manager 49

Name Starts With Name Ends With Name Is ID Is ID Is Greater Than ID Is Less Than Comment Contains Keyword Contains

To filter items in the list of accounts: 1 After listing accounts, click the Users, Groups, Computers, or Computer Groups button.

2 Click the Search (magnifying glass) pop-up menu, choose an option to describe what you want to find, and then type search terms in the search field.

The original list is replaced by items that satisfy your search criteria. If you enter a user name, both full and short user names are searched. If you enter a group name, short group names are searched.

3 When the domains youre working with contain thousands of accounts, choose Workgroup Manager > Preferences and do the following:

Using Advanced Search Use the Search button in the toolbar to locate specific users or groups by searching several fields relevant to them. You can then batch-edit these search results. For more information about batch editing, see Editing Multiple Accounts Simultaneously on page 51.

You can search across several fields: Record Name Real Name User ID Comment Keyword Group ID

To do this Do this

Avoid listing accounts until a filter is specified

Select Limit search results to requested records.

List all accounts in the selected directory domain

Type * (without quotes) in the search field.

Specify the maximum number of accounts to list

Select List a maximum of n records, and then enter a number no greater than 32,767.

50 Chapter 3 Getting Started with Workgroup Manager

There are several field options: Is less than Is greater than Is Contains

To locate users or groups in the Accounts or Preferences panes: 1 In the Workgroup Manager toolbar, click Search.

You can also click the Search (magnifying glass) button in the search field above the accounts list and then choose Advanced Search.

2 Choose a field to search, a field option, and then enter the text you want to search.

3 Click the Add (+) button to add search criteria.

4 Save, rename, or delete a preset by using the Search Presets pop-up menu.

5 After you define your search, click Search Now.

After receiving search results, you can clear the search to revert to your default display or edit the search to refine it further. While editing the search, you can save the search as a preset for later use.

Sorting Users and Groups After displaying a list of accounts in Workgroup Manager, click a column heading to sort entries using the values in that column. Click the heading again to reverse the sort order.

Shortcuts for Working with Accounts Workgroup Manager provides shortcuts for applying the same settings to new or existing accounts. You can also import user and group account information from a file.

Using Presets You can select settings for a user account, group account, or computer group, and save them as presets. Presets work like templates, allowing you to apply predefined settings to a new account. Using presets, you can easily set up multiple accounts with similar settings.

You can only use presets during account creation. You cant use a preset to modify an existing account. You can use presets when creating accounts manually, or when importing them from a file.

If you change a preset after it has been used to create an account, accounts already created using the preset are not updated to reflect those changes.

Chapter 3 Getting Started with Workgroup Manager 51

For more information about how to create presets, see Creating a Preset for User Accounts on page 61.

Editing Multiple Accounts Simultaneously You can edit settings (if they dont need to be unique) for multiple user accounts, group accounts, or computer groups at the same time. Simultaneously editing multiple accounts is referred to as batch editing.

There are two ways to simultaneously edit accounts: select several accounts in the accounts list, or use the batch edit feature in the Advanced Search dialog.

Unlike when you select several accounts, the batch edit feature allows you to preview and edit search results before applying changes, and you can view changes and errors after applying more changes.

There are several ways to select multiple accounts: To select a range of accounts, hold down the Shift key while clicking. To select accounts individually, hold down the Command key while clicking. To deselect accounts, choose Edit > Select All and then Command-click individual

accounts.

Although you can simultaneously edit most account settings for multiple users, some settings must be made for individual users. For example, you cant assign the same name, short name, or user ID to multiple users. Workgroup Manager disables fields where you must provide unique values.

If a setting is not the same for two or more accounts, you may see a mixed-state slider, radio button, checkbox, text field, pop-up menu, or list:

The mixed-state interface element also appears when you do the following: Edit managed preferences that were originally set in Mac OS X v10.4 or earlier Change a preference in the preference editor that corresponds to an interface

element

If you choose a new setting for a mixed-state setting, every account has the new setting.

Interface element Mixed-state appearance

Sliders, radio buttons, and checkboxes

A dash, which indicates that the setting is not the same for all selected accounts

Text fields Either the term Varies or ... appears in the text field

Pop-up menu The term --Varies-- appears in the pop-up menu

Lists The term Data Varies appears in the list

52 Chapter 3 Getting Started with Workgroup Manager

For example, suppose you select three group accounts that each have different settings for the Dock size. When you look at the Dock Display preference pane for these accounts, the Dock Size slider is centered and has a dash on it. If you change the position of the Dock Size slider to Large, all selected accounts then have a large-size Dock.

To batch-edit accounts that match specific criteria: 1 In Workgroup Manager, select Accounts or Preferences.

2 Click the globe icon below the toolbar and choose the directory domain that contains the accounts you want to edit.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 In the toolbar, click Search.

You can also click the magnifier in the search field above the accounts list and then choose Advanced Search.

5 To enter search criteria, choose the field to search and the field option, enter the text you want to search, and then click the Add (+) button to add additional search criteria.

6 Select Perform a batch edit on the search results.

7 To create a list of accounts affected when you save batch edits, select Preview and edit search results before applying changes.

8 To create a list of accounts and changes made to each of those accounts after saving batch edits, select Display postview of changes or errors.

9 Click Continue.

10 Change account information or preference settings, and then click Apply Now.

If a field is disabled, you cant edit the field while multiple user accounts are selected.

11 If you selected Preview and edit search results before applying changes, a dialog appears listing all accounts affected by the batch edit. To remove an account, select the account, and then click Remove Item. When the dialog lists only the accounts you want to edit, click Apply.

If you perform more batch edits using the same query, the removed account returns to this list.

12 If you selected Display postview of changes errors, a dialog appears listing the batch- edit results, including the changed records and fields. To save a text log of the batch- edit results, click Save. Click OK.

13 To stop batch editing, click Clear.

Chapter 3 Getting Started with Workgroup Manager 53

Importing and Exporting Account Information You can use XML or character-delimited text files to import and export user and group account information. Importing information can make it easier to set up many accounts quickly. Exporting information to a file is useful for record-keeping. To back up account information with passwords intact, archive the directory.

For more information, see the appendix, Importing and Exporting Account Information.

54 Chapter 3 Getting Started with Workgroup Manager

4

55

4 Setting Up User Accounts

This chapter tells you how to set up, edit, and manage user accounts.

User accounts give users unique identities on your network and allow you to manage those users.

You can use Workgroup Manager to view, create, edit, and delete user accounts.

To view user accounts in Workgroup Manager, click the Users button above the accounts list.

About User Accounts A user account stores data that Mac OS X Server uses to validate a users identity and provide services to the user.

Where User Accounts Are Stored User accounts, group accounts, computer accounts, and computer groups are stored in a directory domain, available to any Mac OS X computer. A directory domain can reside on a Mac OS X computer (for example, an Open Directory domain or other read/write directory domain), or it can reside on a non-Apple server (for example, a non-Apple LDAP or Active Directory server).

For Windows file service and other services, you can store user accounts in any directory domain accessible from the server that needs to authenticate users for a service.

If the user account is used for Windows domain login from a Windows computer, you must store it in the LDAP directory of the Mac OS X Server that is the primary domain controller (PDC), or in a copy of the LDAP directory on a backup domain controller (BDC).

56 Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts

A Windows user account that is not stored in the PDC servers LDAP directory can be used to access other services. For example, Mac OS X Server can authenticate users with accounts in the servers local directory domain for the servers Windows file service.

Mac OS X Server also authenticates users with accounts on other directory systems, such as an Open Directory master on another Mac OS X Server system, or Active Directory on a Windows server.

For complete information about the different kinds of directory domains, see Open Directory Administration.

Predefined User Accounts The following table describes user accounts that are created when you install Mac OS X Server (unless otherwise indicated). For a complete list, open Workgroup Manager and choose View > Show System Users and Groups.

Predefined user name Short name User ID Use

MySQL Server mysql 74 The user that the MySQL database server uses for its processes that handle requests.

sshd Privilege separation

sshd 75 The user for the sshd child processes that process network data.

System Administrator root 0 A user with no protections or restrictions.

System Services daemon 1 A legacy UNIX user.

Unknown User unknown 99 A user with no login or password. When files or volumes have no real owner, they are assigned unknown as their owner.

Unprivileged User nobody -2 This user was originally created so system services didnt need to run as System Administrator. Now service-specific users such as World Wide Web Server are often used for this purpose.

World Wide Web Server www 70 The nonprivileged user that Apache uses for its processes that handle requests.

Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts 57

Administering User Accounts You can view, create, edit, and delete user accounts stored in various kinds of directory domains.

Creating User Accounts To create a user account in a directory domain, you must have administrator privileges for the domain.

To create user accounts in an LDAPv3 directory on a non-Apple server, use Directory Utility to map the LDAPv3 directory attributes to Open Directory user and group attributes. For more information about user account elements that may need to be mapped, see Understanding What You Can Import and Export on page 251.

To create users in an Active Directory domain, use Active Directory administration tools on a Windows computer. You cant use Workgroup Manager to create user accounts, group accounts, computer accounts, or computer groups in a standard Active Directory domain. If you extend the schema of the Active Directory domain, you can create computer groups in Active Directory.

To create user accounts for Windows users, create them on a Mac OS X Server PDC, which creates them in the servers LDAP directory. Windows users with accounts on the PDC server can log in to the Windows domain from a Windows workstation. These user accounts can be used to authenticate to Windows file service and other services, and to Mac OS X computers on the network.

You can create user accounts in the Mac OS X Server PDC LDAP directory but not in a BDC read-only LDAP directory. If you have a BDC, the PDC server replicates the new accounts to the BDC.

If you create user accounts in a servers local directory domain, you can only authenticate for services provided by that server. You cant use these accounts to log in to a Mac OS X client computer or to perform Windows domain login. However, Windows users can authenticate with Windows file service, mail service, and other platform-neutral services.

For instructions on mapping LDAPv3 attributes or connecting to Active Directory, see Open Directory Administration.

To create a user account: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Make sure the directory services of the Mac OS X Server computer youre using are configured to access the directory domain.

For instructions, see Open Directory Administration.

58 Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts

3 Click the globe icon and then choose the domain where you want the users account to reside.

For Mac OS X Server v10.5 or later, Local and /Local/Default refer to the local directory domain.

4 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

5 Choose Server > New User or click New User in the toolbar.

6 In the panes provided, specify settings for the user.

For details, see Working with Basic Settings on page 63 through Working with Windows Settings on page 85.

You can also use a preset or an imported file to create a user account. For details, see Using Presets to Create Accounts on page 62 and Using Workgroup Manager to Import Accounts on page 253.

From the Command Line You can also create user accounts using the dscl command in Terminal. For more information, see the users and groups chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Editing User Account Information You can use Workgroup Manager to change a user account that resides in an Open Directory domain, the local directory domain, or other read/write directory domain.

You can modify accounts in an Open Directory domain if youre authorized to administer the directory domain. You dont need server administrator privileges but your user ID must have limited or full administrative privileges (which are set in the Privileges pane of Accounts in Workgroup Manager). For more information, see Working with Privileges on page 70.

To make changes to a user account: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Make sure that the directory services of the Mac OS X Server computer youre using are configured to access the desired directory domain.

For instructions, see Open Directory Administration.

3 Click the globe icon and then choose the domain where the users account resides.

If the directory domain is not listed, add it to the pop-up menu by choosing Other. In the dialog that appears, select the domain and then click OK.

4 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

5 Click the Users button and select the user account.

6 In the panes provided, edit settings for the user account.

Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts 59

For details, see Working with Basic Settings on page 63 through Working with Windows Settings on page 85.

From the Command Line You can also edit user account information using the dscl command in Terminal. For more information, see the users and groups chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Working with Read-Only User Accounts Use Workgroup Manager to review information about user accounts stored in read-only directory domains. Read-only directory domains include LDAPv2 domains, LDAPv3 domains not configured for write access, and BSD configuration files.

To work with a read-only user account: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Make sure that the directory services of the Mac OS X Server computer youre using are configured to access the directory domain where the account resides.

For information about using Directory Utility to configure server connections, see Open Directory Administration. For information about the user account elements that need to be mapped, see the appendix, Importing and Exporting Account Information.

3 Click the globe icon and choose the directory domain where the users account resides.

4 Review the users account settings using the panes provided.

For details, see Working with Basic Settings on page 63 through Working with Windows Settings on page 85.

Working with Guest Users You can set up some services to support guest users, who are not authenticated because they dont have a valid user name or password. You dont need to create a user account to support guest users.

The following services can be set up to support guest access: Apple file service. See File Services Administration. FTP service. See File Services Administration. Web service. See Web Technologies Administration. Windows services. See Open Directory Administration.

Users who connect to a server anonymously are restricted to files, folders, and websites with permissions set to Everyone.

Another kind of guest user account is a managed user account that you can configure for easy setup of public or kiosk computers. For more about these kinds of user accounts, see Chapter 10, Managing Preferences.

60 Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts

Working with Windows User Accounts Use Workgroup Manager to change passwords, password policies, and other settings in Windows user accounts.

The user accounts can reside in a servers local directory domain, a Mac OS X Server PDC LDAP directory, or another directory system that allows read-write access (not read-only access) such as an Open Directory master LDAP directory or Active Directory on a Windows server.

You can change the user account settings in the Mac OS X Server PDC LDAP directory, but not in a BDC read-only LDAP directory. If you have a BDC, the PDC server replicates the changes to the BDC.

Deleting a User Account You can use Workgroup Manager to delete a user account stored in an Open Directory domain, the local directory domain, or from any other read/write directory domain.

Deleting a user account also deletes all of the users mail.

To delete a user account using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to delete.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Choose Server > Delete Selected User or click the Delete icon in the toolbar.

From the Command Line You can also delete a user account using the dscl command in Terminal. For more information, see the users and groups chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Disabling a User Account To disable a user account, you can: Deselect the User can access account option in the Basic pane in Workgroup

Manager. Delete the account. Change the users password to an unknown value. Set password options to disable login. This applies to user accounts with the

password type Open Directory or Shadow Password.

WARNING: You cannot undo this action.

Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts 61

From the Command Line You can also disable a user account using the dscl and pwpolicy commands in Terminal. For more information, see the users and groups chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Working with Presets Presets are templates used to define attributes that apply to new user, group, or computer group accounts.

Creating a Preset for User Accounts You can create presets to use when creating user accounts in a directory domain.

Presets are stored in the directory domain youre currently viewing. If you change directory domains, the presets you created in the other directory domain are not available.

To create a preset for user accounts: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Click the globe icon and then choose the domain where the users account resides.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 To create a preset using data in an existing user account, open the account; to create a preset from scratch, create a user account.

5 If youre basing the preset on an existing account, fill in the fields with values you want new user accounts to inherit and then delete values you dont want to specify in advance.

The following attributes can be defined in a user-account preset: simultaneous login, default shell, comment, primary group ID, group membership list, home folder settings, disk quota, mail settings, and print settings.

6 Click Preferences.

7 Configure settings you want the preset to define, and then click Accounts.

After configuring preference settings for a preset, you return to the Accounts settings to save the preset.

8 From the Presets pop-up menu, choose Save Preset, enter a name for the preset, and click OK.

The preset is saved to the current directory domain.

62 Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts

Using Presets to Create Accounts Presets provide a quick way to apply settings to a new account. After applying the preset, you can continue to modify settings for the new account, if necessary.

You can use presets with user, group, and computer group accounts.

Presets are stored in the directory domain youre viewing. If you change directory domains, the presets you created in the other directory domain are not available.

When importing accounts, you can apply a preset to the imported account. For more information, see Using Workgroup Manager to Import Accounts on page 253.

To create an account using a preset: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Click the globe icon and then choose the directory domain where you want the new account to reside.

Make sure the directory domain you choose contains the preset you want to use.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and then enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click the Users, Groups, or Computer Groups button.

5 From the Presets pop-up menu, choose a preset.

6 To create accounts, click New User, New Group, or New Computer Group.

7 Add or update attribute values.

Renaming Presets You can name presets to help remind you of template settings or to identify the type of user account, group account, or computer group that the preset is best suited for.

To rename a preset: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Click the globe icon and then choose the directory domain that has the preset you want to rename.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 From the Presets pop-up menu, choose Rename Preset.

5 Choose a preset from the Rename preset pop-up menu, enter a name, and then click OK.

Editing Presets When you change a preset, existing accounts that were created with it are not updated to reflect the changes.

Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts 63

You edit a preset by using it to create an account, changing fields defined by the preset, and then saving the preset.

To edit a preset: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Click the globe icon and then choose the directory domain with the preset you want to edit.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click the Users, Groups, or Computer Groups button.

5 From the Presets pop-up menu, choose a preset.

6 Click New User, New Group, or New Computer Group to create accounts.

7 Change account settings that you want to save to the preset.

8 After completing your changes, choose Save Preset from the Presets pop-up menu, enter the name of the preset you want to change, click OK, and then click Replace.

Deleting a Preset If you no longer need a particular preset, you can delete it.

To delete a preset: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Click the globe icon and then choose the directory domain with the preset you want to delete.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 From the Presets pop-up menu, choose Delete Preset.

5 Select the preset you want to delete and click Delete.

Working with Basic Settings Basic settings are a collection of attributes that must be defined for all users.

In Workgroup Manager, use the user accounts Basic pane to work with basic settings.

Modifying User Names The user name is the long name for a user, such as Mei Chen or Dr. Anne Johnson. (In addition to the long name, sometimes the user name is referred to as the full name or the real name.) Users can log in using the user name or a short name associated with their accounts.

64 Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts

A user name can contain no more than 255 bytes. Because long user names support various character sets, the maximum number of characters for long user names ranges from 255 Roman characters to as few as 63 characters in character sets where characters occupy up to 4 bytes.

Use Workgroup Manager to edit the user name of an account stored in an Open Directory domain, the local directory domain, or other read/write directory domain. You can also use Workgroup Manager to review the user name in any directory domain accessible from the server youre using.

To work with the user name using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 In the Name field (in the Basic pane), review or edit the user name.

Initially, the value of the user name is Untitled #, where # is the sequential number generated after the last generated number for an existing untitled user.

Avoid assigning the same name to more than one user. Workgroup Manager doesnt let you assign the same name to different users in any domain or in a domain in the search policy. However, it cant detect whether duplicates exist in other domains.

Modifying Short Names A short name is an abbreviated name for a user, such as mchen or annejohnson. Users can log in using a short name or the user name associated with his or her accounts. The short name is used by Mac OS X for home folders.

When Mac OS X creates a users local or network AFP home folder, it names the directory after the users short name. For more information about home folders, see Chapter 7, Setting Up Home Folders.

You can have as many as 16 short names associated with a user account. For example, you might want to use multiple short names as aliases for mail accounts. The first short name is the name used for home folders and legacy group membership lists. Dont reassign that name after you save the user account.

A short user name can contain as many as 255 Roman characters. However, for clients using Mac OS X v10.1.5 and earlier, the first short user name must be eight characters or fewer.

Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts 65

For the first short user name, use only these characters (subsequent short names can contain any Roman character): a through z A through Z 0 through 9 _ (underscore) - (hyphen)

Typically, short names contain eight or fewer characters.

Initially, the value of the first short name is untitled_#, where # is the sequential number generated after the last generated number for an existing untitled user.

Avoid assigning the same name to more than one user. Workgroup Manager doesnt let you assign the same name to different users in a domain or in a domain search policy. However, it cant detect whether duplicates exist in other domains.

After the users account is saved you cant change the first short name but you can change any of the other short names.

Use Workgroup Manager to edit the short name of an account stored in an Open Directory domain, the local directory domain, or other read/write directory domain. You can also use Workgroup Manager to review the short name in any directory domain accessible from the server youre using.

To work with a user short name using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Basic, then in the Short Names field review or edit the short names:

Choosing Stable Short Names When you create a user account, assign the account a short name that wont be changed. After creating the account, you cant use the Basic pane of Workgroup Manager to change a users first short name.

To do this Do this

Change a short name Double-click the short name and then replace it.

Add a short name Double-click the blank entry at the bottom of the short name list and then enter a short name.

66 Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts

To change a users first short name, create a new account for the user in the same directory domain that contains the new first short name and retain all other account information (user ID, primary group, home folder, and so on). Make sure you use the same GUID for the new account. Then disable the login for the old user account.

After you disable the old login, the user can log in using the changed name but will have the same access to files and other network resources as before and will belong to the same groups.

For more information, see Working with GUIDs on page 87, and Disabling a User Account on page 60.

Avoiding Duplicate Names A users short name is used by the login window. This means that having multiple users with the same short name causes a conflict. Although you cant create multiple users with the same short name in the Basic pane of Workgroup Manager, its still possible to create multiple users with the same short name when you use command-line tools or the Inspector.

If multiple user accounts have the same long user name on a Mac OS X computer, the login window displays a list of users to choose from.

If two users have the same first short user name, the login window only recognizes and authenticates the first matching user account it finds in the sequence of directory domains specified by the computers search policy, as set in Directory Utility.

If a local user and a network user have the same first short user name, the local user always takes precedence, preventing the network user from logging in to the computer.

In groups created using Mac OS X versions earlier than 10.4, group membership is determined by the users first short name and group ID (GID). If multiple users have the same first short name, then they have the same group memberships.

Groups created using Mac OS X Server v10.4 or later determine group membership using a GUID and a combination of the users short name and GID. For information about GUIDs, see Working with GUIDs on page 87.

If you dont upgrade legacy groups, the groups still determine membership by only the users first short name and GID. For instructions on upgrading legacy groups, see Upgrading Legacy Groups on page 94.

To ensure that users have the correct legacy group membership, do not use duplicate user short names.

Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts 67

Modifying User IDs A user ID is a number that uniquely identifies a user. Mac OS X computers use the user ID to track a users folder and file ownership.

When a user creates a folder or file, the user ID is stored as the ID of the user who created the folder or file. This user ID has read and write permissions to the folder or file by default.

The user ID should be a unique string of digits from 500 through 2,147,483,647. It is risky to assign the same user ID to different users, because two users with the same user ID have identical directory and file permissions.

User IDs between 0 and 100 are reserved for system use and should not be deleted or modified except to change the password of the root user. Accounts with user IDs below 100 arent listed in the login window.

In general, after user IDs are assigned and users start creating files and folders, you shouldnt change user IDs. However, one possible scenario where you might need to change a user ID is when merging users that were created on different servers onto a new server or cluster of servers. The same user ID might still be associated with a different user on the previous server.

When you create a user account in a shared directory domain, Workgroup Manager assigns a user ID. The value assigned is an unused user ID (1025 or greater) in the servers search policy. (Users created using the Accounts pane of System Preferences are assigned user IDs starting at 501.)

You can use Workgroup Manager to edit the user ID of an account stored in an Open Directory domain or in the local directory domain. You can also use Workgroup Manager to review the user ID in any directory domain accessible from the server youre using.

To change a user ID in Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select an account, click the globe icon above the accounts list, choose the directory domain where the users account resides, and then select the user.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 In the Basic pane, specify a value in the User ID field.

68 Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts

Make sure the value is unique for all directory domains set in the search policy of computers that the user logs in to. Workgroup Manager warns you if you change the value to another user ID in the same directory domain. You can quickly find all existing user IDs by choosing View > Show System Users and Groups, and then clicking the UID column header in the accounts list to sort the accounts by user ID.

Assigning a Password to a User When you create a user account, you must assign a password to the user. You can reset the users password by replacing the password field with a new password.

For information about choosing secure passwords, see Mac OS X Security Configuration.

When you export user accounts using Workgroup Manager, password information isnt exported. If you want to set passwords, you can modify the export file before you import it, or you can set passwords after importing. You can also manually create a text-delimited import file and include passwords in it.

For more information about importing user accounts, see Understanding What You Can Import and Export on page 251.

To assign a password: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select an account, click the globe icon above the accounts list, choose the directory domain where the users account resides, and then select the user.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 In the Basic pane, enter a password in the Password field, enter it again in the Verify field, and then click Save.

Assigning Administrator Privileges for a Server A user who has server administrator privileges controls most of the servers configuration settings and can use applications (such as Server Admin) that require a user to be a member of the servers administrator group.

You can use Workgroup Manager to assign server administrator privileges to a user with an account stored in an Open Directory domain. You can also use Workgroup Manager to review the server administrator privileges in any directory domain accessible from the server youre using.

To set server administrator privileges in Workgroup Manager: 1 Log in to Workgroup Manager by specifying the name or IP address of the server you

want to grant administrator privileges for.

2 Click Accounts.

Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts 69

3 Click the globe icon and choose Local.

4 Click the lock and enter the name and password of a local administrator.

5 Click the globe icon and choose the directory domain where the users account resides.

6 Click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

7 To grant server administrator privileges, in the Basic pane, select User can administer this server.

From the Command Line You can also set server administrator privileges using the dscl command in Terminal. For more information, see the users and groups chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Choosing a Users Login Picture You can change a users login picture using Workgroup Manager. This picture represents the user in the login window, in the Directory application, and in group web services, and is the default buddy icon for the user in iChat.

Although you can use an image file of any size, you should use an image that is 64 x 64 pixels in size. If you use a larger image, resize and crop it in Workgroup Manager.

To change a users login picture: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select an account, click the globe icon above the accounts list, choose the directory domain where the users account resides, and then select the user.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 In the Basic pane, click the picture area in the top right and then choose Edit Picture to open the User Picture window.

5 In the User Picture window, click Choose, select an image file, and then click Open.

As an alternative, you can drag an image file from the Finder or Safari and drop it into the picture area in Workgroup Manager, or in the main area of the User Picture window.

If you have iSight, you can click the camera button to take a snapshot.

6 Use the slider to zoom in and out of your picture and drag your picture around so the focal point is in the center square, and then click Set.

The users picture is the image in the center square.

7 Click Save.

70 Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts

Working with Privileges You can give a user account full or limited control over domain administration. When giving limited administrative control, you can choose which users and groups the user can administer, and what kind of control the user has over those users and groups.

You can change a users domain privileges for Open Directory domains. You cant change privileges for a local user account or an account stored in domains that are not Open Directory.

Full and limited administrators use Workgroup Manager to administer and manage users.

In Workgroup Manager, use the user accounts Privileges pane to set privileges.

Removing Administrative Privileges from a User Users with no administrative privileges can use Workgroup Manager to view (but not change) accounts in a directory domain.

You can change a users domain privileges for LDAPv3 directory domains. You cant change privileges for a local user account or an account stored in a non-LDAPv3 directory domain.

To remove a users administrative privileges: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select an account, click the globe icon above the accounts list, choose the directory domain where the users account resides, and then select the user.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 In Privileges, choose None from the Administration capabilities pop-up menu and click Save.

Giving a User Limited Administrative Capabilities You can allow users who dont need full administrative control the ability to perform common administrative tasks by giving them limited administrative control.

For example, you might want student lab assistants to reset other students passwords but not to edit the groups they belong to. Similarly, you might want school staff to edit student user information but not their managed preferences.

When a user has limited administrative control, after authenticating in Workgroup Manager, the Workgroup Manager interface only allows users to perform tasks assigned to the limited administrator.

Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts 71

The following tasks are available to limited administrators:

If you give a user different administrative capabilities at several account levels, the capabilities are merged.

For example, lets say a user named Anne Johnson is a member of the Algebra 101 group, and the Algebra 101 group is a member of the All Classes group. You give another user, Ravi Patel, the following administrative control: Manage user passwords rights for All Users and Groups Edit managed preferences rights for the All Classes group Edit user information rights for the Algebra 101 group Edit group membership rights for the Anne Johnson user account

Ravi Patel has all four abilities for Anne Johnsons user account.

You can change a users domain privileges for LDAPv3 directory domains. You cant change privileges for a local user account or an account stored in a non-LDAPv3 directory domain.

To add limited administrative capabilities: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select an account, click the globe icon above the accounts list, choose the directory domain where the users account resides, and then select the user.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 In Privileges, choose Limited from the Administration capabilities pop-up menu.

5 To control the level of user or group administration, click the Add (+) button and drag users and groups from the drawer to the User can administer list.

6 Select a user or group from the User can administer list and then select the administration capabilities you want the limited administrator to have.

To give administrative control to all users and groups, select All Users and Groups and then select administrative capabilities.

7 Click Save.

Task Description

Manage user passwords Change a users password in the user accounts Basic pane. A limited administrator cant change a full administrators password.

Edit managed preferences Change managed preference settings.

Edit user information Edit the user accounts Info pane.

Edit group membership Edit the user accounts Groups pane or the group accounts Members pane.

72 Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts

Giving a User Full Administrative Capabilities A user with full administrative capabilities is also known as a directory domain administrator. Directory domain administrators can modify any records in the directory domain and are the only users who can change the passwords of other directory domain administrators.

You can change a users domain privileges for LDAPv3 directory domains. You cant change privileges for a local user account or an account stored in a non-LDAPv3 directory domain.

To change a users administrative privileges: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select an account, click the globe icon above the accounts list, choose the directory domain where the users account resides, and then select the user.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 In Privileges, from the Administration capabilities pop-up menu, choose Full, and then click Save.

Working with Advanced Settings Advanced settings include login settings, keywords, password type, and searchable comments. In Workgroup Manager, use the user accounts Advanced pane to work with advanced settings.

Enabling a Users Calendar If your iCal server enables individual user calendars, you can configure user accounts to use iCal server. When users use iCal to log into the server, they can access their calendars.

To enable a users calendar: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select an account, click the globe icon above the accounts list, choose the directory domain where the users account resides, and then select the user.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 In Advanced, select Enable calendaring, choose a server from the pop-up menu, and then click Save.

Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts 73

Allowing a User to Log In to More Than One Computer At a Time You can allow a managed user to log in to more than one managed computer at a time, or you can prevent the user from doing so.

Note: Simultaneous login is not recommended for most users. You may want to reserve simultaneous login privileges for technical staff, teachers, or other users with administrator privileges. (If a user has a network home folder, thats where the users application preferences and documents are stored. Simultaneous login can change these items, and many applications dont support such changes while the applications are open.)

You can only disable simultaneous login for users with AFP home folders.

To allow a user to log in to more than one computer at a time: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Advanced.

5 Select Allow simultaneous login on managed computers.

Choosing a Default Shell You can change the default shell that the user uses for command-line interactions with Mac OS X, such as /bin/tcsh or /bin/bash (the default).

The default shell is used by the Terminal application on the computer that the user is logged in to, but Terminal has a preference that lets you override the default shell. The default shell is used by secure shell (SSH) when the user logs in to a remote Mac OS X computer.

Note: Terminal has a preference that allows the user to override the default shell.

To choose a default shell: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

74 Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts

4 To specify the users default shell when logging in to a Mac OS X computer, choose a shell from the Login Shell pop-up menu.

To specify a shell that doesnt appear in the list, choose Custom and then enter the path to the shell.

To ensure that a user cant access the server remotely using the command line, choose None.

Choosing a Password Type and Setting Password Options For user accounts in the LDAP directory of an Open Directory server, you can set the password type to Open Directory or Crypt Password. User accounts in the local directory domain have a password type of Shadow Password.

When you set the password type to Shadow Password or Open Directory, you can set several password policy options, including disabling login after a period of inactivity or failed authentication attempts, or setting password restrictions (such as requiring that passwords be a certain length or that they be changed at the next login).

If you set the password type to Shadow Password, you can also set security options to control which authentication methods are used when validating the users password.

You can only assign the Open Directory password type if the directory administrator account that you authenticate with also uses an Open Directory password.

Windows users must have Open Directory passwords for Windows domain login.

For a detailed explanation of password types, password policy options, and security options, see Open Directory Administration.

To choose a user password type and set password options: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Advanced.

5 From the User Password Type pop-up menu, choose Shadow Password, Open Directory, or Crypt Password.

When you choose a password type, a prompt might appear requiring you to enter a password, depending on whether you entered a password in the Basic pane.

If you choose Open Directory or Shadow Password, you can set a password policy for the selected users by clicking Options, selecting any of the options, and clicking OK.

Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts 75

If you choose Shadow Password, you can also select authentication methods by clicking Security.

6 Click Save.

Creating a Master List of Keywords You can define keywords that enable quick searching and sorting of user accounts. Using keywords can simplify tasks such as creating groups or editing multiple user accounts.

Before you begin adding keywords to user records, you must create a master keyword list. The list of keywords shown in the Advanced pane for a selected user applies only to that user.

Each directory domain has its own master keyword list. For example, if you add a keyword to the local directory domains master keyword list, it isnt available in another directory domain unless you add it to that directory domains master keyword list.

To edit the master keyword list: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Advanced and choose from the following:

5 When you finish editing the master list, click OK.

Applying Keywords to User Accounts You can remove a keyword from all user accounts that are tagged with that keyword. However, you can only add keywords to one user account at a time.

To do this Do this

View the master keyword list, which lists all terms available for use as keywords

Click the Edit (pencil) button. You can access and edit the master keyword list from any selected user account.

Add a keyword to the master list Click the Add (+) button and enter the keyword in the text field.

Remove a keyword from the master list and from all user and computer accounts where it appears

Select the keyword, select Remove deleted keywords from users and computers, and then click the Remove () button.

Remove a keyword only from the master list

Deselect Remove deleted keywords from users and computers, select the keyword you want to remove, and then click the Remove () button.

76 Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts

To work with keywords for a user account: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Advanced and choose from the following:

5 When you finish adding or removing keywords for the selected user account, click Save.

Editing Comments You can save a comment in a users account to provide information you might need to help administer a user. A comment can contain no more than 32,767 bytes.

Note: Some character sets use characters that occupy up to 4 bytes. This reduces the total number of characters you can use.

You can use Workgroup Manager to add a comment to an account stored in an Open Directory domain, the local directory domain, or other read/write directory domain. You can also use Workgroup Manager to review the comment in any directory domain accessible from the server youre using.

To work with a comment using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Advanced and edit or review the contents of the Comment field.

To do this Do this

Add a keyword to the selected account

Click the Add (+) button to view the list of available keywords, select one or more keywords in the list, and then click OK.

Remove a keyword from a specific user account

Select the keyword you want to remove and click the Remove () button.

Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts 77

Working with Group Settings Group settings identify the groups a user belongs to. In Workgroup Manager, use the Group Settings pane in the users account to work with group settings.

For information about how to administer group accounts, see Chapter 5, Setting Up Group Accounts.

Choosing a Users Primary Group A primary group is the fastest way to determine whether a user has group permissions for a file. The primary group ID is used by the file system when the user accesses a file that he or she doesnt own. The file system checks the files group permissions, and if the primary group ID of the user matches the ID of the group associated with the file, the user inherits group access permissions.

Important: Dont rely on primary group membership when assigning file permissions. Although you can make a primary group a hierarchical group or a parent of hierarchical groups, the file permissions for the primary group do not propagate. If a users primary group is a hierarchical group or the parent of a hierarchical group, the user is granted file permissions only for the primary group.

If the user does not belong to other groups, the user belongs to the primary group. If a user selects a different workgroup at login, the user still retains access permissions from the primary group.

The primary group ID should be a unique string of digits. By default, the primary group ID is 20 (which identifies the group as staff), but you can change it. The maximum value for a group ID is 2,147,483,647.

Use Workgroup Manager to define the primary group ID of an account stored in an Open Directory domain, the local directory domain, or other read/write directory domain. You can also use Workgroup Manager to review the primary group information for any directory domain accessible from the server youre using.

To set a primary group ID using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Groups and then edit or review the Primary Group ID field.

78 Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts

Workgroup Manager displays long and short names for the group after you enter a primary group ID (if the group exists and is accessible in the search policy of the server youre logged in to).

Reviewing a Users Group Memberships You can use Workgroup Manager to review the groups a user belongs to if the user account resides in a directory domain accessible from the server youre using.

You can view all groups the user belongs to and the parent groups of those groups.

To review group memberships using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Groups.

Except for the primary group, all other groups the user belongs to are listed in the Other Groups list.

5 To view parent groups, click Show Inherited Groups.

Parent groups are shown in italics.

Adding a User to a Group Add a user to a group when you want multiple users to have the same file permissions, or when you want to manage their Mac OS X preferences using workgroups or computer groups.

For example, you can have groups for students in a classroom who are not permitted to use a particular printer, or for the quality control team in a factory that requires access to the internal reports of different groups.

Groups can include users and groups that are in an Open Directory domain or the local directory domain. If you use an NFS directory, there is a 16-group limitation.

You can also add users to a group using the Members pane in the group account.

If a user is a direct member of multiple groups, he or she can choose which group to acquire managed preferences from when logging in. You can manage Login preferences so that preferences are combined from all workgroups accessible by the user.

Note: There is no limit to the number of groups a user can belong to.

Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts 79

To add a user to a group using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Groups and then click the Add (+) button.

This opens a drawer that lists the groups defined in the directory domain youre working with.

5 Select the group and then drag it to the Other Groups list in the Groups pane.

Removing a User from a Group You can use Workgroup Manager to remove a user from a group if the user and group accounts reside in an Open Directory domain or the local directory domain.

To remove a user from a group using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Groups.

5 Select the groups you want to remove the user from and then click the Remove () button.

You can also remove users from a group by using the Members pane of group accounts. For more information, see Removing Group Members on page 100.

Working with Home Settings Home settings describe a users home folder attributes. If you dont have a share point set up to host home folders, you must set one up. To set up share points, use Server Admin. To set up home folders, use Workgroup Manager.

For information about setting up share points and home folders, see Chapter 7, Setting Up Home Folders.

80 Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts

Working with Mail Settings You can create a mail account by specifying mail settings in the user account. To use the mail service account, the user configures a mail client to identify the user name, password, mail service, and mail protocol you specify in the mail settings.

In Workgroup Manager, use the Mail pane in the user account to work with mail settings.

For information about how to set up and manage Mac OS X Server mail service, see Mail Service Administration.

Enabling Mail Service Account Options You can use Workgroup Manager to enable mail service and set mail options for a user account stored in an Open Directory domain or other read/write directory domain. You can also use Workgroup Manager to review the mail settings of accounts stored in a directory domain accessible from the server youre using.

To work with a users mail account options using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Mail.

5 To allow the user to use mail service, select Enabled.

6 In the Mail Server fields, enter a valid mail server name or address for the DNS name, or enter the IP address of the server the users mail should be routed to.

Workgroup Manager doesnt verify this information.

7 In the Mail Quota field, enter a value to specify the maximum number of megabytes for the users mailbox.

A 0 (zero) or empty value means no quota is used.

When the users message space approaches or surpasses the mail quota you specify, mail service displays a message prompting the user to delete unwanted messages to free up space. The message shows quota information in megabytes (MB).

8 To identify the protocol used for the users mail account, select a Mail Access setting: Post Office Protocol (POP), Internet Message Access Protocol (IMAP), or both.

9 Click Save.

Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts 81

Disabling a Users Mail Service You can use Workgroup Manager to disable mail service for users whose accounts are stored in an Open Directory domain, the local directory domain, or other read/write directory domain.

To disable a users mail service using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Mail, select None, and then click Save.

Forwarding a Users Mail You can use Workgroup Manager to set up mail-forwarding for users whose accounts are stored in an Open Directory domain or the local directory domain.

To forward a users mail using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Mail, select Forward, and then enter the forwarding mail address in the Forward To field.

Make sure you enter the correct address. Workgroup Manager doesnt verify that the address exists.

5 Click Save.

Working with Print Quota Settings User print settings define the ability of a user to print to accessible Mac OS X Server print queues.

For information about how to set up print queues, see Print Service Administration.

82 Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts

In Workgroup Manager, use the Print Quota pane in the user account to work with print quota settings.

Enabling a Users Access to All Available Print Queues You can use Workgroup Manager to allow a user to print to all or some of the accessible Mac OS X print queues that enforce quotas. To use Workgroup Manager to enable access to print queues, the users account must be stored in an Open Directory domain or the local directory domain.

To set a users print quota for all available print queues enforcing quotas: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 In Print Quota, select All Queues.

5 Enter values for the maximum number of pages the user can print in a specific number of days.

For the settings to take effect, the print service queue must enforce quotas.

6 Click Save.

Enabling a Users Access to Specific Print Queues You can use Workgroup Manager to allow a user to print to all or some of the accessible Mac OS X print queues that enforce quotas. To use Workgroup Manager to enable access to print queues, the users account must be stored in an Open Directory domain or the local directory domain.

To set a users print quota for specific print queues enforcing quotas: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 In Print Quota, select Per Queue.

5 If the print queue you want to specify is not on the Queue Name pop-up menu, click Add, enter the queue name, and then specify the IP address or DNS name of the server where the queue is defined in the Print Server field.

For your settings to take effect, the print service queue must enforce quotas.

Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts 83

6 To give the user unlimited printing rights to the queue, select Unlimited printing; otherwise, select Limit to and specify the maximum number of pages the user can print in a specific number of days.

7 Click Save.

Removing a Print Quota For a Queue If you no longer require a print quota for a queue, you can use Workgroup Manager to delete the quota for specific users.

To delete specific print quotas, you must manage print settings per queue.

To delete a users print quota using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user in the list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Print Quota and then select Per Queue.

5 Choose the users print queue that you want to delete from the Queue Name pop-up menu.

6 Click Delete and then click Save.

Resetting a Users Print Quota Occasionally, a user exceeds his or her print quota and needs to print additional pages. For example, an administrator might want to print a 200-page manual, but the print quota is only 150 pages. Or a student may exceed his or her quota by printing several revisions of the same essay.

You can use Workgroup Manager to reset a users print quota and allow the user to continue printing.

You can also extend a users page limit without resetting the quota time period by changing the number of pages allowed for the user. In this way, the time period for the quota remains the same and is not reset, but the number of pages the user can print during that period is adjusted for both the current and future print quota periods.

To restart a users print quota using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

84 Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Print Quota.

5 If youre managing All Queues, click Restart Print Quota.

6 If youre managing Per Queue, choose a print queue from the Queue Name pop-up menu and then click Restart Print Quota.

7 To increase or decrease a users page limit, enter a new number in the Limit to ___ pages field.

8 Click Save.

Disabling a Users Access to Print Queues That Enforce Quotas You can use Workgroup Manager to prevent a user from printing to any accessible Mac OS X print queues that enforce quotas.

To use Workgroup Manager to disable access to print queues, the users account must be stored in an Open Directory domain or the local directory domain.

To disable a users access to print queues enforcing quotas: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Print Quota and then select None.

Working with Info Settings If a users account resides in an LDAPv3 directory domain, it can contain information imported from Address Book.

Attributes that are tracked in the Info pane include: Name Address Phone number Email address Chat names Homepage URL Weblog URL

Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts 85

Other users can view the information in this pane when they view the user account in Workgroup Manager and Directory.

To change a users info: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Info, enter or change values, and when you finish, click Save.

Working with Windows Settings Windows users have settings for a Windows home folder, a roaming user profile, and a Windows login script. You can change these settings in the Windows pane of Workgroup Manager.

You can change user account settings in the Mac OS X Server PDC LDAP directory but not in a BDC read-only LDAP directory. If you have a BDC, the PDC server replicates changes to the BDC.

Changing a Windows Users Profile Location You can change where a Windows users profile settings are stored. The profile includes the users My Documents folder, favorites (web browser bookmarks), preference settings (such as backgrounds and event sounds), and more.

User profiles are stored in /Users/Profiles/ on the PDC server. This is an SMB share point, although it is not shown as a share point in Workgroup Manager.

You can designate a different location for a user profile, which can be a share point on the PDC server or a Windows domain member server. The share point must be configured to use SMB.

User profiles can be located in a share point or in a folder in a share point. The share point or folder used for user profiles must have the proper access privileges.

Set the owner to root and give the owner Read & Write permission. Set the group to the users primary group (which is normally staff) and give the group Read & Write permission. Set the permission for everyone else to None.

For instructions, see Setting Up an SMB Share Point on page 119.

Instead of storing a roaming profile in a share point on a server, you can designate the location of a local profile stored on the Windows computer.

86 Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts

To change the Windows roaming profile location for a user account: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Open the user account whose profile location you want to change.

To open a user account in the PDC, click the globe icon and choose the PDC servers LDAP directory.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Windows and enter the new profile location in the User Profile Path field.

To use the default share point for user profiles, leave this field blank. For a roaming profile stored in a different share point, enter the location of the share

point using the universal naming convention (UNC) format: \\servername\sharename\usershortname

For servername, substitute the NetBIOS name of the PDC server or a Windows domain member server where the share point is located.

To view the servers NetBIOS name, open Server Admin, select SMB in the Servers list, click Settings, click General, and then look at the Computer Name field.

For sharename, substitute the name of the share point.

For usershortname, substitute the first short name of the user account youre configuring.

For a local profile stored on the Windows computer, enter the drive letter and folder path in UNC format as in the following example: C:\Documents and Settings\juan

5 Click Save.

Changing a Windows Users Login Script Location You can use Workgroup Manager to change the folder location of a users Windows login script in the /etc/netlogon/ folder on the PDC server.

To change the Windows login script location for a user account: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Open the user account whose Windows login script location you want to change.

To open a user account in the PDC, click the globe icon and choose the PDC servers LDAP directory.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Windows and enter the new login script location in the Login Script field.

Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts 87

Enter the relative path to a login script in /etc/netlogon/ on the PDC server. For example, if an administrator places a script named setup.bat in /etc/netlogon/, the Login Script field should contain setup.bat.

5 Click Save.

Changing a Windows Users Home Folder Drive Letter You can use Workgroup Manager to change the Windows drive letter that a users home folder is mapped to.

To change the Windows home folder drive letter for a user account: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Open the user account whose Windows home folder drive letter you want to change.

To open a user account in the PDC, click the globe icon and choose the PDC servers LDAP directory.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Windows and choose a drive letter from the Hard Drive pop-up menu.

The default drive letter is H. Windows uses the drive letter to identify the mounted home folder.

5 Click Save.

Changing a Windows Users Home Folder Location You can change where a Windows users network home folder is stored. By default, the network home folder is the same for Windows as it is for Mac OS X, and its location is specified in the Home pane.

For more information, see Setting Up a Home Folder for a Windows User on page 127.

Working with GUIDs Although you can view and modify most user account attributes using the Accounts pane in Workgroup Manager, you must use the Inspector to view and modify GUIDs.

Viewing GUIDs GUIDs are stored in the directory domain and are not immediately visible in Workgroup Manager. To view GUIDs, you must first enable the Inspector in Workgroup Manager. For instructions on using the Inspector, see Open Directory Administration.

WARNING: Although the Inspector allows you to edit GUIDs, it is not recommended. Doing so destroys existing group memberships and file permissions for that user ID.

88 Chapter 4 Setting Up User Accounts

To view a user or group GUID: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Make sure the directory services of the Mac OS X Server computer youre using are configured to access the directory domain.

3 Click the globe icon and then choose the domain where the account resides.

4 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

5 Click the Users, Groups, Computers, or Computer Groups button and select the account.

You can only view GUIDs for individual accounts.

6 Click the Inspector button under the lock on the far right.

If there is no Inspector button, make sure the Inspector is enabled by choosing Workgroup Manager > Preferences, and then select Show All Records tab and inspector.

7 Select the GeneratedUID field and then click Edit.

8 Click Cancel to make sure you do not change the GUID.

From the Command Line You can also view a user or group GUID using the dscl command in Terminal. For more information, see the users and groups chapter of Command-Line Administration.

5

89

5 Setting Up Group Accounts

This chapter tells you how to set up, edit, and manage group accounts.

A group account offers a simple way to manage a collection of users with similar needs. You can also create group folders, which provide an easy way for group members to share files with each other.

You can use Workgroup Manager to view, create, edit, and delete group accounts.

To view group accounts in Workgroup Manager, click the Groups button above the accounts list.

About Group Accounts A group account stores the identities of users who belong to the group, as well as information that lets you customize the working environment for members of the group. When you define preferences for a group, the group is known as a workgroup.

A primary group is the users default group. Primary groups can expedite the validation performed by the Mac OS X file system when a user accesses a file.

How Group Accounts Track Membership Mac OS X Server uses GUIDs and a combination of the users short name and GID to determine group membership. Before Mac OS X v10.4, group membership was based only on a combination of the users short name and GID.

You can now have groups composed of users with all versions of Mac OS X. When you use Workgroup Manager on Mac OS X Server v10.5 to add a member to a group, you add both the users short name and GUID, which ensures backward compatibility.

90 Chapter 5 Setting Up Group Accounts

Where Group Accounts Are Stored Group accounts can be stored in any Open Directory domain. A directory domain can reside on a Mac OS X computer (for example, an Open Directory domain) or it can reside on a non-Apple server (for example, an LDAP or Active Directory server). Workgroup Manager can work with accounts stored in any of these directory domains.

Group accounts must be stored in a directory domain accessible from the server that needs them:

For services provided by a Mac OS X Server PDC or Windows domain member server, group accounts can be stored in the PDC LDAP directory.

For services provided by an Active Directory domain member, group accounts can be stored in the Active Directory domain.

For services provided by a Windows standalone server, group accounts can be stored in the servers local directory domain.

If a server is configured to access multiple directory domains, group accounts can be stored in any of them.

For more information about the different kinds of Open Directory domains, see Open Directory Administration.

Predefined Group Accounts The following table describes most group accounts that are created when you install Mac OS X Server. For a complete list, open Workgroup Manager and choose View > Show System Users and Groups.

Predefined group name Group ID Use

admin 80 A group that users with administrator privileges belong to.

bin 7 A group that owns all binary files.

daemon 1 A group used by system services.

dialer 68 A group for controlling access to modems on a server.

kmem 2 A legacy group used to control access to reading kernel memory.

mail 6 A group historically used for access to local UNIX mail.

_mysql 74 A group that the MySQL database server uses for its processes that handle requests.

network 69 A group that has no specific meaning.

nobody -2 A group used by system services.

nogroup -1 A group used by system services.

operator 5 A group that has no specific meaning.

smmsp 25 A group used by sendmail.

sshd 75 A group used for the sshd child processes that process network data.

Chapter 5 Setting Up Group Accounts 91

Administering Group Accounts Workgroup Manager lets you administer group accounts stored in multiple directory domains.

Creating Group Accounts To create a group account in a directory domain, you must have domain administrator privileges.

You can also create group accounts on a non-Apple LDAPv3 server if the server is configured for write access.

To create a group account: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Make sure the directory services of the Mac OS X Server computer youre using are configured to access the directory domain.

For information about using Directory Utility to configure an LDAP connection, see Open Directory Administration. For information about the group account elements that may need to be mapped, see the appendix, Importing and Exporting Account Information.

3 Click the globe icon and choose the domain where you want the group account to reside.

4 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

5 Click the Groups button.

6 Click New Group and then specify settings for the group in the panes provided.

staff 20 A default group that UNIX users are traditionally placed.

sys 3 A group that has no specific meaning.

tty 4 A group that owns special files such as the device file associated with an SSH or telnet user.

_unknown 99 A group used when the system doesnt know about the hard drive.

utmp 45 A group that controls who can update the systems list of logged-in users.

_uucp 66 A group used to control access to UUCP spool files.

wheel 0 A group (in addition to the admin group) that users with administrator privileges belong to. Membership is required for using the su command.

_www 70 A nonprivileged group that Apache uses for its processes that handle requests.

Predefined group name Group ID Use

92 Chapter 5 Setting Up Group Accounts

You can also use a preset or an import file to create a group. For details, see Creating a Preset for Group Accounts, and the appendix, Importing and Exporting Account Information.

From the Command Line You can also create a group account using the dseditgroup command in Terminal. For more information, see the users and groups chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Creating a Preset for Group Accounts You can use presets to apply predetermined settings to a new group account.

Presets are stored in the directory domain that youre viewing. If you change directory domains, the presets you created in the other directory domain are not available.

For instructions on renaming, editing, or deleting group presets, see Renaming Presets on page 62, Editing Presets on page 62, and Deleting a Preset on page 63.

To create a preset for group accounts: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Make sure the server is configured to access the Mac OS X directory domain or non- Apple LDAPv3 domain where the preset is used to create accounts.

3 To create a preset using data in an existing group account, open the account; to create a preset from scratch, create a group account.

4 Fill in the fields with values you want new groups to inherit and delete values you dont want to specify in advance.

5 Click Preferences, configure settings that you want the preset to define, and then click Accounts.

After configuring preference settings for a preset, you must return to the Accounts settings to save the preset.

6 From the Presets pop-up menu, choose Save Preset, enter a name for the preset, and then click OK.

Editing Group Account Information You can use Workgroup Manager to change a group account that resides in an Open Directory domain, the local directory domain, or other read/write directory domain.

To make changes to a group account: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Make sure the directory services of the Mac OS X Server computer youre using are configured to access the directory domain.

For instructions, see Open Directory Administration.

3 Click the globe icon and choose the domain where the group account resides.

Chapter 5 Setting Up Group Accounts 93

4 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

5 Click the Groups button and select the group you want to work with.

6 Edit settings for the group in the panes provided.

For details, see Working with Basic Settings for Groups on page 95, Working with Member Settings for Groups on page 99, and Working with Group Folder Settings on page 100.

From the Command Line You can also edit a group account using the dseditgroup command in Terminal. For more information, see the users and groups chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Creating Hierarchical Groups A hierarchical group is a group that is a member of another group, known as a parent group.

For computers with Mac OS X v10.5 or later, hierarchical groups inherit managed preferences. Members of a hierarchical group have combined preferences managed by their chosen workgroup and by parent groups. They can also inherit preferences from parent groups.

For computers with Mac OS X v10.4 or later, the access permissions of a parent group are inherited. For example, if you set a parent groups ACL permissions so the parent group cant write to a folder, the ACL permissions are propogated so that hierarchical groups also cant write to that folder.

Groups created using Mac OS X Server v10.3 and v10.4 must be upgraded to become parent or child hierarchical groups and use hierarchical preference management. If you dont upgrade groups created using Mac OS X Server v10.3, you cant use hierarchical groups. If you dont upgrade groups created using Mac OS X Server v10.4, you cant use hierarchical preference management with those groups. For more information, see Upgrading Legacy Groups on page 94.

To create a hierarchical group: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Make sure that the directory services of the Mac OS X Server computer youre using are configured to access the desired directory domain.

For instructions, see Open Directory Administration.

3 Click the globe icon and choose the domain where you want the hierarchical group to reside.

4 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

94 Chapter 5 Setting Up Group Accounts

5 To create a group, click the Groups button.

6 In the Members pane, click the Add (+) button to open a drawer that lists the users and groups defined in the directory domain youre working with.

Make sure the group account resides in a directory domain specified in the search policy of computers the user logs in to.

The drawer lists user and group accounts. Click the Groups button in the drawer to list group accounts.

7 Drag the group from the drawer to the Members list.

All members of the hierarchical group also become members of the parent group.

8 Click Save.

From the Command Line You can also create a hierarchical group account using the dseditgroup command in Terminal. For more information, see the users and groups chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Upgrading Legacy Groups When you upgrade from Mac OS X Server v10.3 or earlier, or when you import groups created using Workgroup Manager v10.3 or earlier, existing groups cant use hierarchical preference management unless you first convert them.

Upgrading legacy groups does not negatively affect group members with client computers running previous versions of Mac OS X.

To convert a legacy group to an upgraded group account: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Make sure that the directory services of the Mac OS X Server computer youre using are configured to access the directory domain.

For instructions, see Open Directory Administration.

3 Click the globe icon and choose the domain where the group account resides.

4 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

5 Click the Groups button and select the legacy group you want to upgrade.

6 In the Members pane, click the Upgrade Legacy Group button and then click Save.

Working with Read-Only Groups You can use Workgroup Manager to review information for group accounts stored in read-only directory domains. Read-only directory domains include LDAPv2 domains, LDAPv3 domains not configured for write access, NIS domains, and BSD configuration files.

Chapter 5 Setting Up Group Accounts 95

To work with read-only groups: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Make sure that the directory services of the Mac OS X Server computer youre using are configured to access the directory domain where the account resides.

For information about using Directory Utility to configure server connections, see Open Directory Administration. For information about the group account elements that need to be mapped, see the appendix, Importing and Exporting Account Information.

3 Click the globe icon and then choose the directory domain where the group account resides.

4 Use the panes provided to review the group account settings.

Deleting a Group You can use Workgroup Manager to delete a group account stored in an Open Directory domain, the local directory domain, or other read/write directory domain.

To delete a group using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the group account you want to delete.

To select the account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, click the Groups button, and then select the group.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Choose Server > Delete Selected Group or click the Delete icon in the toolbar.

From the Command Line You can also delete a group account using the dseditgroup command in Terminal. For more information, see the users and groups chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Working with Basic Settings for Groups Basic settings for groups include name, ID, picture path, comments, and whether the group uses web services.

Naming a Group A group has two names: a long name and a short name. A long group name (for example, English Department Students) is used for display

purposes and contains no more than 255 bytes.

WARNING: You cannot undo this action.

96 Chapter 5 Setting Up Group Accounts

Because long group names support various character sets, the number of characters for long group names can range from 255 Roman characters to as few as 63 characters (for character sets in which characters occupy up to 4 bytes).

A short group name contains as many as 255 Roman characters. However, for clients using Mac OS X v10.1.5 or earlier, the short group name must be eight characters or less. Use only the following characters in a short group name: a through z A through Z 0 through 9 _ (underscore) The short name (typically eight or less characters) may be used by Mac OS X to find group members user IDs when determining whether a user can access a file as a result of his or her group membership.

For more information about group membership, see How Group Accounts Track Membership on page 89.

If a group has a mailing list enabled, the short name is also used in the groups mailing list address (shortname@hostname.com).

For more information about enabling a groups mailing list, see Enabling a Groups Web Services on page 98.

You can use Workgroup Manager to edit the long or short names of a group account stored in an Open Directory domain, the local directory domain, or other read/write directory domain. You can also use Workgroup Manager to review the names in any directory domain accessible from the server youre using.

To work with group names using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the group account you want to work with.

To select an account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, click the Groups button, and select the group.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Basic, then in the Name field (or the Short name field) review or edit the names and then click Save.

Before saving a new name, Workgroup Manager checks to ensure that the name is unique.

Defining a Group ID A group ID is a string of ASCII digits that uniquely identifies the group. The maximum value is 2,147,483,647.

Chapter 5 Setting Up Group Accounts 97

You can use Workgroup Manager to edit the ID for a group account stored in an Open Directory domain or the local domain, or to review the group ID in any directory domain accessible from the server youre using. The group ID is associated with group privileges and permissions.

To work with a group ID using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the group account you want to work with.

To select an account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, click the Groups button, and then select the group.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Basic, then in the Group ID field review or edit the ID and click Save.

Before saving a group ID, Workgroup Manager checks to ensure that it is unique in the directory domain youre using.

Choosing a Groups Login Picture You can quickly change a groups login picture in Workgroup Manager. This picture represents the group in the workgroup chooser of the login window.

Although you can use an image file of any size, you should use an image that is 64 x 64 pixels in size. If you use a larger image, it is centered and resized to 64 x 64.

Group pictures are stored as a path to an image file, not as the file itself. This path must be accessible by the computers used by the group. For example, if you enter a path to an image file on the desktop, the image file must be located on the desktop of all computers used by the group. To avoid copying image files to all computers, store image files on a server.

To choose a groups login picture: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the group account you want to work with.

To select an account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, click the Groups button, and select the group.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 In the Basic pane, drag a picture to the picture area in the top right.

When you drag a picture to the picture area, the Picture Path field is updated with the new location of the picture. You can also change the picture by editing this path.

5 Click Save.

98 Chapter 5 Setting Up Group Accounts

Enabling a Groups Web Services Mac OS X Server v10.5 includes Groups, a feature that allows groups to easily create a collaborative website. This website uses calendar, wiki, and blog technology to streamline group communication. You can also set up a mailing list so that mail sent to the list is sent to all group members and are archived on the group website.

You can only enable the web calendar and mailing list archive if you first enable the wiki and blog service.

You can choose who views or edits the website: Group members only includes all members of the group Some group members (only available for editing) includes group members who are

given editing privileges Authenticated users includes anyone who can authenticate with your organizations

directory Anyone allows everyone, without requiring authentication

You can provide different levels of website access to different subsets of users. For example, you can set up an intranet site where everyone in your organization can view the site (allow Entire directory to view services), but only group members can edit it (allow Group members to edit services).

When setting up levels of website access, the users who can edit the website are a subset of the users who can view it. For example, you cant let anyone edit the site and allow only group members to view it.

When you create a group, the URL of the group website and the mailing list email address is based on the short name of the group (shortname@hostname.com). If you change the groups name after creating it, the URL and mailing list email address do not change.

The administrator computers search policy must include the server that hosts web services.

To enable a groups web services: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the group account you want to work with.

To select an account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, click the Groups button, and select the group.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Choose a server from the Enable the following services for this group on pop-up menu.

Chapter 5 Setting Up Group Accounts 99

5 Select the services you want to enable.

You can only select services that are not disabled by your web server.

6 Choose who can view the group website by using the can view these services pop-up menu.

This option applies to viewing the wiki, blog, calendar, and mailing list archive.

7 Choose who can edit the group website by using the can write to these services pop- up menu.

This option applies to editing the wiki, blog, and calendar.

8 Click Save.

Working with Member Settings for Groups In Workgroup Manager, use the Members pane for a group to view, add, or remove group members.

When a user name in the Members list appears in italics, the group is the users primary group.

Adding Users or Groups to a Group When you want multiple users or groups to have the same file permissions, or when you want to apply the same management settings to all users or groups, add the users or groups to a group.

After assigning a user to a primary group, you dont need to add the user to that group. However, you must specifically add users to other groups.

You can use Workgroup Manager to add a user to a group if the user and group accounts are in an Open Directory domain or the local directory domain. Although some group information doesnt apply to Windows users, you can also add Windows users to groups you create.

Mac OS X Server v10.5 and later supports hierarchical groupsgroups composed of nested groups. By managing preferences for a parent group, child groups also receive these managed preferences. For more information, see Understanding Hierarchical Preference Management on page 159.

To add a user to a group using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the group account you want to work with.

To select an account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, click the Groups button, and then select the group.

100 Chapter 5 Setting Up Group Accounts

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 In the Members pane, click the Add (+) button to open a drawer that lists the users and groups defined in the directory domain youre working with.

Make sure the group account resides in a directory domain specified in the search policy of computers that the user logs in to.

5 Select the user account, drag the user into the list, and then click Save.

From the Command Line You can add a user to a group using the dseditgroup command in Terminal. For more information, see the users and groups chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Removing Group Members You can use Workgroup Manager to remove group members if the group account and its members reside in an Open Directory domain or the local directory domain.

You cant remove a users primary group.

To remove group members: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the group account you want to work with.

To select an account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, click the Groups button, and then select the group.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 In the Members pane, select the members you want to remove from the group, click the Remove () button, and then click Save.

From the Command Line You can also remove users from a group using the dseditgroup command in Terminal. For more information, see the users and groups chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Working with Group Folder Settings A group folder offers a way to organize and distribute documents and applications to group members, and gives group members a way to share files with each other.

Group folders are not directly linked to workgroup management, but access and workflow management can be improved by combining the use of group folders with managed preferences for workgroups.

Chapter 5 Setting Up Group Accounts 101

For example, to set a multimedia lab computer specifically for a movie-editing class, you could set Dock preferences for the movie-editing workgroup to display only iMovie and the group folder. Because the group folder is in the Dock, it provides an easily accessible location for students to store and retrieve files.

Group folders arent automatically mounted on Windows workstations when group members log in to the Windows domain. If the group folders share point is shared using SMB, a Windows user can go to My Network Places (or Network Neighborhood) and access the contents of the group folder.

Specifying No Group Folder You can use Workgroup Manager to change a group account with a group folder to one that has no group folder. By default, a new group has no group folder.

To specify no group folder: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the group account you want to work with.

To select an account, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the account resides, click the Groups button, and then select the group.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click the Groups button and select a group.

5 Click Group Folder; then in the list, select (None) and click Save.

Creating a Group Folder You can create a group folder for a group in any existing share point, or you can create the group folder in the /Groups folder (a predefined share point).

In Workgroup Manager, you can also create group folders that dont reside immediately below a share point. For example, you can organize group folders into several subfolders under a share point that you define. If Groups is the share point, you can place group folders for students in /Groups/StudentGroups and group folders for teachers in /Groups/TeacherGroups. The full path to a group folder for second-grade students might be /Groups/StudentGroups/SecondGrade.

Group folders are hosted on share points. For instructions about creating share points, see Setting Up a Share Point on page 116.

After setting up a group folder, you can automate a group members access to the group folder when the user logs in by: Setting up Dock preferences to make the group folder visible in the Dock.

For instructions, see Providing Easy Access to Group Folders on page 175.

102 Chapter 5 Setting Up Group Accounts

Setting up login preferences so that users can click Computer in the Finder to see the group folder share point and the group folders in it. For instructions, see Providing Easy Access to the Group Share Point on page 199.

When setting up these preferences, make sure the group is defined in a shared domain in the search policy of the group members computer. For instructions on setting a computers search policy, see Open Directory Administration.

If you dont automate group folder access, group members can access the group folder using the Connect to Server command in the Go menu in the Finder to navigate to the server where the group folder resides.

To set up a group folder in the /Groups folder or in another existing share point: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the group account you want to work with.

To select an account, connect to the server where the account resides, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the group account is stored, click the Groups button, and then select the group.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Group Folder.

5 To add a share point to the list, click the Add (+) button and enter the requested information.

In the URL field, enter the full URL to the share point where you want the group folder to reside.

For example, to identify an AFP share point named SchoolGroups on a server whose DNS name is myserver.example.com, enter afp://myserver.example.com/SchoolGroups.

If you are not using DNS, replace the DNS name of the server hosting the group folder with the servers IP address: afp://192.168.2.1/SchoolGroups.

In the Path field, enter the path from the share point to the group folder, including the group folder but excluding the share point. Do not put a slash at the beginning or at the end of the path.

For example, if the share point is SchoolGroups and the full path to the group folder is SchoolGroups/StudentGroups/SecondGrade, enter StudentGroups/SecondGrade in the Path field.

Note: Configuring a group folder share point with a network mount record does not cause the group folder to mount when a group member logs in. You can provide easy access to a group folder by managing Dock or login preferences for the group.

Chapter 5 Setting Up Group Accounts 103

6 In the Owner Name fields, enter the short name and long name of the user you want to assign as the owner of the group folder so the user can act as group folder administrator.

To choose an owner from a list of users in the current directory domain, click the Browse (...) button. Click the globe icon in the drawer to choose a different directory domain.

The group folder owner is given read/write access to the group folder.

7 Click Save.

8 To create the folder, use the ssh tool to connect to the server hosting the share point and then enter the CreateGroupFolder command in Terminal.

You must be the root user to use the command. For more information about ssh, enter man ssh in Terminal to view the man page. For more information about CreateGroupFolder, enter man CreateGroupFolder in Terminal to view the man page.

The group folder is named using the short name of the group it is associated with.

From the Command Line You can also create a group folder using the sudo /usr/bin/CreateGroupFolder command and assign it using the dseditgroup command in Terminal. For more information, see the users and groups chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Designating a Group Folder for Use by Multiple Groups To permit a group folder to be accessed by multiple groups, identify the folder for each group separately.

Usually, a single group has read/write permissions for a group folder. To allow multiple groups to access the same group folder, use Server Admin to add an ACE for every group to the group folders ACL.

For more information about using Server Admin to apply ACL permissions to folders, see File Services Administration.

To configure more than one group to use the same group folder: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the first group account that will use the folder.

To select an account, connect to the server where the account resides, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the group account is stored, click the Groups button, and then select the group.

3 Click Group Folder, select the folder you want the group to use, and then click Save.

4 In Server Admin, add an ACE entry that gives the group read/write permissions for the group folder.

5 Repeat this process for each group that you want to use the same group folder.

104 Chapter 5 Setting Up Group Accounts

6

105

6 Setting Up Computers and Computer Groups

This chapter tells you how to set up and manage individual computers and groups of computers.

To manage an individual computer, you must create a computer account. To manage a group of computers, you must create a computer group composed of computer accounts or of other computer groups.

Use Workgroup Manager to view, create, edit, and delete computers and computer groups.

To view computers in Workgroup Manager, click the Computers button above the accounts list. To view computer groups in Workgroup Manager, click the Computer Groups button above the accounts list.

About Computer Accounts A computer account stores data that allows Mac OS X Server to identify and manage individual computers. To create computer groups, you must first create computer accounts for each individual computer.

Before setting up a computer, you need the computers name and address. You usually use the computer name specified in a computers Sharing preferences, or you can use a descriptive name that you find more suitable.

A computers address must be the Ethernet address, which is unique to each computer. (A computers Ethernet address, or Ethernet ID, is also known as its MAC address.) When you browse for a computer, Workgroup Manager enters the computers name and Ethernet address for you. A client computer uses this data to find preference information when a user logs in.

For Windows computers, you must know the NetBIOS name of each Windows client computer. This name is entered in the name field. You dont need to know the Ethernet address of Windows client computers.

106 Chapter 6 Setting Up Computers and Computer Groups

When a computer starts up, Mac OS X tries to match the computers Ethernet address with a computer account. If a matching computer account is found, the computer uses the managed preferences for that computer account and the computer groups it belongs to. If no matching computer account is found, the computer uses the managed preferences for the Guest Computer account.

Creating Computer Accounts To create a computer account in a directory domain, you must have administrator privileges and the computers Ethernet ID.

When you enter the Ethernet ID, it must be entered correctly so the DHCP server can find the computer. It must follow these rules: It must be entered using hexadecimal numbers. Hexadecimal numbers include digits

09 and letters af. Bytes must be separated by colons. Bytes are comprised of two hexadecimal

numbers. All bytes with a single hexadecimal number should have a leading zero. For example,

the following Ethernet ID is invalid because the single hexadecimal numbers do not have leading zeros: 7:8:9:a:b:c

However, the following Ethernet ID is valid because the hexadecimal numbers have leading zeros:

07:08:09:0a:0b:0c

The letters af must be entered in lower case.

To create a computer account: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Click the globe icon and choose the directory domain where you want to store the computer account.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click the Computers button.

5 Choose Server > New Computer (or click New Computer in the toolbar) and then enter long and short names for the computer.

6 Click General.

7 To add a comment, in the Comment field, enter a comment.

Comments and keywords make it easier to search for the computer.

8 To associate keywords with the computer, click the Add (+) button next to the keywords list.

Chapter 6 Setting Up Computers and Computer Groups 107

If keywords that you want to associate arent listed in the master keyword list, click Edit Keywords, click the Add (+) button, enter a name for the keyword, and click OK.

Select the keywords you want to associate with the computer and click OK.

9 Click Network, enter the Ethernet ID for the computer and its IP address (if the computer receives a static IP), and then click Save.

The Ethernet ID is required to identify the computer.

Working with Guest Computers If an unknown computer (one that doesnt have a computer account) connects to your network and attempts to access services, that computer is treated as a guest computer. Settings for the guest computer account apply to these unknown computers.

To apply specific management settings to a computer, dont use the guest computer account to manage it. Create a computer account for it.

Note: You cant change the name of a guest computer. Because the Guest Computer account is associated with all unknown computers, you cant enter network settings to identify the computer.

To set up the guest computer account: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Click the globe icon and choose the directory domain that contains the guest computer account.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click the Computers button (on the left).

5 Choose Server > Create Guest Computer.

6 Select the Guest Computer account.

7 Click General, enter a comment or add keywords, and then click Save.

Working with Windows Computers Every Windows computer that joins the Windows domain of a Mac OS X Server primary doman controller (PDC) must have a computer account, which identifies the Windows computer by its NetBIOS name.

The computer account for a Windows computer also contains information for authenticating the computer as a trusted workstation in the Windows domain. Mac OS X Server creates this information in the form of a UID and a GID.

You can add Windows computer accounts to computer groups, but Windows computers dont receive managed preferences.

108 Chapter 6 Setting Up Computers and Computer Groups

Important: Dont create computer accounts for Windows 2000 or Windows XP computers. If you do so, they may not be usable for domain login. Instead, use the Windows software on these computers to join them to the Windows domain. For information, see Open Directory Administration.

About Computer Groups A computer group comprises computers with the same preference settings. You can use Workgroup Manager create and modify computer groups.

To edit computer groups or computer group preferences, you must have domain administrator privileges. For instructions on assigning administrator privileges for a directory domain, see Giving a User Full Administrative Capabilities on page 72.

Differences Between Computer Groups and Computer Lists Computer groups are a new concept to Mac OS X Server v10.5. Before Mac OS X Server v10.5, computer lists were used to manage computers. Computer lists and computer groups function similarly. By managing a computer list or a computer group, you are managing all individual computers within them.

There are two major differences between computer groups and computer lists: Computer groups allow you to include other computer groups. You can then

manage hierarchical groups by managing the parent computer group. A computer can be a member of multiple computer groups. However, a computer

can only be a member of a single computer list.

Ideally, all members of a computer group are either computers running Mac OS X v10.5 or later, or other computer groups. Computer groups that include computers running Mac OS X v10.4 or earlier act like any other computer group of computers running Mac OS X v10.5 or laterthat is, computers can belong to multiple computer groups, and you can form hierarchical groups.

The computer group acts like a computer list for computers running earlier versions of Mac OS X. Computers can only belong to one list, and nesting the computer group has no effect on the computer.

Administering Computer Groups You can use Workgroup Manager to administer computer groups stored in various directory domains.

Creating a Computer Group When you create a computer group, keep in mind the following:

Chapter 6 Setting Up Computers and Computer Groups 109

A computer group is a group of computers that have the same preference settings and are available to the same users and groups.

You can add up to 2000 computers to a computer group.

You can create hierarchical groups to manage computers with Mac OS X v10.5 or later. Hierarchical groups inherit managed preferences. Computers in a hierarchical group have combined preferences managed by their computer group and by parent computer groups. They can also inherit preferences from parent computer groups.

To set up a computer group: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Click the globe icon and choose the directory domain where you want to store the computer group.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click the Computer Groups button (on the left).

5 To use a preset, choose one from the Presets pop-up menu.

6 Choose Server > New Computer Group (or click New Computer Group in the toolbar), and then enter a name for the computer group.

7 Click Basic.

8 Optionally, add a comment.

Comments are useful for providing information about a computers location, configuration (for example, a computer set up for individuals with special needs), or attached peripherals. You could also use the comment for identification information, such as the computers model or serial number.

9 Click Members, click the Add (+) button, and then drag computers or computer groups listed in the drawer to add them to the computer group.

You can also click the Browse (...) button, select a computer, and click Add.

10 Click Save.

After setting up a computer group, you can manage preferences for it. For more information about using managed preferences, see Customizing the User Experience on page 149, and Chapter 10, Managing Preferences.

Creating a Preset for Computer Groups You can select settings for a computer group and save them as a preset. Presets work like templates, allowing you to apply preselected settings and information to new computer groups.

110 Chapter 6 Setting Up Computers and Computer Groups

Using presets, you can easily set up multiple computer groups that use similar settings. However, you can only use presets when creating a computer group. You cant use a preset to change a computer group.

To set up a preset for computer groups: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Click the globe icon and choose the directory domain where you want to create a computer group using presets.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click the Computer Groups button (on the left).

5 Create a computer group by clicking New Computer Group or by selecting an existing computer group (on the left).

6 Fill in the information in the Basic and Members panes.

7 From the Presets pop-up menu, choose Save Preset.

After creating a preset, you can change its settings, change its name, or delete it:

Using a Computer Group Preset When you create a computer group, you can choose any preset from the Presets pop- up menu to apply initial settings. You can further modify computer group settings before you save the list.

When you save the computer group, you cant use the Preset menu again for that list (for example, you cant apply a different preset to the group).

To use a preset for computer groups: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Click the globe icon and choose the directory domain where you want to store the computer group.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

To do this Do this

Change the presets settings Create a computer group based on the preset and change the computer group settings. Save the preset using the same name as the old preset. When you change a preset, existing accounts that were created with it are not updated to reflect the changes.

Change the name of a preset Choose Rename Preset from the Presets pop-up menu, choose the preset, enter a new name, and then click OK.

Delete a preset Choose Delete Preset from the Presets pop-up menu, select the preset, and then click Delete.

Chapter 6 Setting Up Computers and Computer Groups 111

4 Click the Computer Groups button (on the left) and then click Basic.

5 From the Presets pop-up menu, choose a preset.

6 Choose Server > New Computer Group (or click New Computer Group in the toolbar).

7 Add or update settings as needed and then click Save.

Adding Computers or Computer Groups to a Computer Group You can easily add computers and computer groups to an existing computer group using Workgroup Manager.

Hierarchical computer groups are supported in Mac OS X Server v10.5 or later. If you add computer groups containing client computers running Mac OS X v10.4 or earlier, those clients dont receive managed preferences from parent computer groups.

To add computers or computer groups to a computer group: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the computer group.

To select the computer group, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain that contains the computer group, click the Computer Groups button, and then select the computer group.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Members, click the Add (+) button, and then drag computers or computer groups from the drawer to the list.

You can also click the Browse (...) button, select a computer, and then click Add.

Continue adding computers and computer groups until the list is complete.

5 Click Save.

Removing Computers and Computer Groups from a Computer Group If you remove a computer from a computer group, you can still manage it by managing its computer account or by adding it to another computer group.

To remove a computer or computer groups from a computer group: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the computer group the computer belongs to.

To select the computer group, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain that contains the computer group you want to modify, click the Computer Groups button, and then select the list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 In the Members pane, select one or more computers or computer groups.

112 Chapter 6 Setting Up Computers and Computer Groups

5 Click the Remove () button and then click Save.

Deleting a Computer Group If you no longer need a computer group, you can use Workgroup Manager to delete it.

To delete a computer group: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the computer group.

To select the computer group, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain that contains the computer group you want to delete, click the Computer Groups button, and then select the list.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Choose Server > Delete Selected Computer Group, or click Delete in the toolbar and then click Delete.

Upgrading Computer Lists to Computer Groups Computer lists are groups of computers created in Mac OS X Server v10.4 or earlier. Computer lists can only include computers, not other computer lists. Computer groups can include computers and hierarchical computer groups. You can hierarchically manage preferences for computer groups.

Computer groups can include computers running earlier versions of Mac OS X. These computers don't receive hierarchical preference management.

To upgrade computer lists to computer groups: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts, click the Computer Groups button, and then

select a computer list.

2 In the Basic pane, click Upgrade Computer List to Group.

WARNING: You cannot undo this action.

7

113

7 Setting Up Home Folders

This chapter provides guidelines for setting up and managing home folders.

Mac OS X uses the home foldera folder for a users personal useto store the users application preferences and personal files, like documents and music.

To set up share points that host home folders, you can use Server Admin. After setting up share points, you can then use Workgroup Manager to set up home folders on the share points.

About Home Folders You can set up Mac OS X home folders so they can be accessed by Apple Filing Protocol (AFP) or Network File System (NFS).

To set up a home folder for a user in Workgroup Manager, use the Home pane when viewing a users account.

You can also import user home folder settings from a file. For an explanation of how to work with import files, see the appendix, Importing and Exporting Account Information.

A users home folder doesnt need to be stored on the same server as the directory domain containing the users account. In fact, distributing directory domains and home folders across various servers can help balance the workload. For more information, see Distributing Home Folders Across Multiple Servers on page 115.

114 Chapter 7 Setting Up Home Folders

The home folder you designate in the Home pane can be used when logging in from a Windows workstation or a Mac OS X computer. This can be helpful for a user whose account resides on a server that is a Windows primary domain controller (PDC).

There are additional limitations on the maximum path length, depending on the version of Mac OS X used by clients. For more information, see the Apple Service & Support website article, Avoid spaces and long names in network home directory name, path, at docs.info.apple.com/article.html?artnum=107695.

Hosting Home Folders for Mac OS X Clients To host home folders for Mac OS X clients, use AFP or NFS. If you are hosting only Mac OS X clients, use AFP. If you are hosting Mac OS X and UNIX clients, use NFS.

The preferred protocol is AFP because it provides authentication-level access security. A user must log in with a valid name and password to access files.

NFS file access is based not on user authentication, but on the user ID and the client IP address, so it is generally less secure than AFP. Use NFS only if you need to provide home folders for a large number of users who use UNIX workstations.

Hosting Home Folders for Other Clients To host home folders for Windows clients, use SMB. To optimally handle both Mac OS X and Windows clients, you could use both AFP (for Mac OS X clients) and SMB (for Windows clients).

SMB is a protocol used by Windows to access share points. You can set up a share point for SMB access only, so that Windows users have a network location for files that cant be used on other platforms. Like AFP, SMB also requires authentication with a valid name and password to access files.

In addition to having home folders, Windows users also have roaming profiles. With roaming profiles, each user has the same profile when he or she logs in to the domain from any Windows workstation on the network.

A roaming profile stores a Windows users preference settings (screensaver, colors, backgrounds, event sounds, and so on), favorites, My Documents folder, and more, in a share point on a Mac OS X Server. By default, a users roaming profile is stored in a predetermined folder on the PDC, and backup domain controllers (BDCs) have an up- to-date copy of this folder.

WARNING: If the absolute path from the client to the network home folder on the server contains spaces or more than 89 characters, some types of clients wont connect. For example, a client using automount with an LDAP-based AFP home folder might not be able to access its home folder. The / character is considered a character.

Chapter 7 Setting Up Home Folders 115

The default share point for Windows home folders is the same as the share point for Mac OS X home folders. The default share point for user profiles is the /Users/Profiles/ folder on the PDC and BDC servers. (This SMB share point is not shown in Workgroup Manager.) You can set up alternate SMB share points for home folders and user profiles on the PDC server or on domain member servers.

Distributing Home Folders Across Multiple Servers The following illustration shows one Mac OS X Server computer storing user accounts, and two other Mac OS X Server computers storing AFP home folders.

When a user logs in, he or she is authenticated using an account stored in a shared directory domain on the accounts server. The location of the users home folder (stored in the account) is used to mount the home folder, which resides on one of the two home folder servers.

Here are the steps you could use to set up this scenario for AFP home folders:

Step 1: Create a shared domain for user accounts on the accounts server Create a shared LDAP directory domain by setting up an Open Directory master, as described in Open Directory Administration.

Step 2: Set up an automountable share point for home folders on each home folder server For information about how to set up automountable share points, see Setting Up an Automountable AFP Share Point for Home Folders on page 117.

Home folders A through M

Mac OS X Server

Home folders N through Z

User accounts

116 Chapter 7 Setting Up Home Folders

Step 3: Create the user accounts in the shared domain on the accounts server For information about specifying which share point is used for a users home folder, see Administering Home Folders on page 121.

Step 4: Set up the directory services of the client computers so their search policy includes the shared directory domain on the accounts server For information about configuring search policies, see Open Directory Administration.

When a user restarts his or her computer and logs in using the account in the shared domain, the home folder is created automatically (if it hasnt already been created) on the appropriate server, and is visible on the users computer.

Administering Share Points A share point is a hard disk (or hard disk partition), disc media, or folder that contains files you want users to share. You can use share points to host home folders.

Setting Up a Share Point You can use Server Admin to set up share points and then use the share points to host local home folders. Or you can mount the share point so it hosts network home folders.

To set up a share point: 1 Open Server Admin and connect to the server where you want to host the share point.

To connect to the server, choose Server > Connect, enter the server address in the Address field, and then authenticate as a server administrator.

If youre already connected, youll see Disconnect (instead of Connect) in the Server menu.

2 Select the server and click File Sharing.

3 Click Volumes, then display folders within volumes by clicking Browse.

4 Select the volume or folder that will become a share point.

To create a folder, select a parent folder or volume and click New Folder, enter the name of the folder, and click Create.

5 In Permissions, select entries in the list, click the Edit (pencil) button to change their name or permissions, and change the settings as follows:

6 Click Share and then click Save.

UNIX Class Name Permission

Owner (single silhouette) admin Read and Write

Group (several silhouettes) admin Read

Others (globe) Others Read

Chapter 7 Setting Up Home Folders 117

Setting Up an Automountable AFP Share Point for Home Folders You can use Server Admin to set up an AFP share point for home folders.

Home folders for user accounts stored in shared directory domains (such as an Open Directory domain) can reside in any AFP share point that the users computer can access. This share point must be automountablethat is, it must have a network mount record in the directory domain where the user account resides.

Using an automountable share point ensures that the home folder appears in /Network/Servers when the user logs in to a Mac OS X computer configured to access the shared domain.

Users can access home folders on any automountable share point with guest access enabled.

To set up an automountable AFP share point for home folders: 1 If you do not have a share point to host home folders, create one.

For instructions, see Setting Up a Share Point on page 116.

2 Open Server Admin and connect to the server that hosts the share point.

To connect to the server, choose Server > Connect, enter the server address in the Address field, and authenticate as a server administrator.

If youre already connected, youll see Disconnect (instead of Connect) in the Server menu.

3 To view a list of available services, use the disclosure triangle next to your server.

If Server Admin doesnt list the AFP service, click the Add (+) button, choose Add Service, select AFP, and then click Save.

4 Select the AFP service and click Settings.

5 In Access, select Enable Guest access and click Save; then if AFP is not running, click Start AFP.

For more information about administering AFP service, see File Services Administration.

6 Select the server and click File Sharing.

7 Click Share Points and then select the share point.

8 In Share Point, select Enable Automount.

When you select Enable Automount, a configuration dialog appears. If it doesnt, click Edit.

9 Choose your directory domain from the Directory pop-up menu, choose AFP from the Protocol pop-up menu, select Use for User home folders, and click OK.

10 In the dialog that appears, authenticate as the directory administrator and then click OK.

118 Chapter 7 Setting Up Home Folders

11 Click Protocol Options.

12 In AFP, select Share this item using AFP and Allow AFP guest access.

When you enable guest access, it is enabled for all home folders in the share point.

By default, in home folders guests can only access /Public and /Sites folders. When a guest browses the home folder server, they can see who has home folders on that server but are restricted to opening guest-access-enabled folders.

Guests can also use ~user-short-name/Public to access a users /Public folder.

13 To prevent SMB access to the share point, in SMB, deselect Share this item using SMB.

14 To prevent FTP access to the share point, in FTP, deselect Share this item using FTP.

15 To prevent NFS access to the share point, in NFS, deselect Export this item and its contents to.

16 Click OK to close the Protocol Options dialog and then click Save.

From the Command Line You can also set up a share point using the sharing command in Terminal. For more information, see the file services chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Setting Up an Automountable NFS Share Point for Home Folders Although AFP is the preferred protocol for accessing home folders (because of the security it offers), you can use Server Admin to set up a network NFS share point for home folders.

NFS share points can be used for home folders of users defined in shared directory domains, such as an Open Directory domain or an Active Directory domain.

The NFS share point must be automountablethat is, it must have a network mount record in the directory domain where the user account resides.

An automountable share point ensures that the computer can locate the NFS share point and home folder. It also makes the share points server visible in /Network/Servers when the user logs in to a Mac OS X computer configured to access the shared domain.

To set up an automountable NFS share point for home folders: 1 If you do not have a share point to host home folders, create one.

For instructions, see Setting Up a Share Point on page 116.

2 Open Server Admin and connect to the server that hosts the share point.

To connect to the server, choose Server > Connect, enter the server address in the Address field, and then authenticate as a server administrator.

If youre already connected, youll see Disconnect (instead of Connect) in the Server menu.

Chapter 7 Setting Up Home Folders 119

3 To view a list of available services, use the disclosure triangle next to your server.

If Server Admin doesnt list the NFS service, click the Add (+) button, choose Add Service, select NFS, and then click Save.

4 Select the NFS service, then if NFS is not running, click Start NFS.

For more information about administering NFS service, see File Services Administration.

5 Select the server and click File Sharing.

6 Click Share Points and then select the share point.

7 In Share Point, select Enable Automount and then click Edit.

8 Choose your directory domain from the Directory pop-up menu, choose NFS from the Protocol pop-up menu, select Use for User home folders, and click OK.

9 In the dialog that appears, authenticate as the directory administrator and then click OK.

10 Click Protocol Options.

11 In NFS, select Export this item and its contents to and choose Client List.

12 Add client computers that you want to have access to the share point.

Click the Add (+) button and enter the IP address or host name of a client you want to add to the computer group.

Click the Remove () button to remove the selected computer from the list.

13 In the Mapping pop-up menu, choose Root to Nobody.

14 In the Minimum Security pop-up menu, choose the minimum level of authentication security required with the computers.

If your computers cant authenticate with this level of security, they cant use NFS share points.

15 To prevent AFP access to the share point, in AFP, deselect Share this item using AFP.

16 To prevent SMB access to the share point, in SMB, deselect Share this item using SMB.

17 To prevent FTP access to the share point, in FTP, deselect Share this item using FTP.

18 Click OK to close the Protocol Options dialog and then click Save.

From the Command Line You can also set up a share point using the sharing command in Terminal. For more information, see the file services chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Setting Up an SMB Share Point You can use Server Admin to: Enable or disable access to a share point that uses SMB Change the share point name that SMB clients see Choose whether guest access and opportunistic locking is allowed

120 Chapter 7 Setting Up Home Folders

Set the default permissions for new files and folders in the share point

SMB share points cant be used for Mac OS X home folders, but can be used for Windows home folders.

Note: Dont use a slash (/) in the name of a folder or volume you plan to share. Users trying to access the share point might have trouble seeing it.

To create an SMB share point and set permissions: 1 If you do not have a share point to host home folders, create one.

For instructions, see Setting Up a Share Point on page 116.

2 Open Server Admin and connect to the server that hosts the share point.

To connect to the server, choose Server > Connect, enter the server address in the Address field, and authenticate as a server administrator.

If youre already connected, youll see Disconnect (instead of Connect) in the Server menu.

3 To view a list of available services, use the disclosure triangle next to your server.

If Server Admin doesnt list the SMB service, click the Add (+) button, choose Add Service, select SMB, and then click Save.

4 Select the SMB service.

5 In General, select Standalone Server from the Role pop-up menu.

6 In Access, select Allow Guest access.

7 Click Save and then click Start SMB.

If SMB is already running, the Start SMB button is replaced by the Stop SMB button.

8 Select the server and click File Sharing.

9 Select the share point.

10 In Share Point, click Protocol Options.

11 In SMB, select Share this item using SMB.

12 To allow unregistered users access to the share point, select Allow SMB guest access.

For greater security, dont select this item.

13 To change the name that clients see when they browse for and connect to the share point using SMB, enter a new name in the Custom SMB name field.

Changing the custom SMB name doesnt affect the name of the share point itself, only the name that SMB clients see.

14 Select the type of locking for this share point:

To allow clients to use opportunistic file locking, select Enable oplocks.

Chapter 7 Setting Up Home Folders 121

Important: Do not enable oplocks for a share point thats using a protocol other than SMB. For more information on oplocks, see File Services Administration.

To set standard locks on server files, select Enable strict locking.

Note: For servers earlier than Mac OS X Server v10.2.4, opportunistic locking is always on and strict locking is always off. Avoid using Workgroup Manager from Mac OS X Server v10.3 or later to view locking settings for earlier servers. It can display incorrect information about the settings.

15 Choose a method for assigning default UNIX access permissions for new files and folders in the share point:

To set new items to adopt permissions of the enclosing item, select Inherit permissions from parent.

To assign specific permissions, select Assign as follows and use the Owner, Group, and Everyone pop-up menus.

16 To prevent AFP access to the share point, in AFP, deselect Share this item using AFP.

17 To prevent NFS access to the share point, in NFS, deselect Export this item and its contents to.

18 To prevent FTP access to the share point, in FTP, deselect Share this item using FTP.

19 Click OK to close the Protocol Options dialog and then click Save.

From the Command Line You can also set up a share point using the sharing command in Terminal. For more information, see the file services chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Administering Home Folders You can use Workgroup Manager to assign a home folder location to user accounts. To assign a home folder location, you must create a share point. For instructions on creating share points, see Setting Up a Share Point on page 116.

Specifying No Home Folder You can use Workgroup Manager to change a user account that has a home folder to one that has none. By default, new users have no home folder. When users do not have home folders, they cant save files locally.

Important: Portable home directories require that you specify a network home folder.

To define no home folder: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Open the directory domain where the user account resides and authenticate as an administrator of the domain.

122 Chapter 7 Setting Up Home Folders

To open a directory domain, click the globe icon and choose from the pop-up menu. To authenticate, click the lock.

3 Click the Users button and select one or more user accounts.

4 Click Home and select (None) from the list.

5 Click Save.

Creating a Home Folder for a Local User You can use Workgroup Manager to define home folders for users whose accounts are stored in a servers local directory domain.

You might want to use local user accounts on standalone servers (servers not accessible through a network) and for administrator accounts on a server. These accounts are meant to be used by those logging in to the server locally. They are not meant to be used by network users.

Home folders for local users should reside in share points on the server where the users accounts reside. These share points do not need to be automountable (that is, they do not require a network mount record).

A home folder has the same name as the users first short name.

To create a home folder for a local user: 1 If you dont already have a share point, create one.

For instructions, see Setting Up a Share Point on page 116.

2 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts and select the user account you want to work with.

To select a local user account, click the globe icon, choose the local directory domain, click the Users button, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

3 Click the lock and authenticate as an administrator of the local directory domain.

4 Click Home to set up the selected users home folder.

5 If the folder you want to use is a share point, select it.

The list displays all share points on the server you are connected to.

6 If the folder isnt a share point, click the Add (+) button; then, in the dialog, enter the path to the folder in the Full Path field (leave the other two fields blank) and click OK.

For example, if you want to use the local /Users folder, enter:

/Users/usershortname

Replace usershortname with the short name of the user.

Dont use a terminating slash.

7 Optionally, enter a disk quota and specify megabytes (MB) or gigabytes (GB).

Chapter 7 Setting Up Home Folders 123

8 Click Create Home Now and then click Save.

If you do not click Create Home Now before clicking Save, the home folder is created the next time the user logs in remotely. However, only certain clients can connect to servers hosting share points in the local domain.

For instructions on setting up a share point for Mac OS X clients, see Creating a Network Home Folder on page 123.

From the Command Line You can also create a home folder for a local user using the createhomedir command in Terminal. For more information, see the users and groups chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Creating a Network Home Folder In Workgroup Manager, you can set up a network home folder for a user account stored in a shared directory domain.

A users network home folder can reside in any AFP or NFS share point that the users computer can access.

The share point must be automountablethat is, it must have a network mount record in the directory domain. An automountable share point ensures that the client computer can locate the share point and the home folder. It also makes the share points server visible in /Network/Servers when the user logs in to a Mac OS X computer configured to access the shared domain.

You can use Workgroup Manager to create a network home folder for a user whose account is stored in an Open Directory domain or another read/write directory domain accessible from the server you are using. You can also use Workgroup Manager to review home folder information in any accessible read-only directory domain.

To create a network home folder for AFP or NFS share points: 1 Make sure that the share point exists on the server where you want the home folder to

reside and that the share point has a network mount record configured for home folders.

For instructions, see Setting Up an Automountable AFP Share Point for Home Folders on page 117, or Setting Up an Automountable NFS Share Point for Home Folders on page 118.

2 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts and select the user account you want to work with.

To select an account, connect to the server where the account resides, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the user account is stored, click the Users button, and then select the user account in the accounts list.

124 Chapter 7 Setting Up Home Folders

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Home; then in the share points list select the share point you want to use.

The list displays all automountable network-visible share points in the search policy of the server you are connected to, as well as custom home folder locations in the directory domain.

If the share point you want to select is not listed, try clicking Refresh. If the share point still does not appear, it might not be automountable. Set up the share point to have a network mount record configured for home folders as described in step 1, or create a custom home folder location as described in Creating a Custom Location for Home Folders on page 124.

5 Optionally, enter a disk quota and specify megabytes (MB) or gigabytes (GB).

6 Click Create Home Now and then click Save.

For AFP share points, if you do not click Create Home Now before clicking Save, the home folder is created the next time the user logs in remotely. For NFS share points, you are required to click Create Home Now before clicking Save.

The home folder has the same name as the users first short name.

7 If the home folder is in a new NFS share point, make sure the user restarts his or her computer so the share point is visible.

When the user logs in using SSH to obtain command-line access to the server, the users home folder is mounted.

From the Command Line You can also create a network home folder using the createhomedir command in Terminal. For more information, see the users and groups chapter of Command-Line Administration.

Creating a Custom Location for Home Folders The users home folder does not need to reside in the share point folder. For example, you can organize home folder locations by creating several subfolders in a share point. If /Homes is the share point folder, you can place teacher home folders in /Homes/Teachers and student home folders in /Homes/Students.

You can use Workgroup Manager to define a custom location for the home folder of a user whose account is stored in a servers local directory domain or in a shared directory domain. Shared directory domains can be an Open Directory domain, or another read/write directory domain, and must be accessible from the server that you are using.

To create a custom location for home folders, your share point must be configured correctly.

Chapter 7 Setting Up Home Folders 125

The share point for a local user accounts home folder should reside in an AFP share point on the server where the user account resides. This share point does not need to be automountablethat is, it does not require a network mount record in the directory domain.

The share point for the home folder of a user account in a shared directory domain can reside in any share point that the users computer can access. This share point must be automountable. Additionally, any NFS share point used for home folders must also be automountable.

For instructions, see Setting Up an Automountable AFP Share Point for Home Folders on page 117, or Setting Up an Automountable NFS Share Point for Home Folders on page 118.

Important: The following procedure requires Mac OS X Server v10.4.3 or later.

To create a custom home folder using Workgroup Manager: 1 Make sure the share point exists and is configured correctly.

2 To have the home folder to reside beneath a folder under the share point, use Workgroup Manager or the Finder to create all folders in the path between the share point and where the home folder resides.

3 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts and then select the user account you want to work with.

To select an account, connect to the server where the account resides, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the user account is stored, click the Users button, and then select the user account.

4 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

5 Click Home.

6 Click the Add (+) button to add a custom home folder location or select a location and click the Duplicate (copy icon) button to copy an existing location.

7 In the Mac OS X Server/Share Point URL field, enter the full URL to an existing automountable AFP share point where you want the home folder to reside or leave this field blank for an NFS share point.

For example, if the AFP share point is /Homes and you are using DNS, you might enter afp://server.example.com/Homes. If you are not using DNS, replace the DNS name of the server hosting the home folder with the servers IP address: afp://192.168.2.1/Homes. Dont put a slash (/) at the end of the URL.

8 In the Path to Home Folder field, enter the path from the AFP share point to the home folder, including the home folder but excluding the share point.

For an NFS share point, leave this field blank.

126 Chapter 7 Setting Up Home Folders

For example, to create a home folder for a user named Smith, in a custom location of /Homes/Teachers/SecondGrade/, enter Teachers/SecondGrade/Smith. Make sure the custom location folder exists.

Do not put a slash (/) at the beginning or the end of the path.

9 In the Full Path field, enter the full path to the home folder, including the home folder itself, in this format:

[/Network/Servers/servers-host-name/][Volumes/[drive/]volume/]share-point/path

The entries in brackets ([ ]) are optional. Include them only if they apply to the share point location. If the share point is for local user accounts, do not include /Network/ Servers/servers-host-name.

Replace the following elements:

Use an initial slash (/) but no terminating slash.

For example, the following is a Full Path entry for a custom home folder for local users: /Homes/Teachers/SecondGrade/Smith

The following is a Home entry for a custom home folder in the Hard-Drive volume stored in a server located at server.example.com:

/Network/Servers/server.example.com/Volumes/Hard-Drive/Homes/Teachers/ SecondGrade/Smith

If you used a volume named HomeFolders in an external drive named external-HD as a location for a custom home folder, the Full Path entry looks like this:

/Network/Servers/server.example.com/Volumes/external-HD/HomeFolders/Homes/ Teachers/SecondGrade/Smith

10 Click OK.

11 Optionally, enter a disk quota and specify megabytes (MB) or gigabytes (GB).

12 Click Create Home Now and then click Save.

If you do not click Create Home Now before clicking Save, the home folder is created the next time the user logs in to a client computer.

Element Do this

servers-host-name Replace this with the AFP servers host name.

drive If the share point is stored on a server with multiple storage devices, replace this with the name of the storage device.

volume If the share point is stored on a server with multiple volumes, replace this with the name of the volume storing the share point.

share-point Replace this with the name of the share point.

path Replace this with the path you entered in the previous step.

Chapter 7 Setting Up Home Folders 127

Note: Home folders are created the first time a user logs in only on share points served through an AFP or SMB server. NFS home folders must be created manually.

Setting Up a Home Folder for a Windows User Using Workgroup Manager, you can set up a network home folder that will be mounted when a Windows user logs in to a Windows domain. Normally, the same network home folder is also mounted if the user logs in on a Mac OS X computer. You can also set up separate home folders if you prefer.

You can create a home folder in any existing share point, or you can create the home folder in the /Users foldera predefined share point.

To create a home folder in a new share point, create the share point first. The share point for a Windows home folder must be on a Windows domain member server or the PDC server and use the SMB protocol.

For instructions, see Setting Up an SMB Share Point on page 119.

If the share point will be used for Mac OS X home folders, it must also use AFP or NFS and have a network mount record configured for home folders.

Set the Windows home folder for a user account in the Mac OS X Server PDC LDAP directory. If you have a BDC, the PDC server replicates changes to it.

To set up a home folder in an existing share point: 1 In Workgroup Manager, open the user account where you want to set up a home

folder.

To open an account, click Accounts, click the globe icon below the toolbar, and then open the PDC LDAP directory.

To edit home folder information, click the lock to authenticate as an LDAP directory domain administrator and then select the user in the user list.

2 If you want to use the same network home folder for Windows as for Mac OS X, click Home, specify the share point to use, and then do the following:

In the share points list, select /Users or the share point you want to use and then click Create Home Now. If you want to select /Users but it isnt listed, click the Add (+) button and then in the Full Path field, enter:

/Users/usershortname

Replace usershortname with the first short name of the user account youre configuring.

128 Chapter 7 Setting Up Home Folders

Optionally, enter a disk quota for the users home folder and specify megabytes (MB) or gigabytes (GB).

Important: This quota also applies to the users roaming profile if its on the same volume as the home folder. Make sure the quota is adequate for both folders for an entire work session. A users profile folder includes the My Documents folder and the Internet Explorer cache, which often use considerable disk space. For more information, see Setting Disk Quotas for Windows Users to Avoid Data Loss on page 130.

3 Click Windows and enter the home folder location in the Path field:

To use the same home folder for Windows login and Mac OS X login, leave Path blank. You can also specify this home folder by entering a UNC path that doesnt include a share point: \\servername\usershortname.

Replace servername with the NetBIOS name of the PDC server or a Windows domain member server where the share point is located. You can see the servers NetBIOS name by opening Server Admin and clicking SMB in the Servers list. Then click Settings, click General, and look at the Computer Name field.

Replace usershortname with the first short name of the user account youre configuring.

To specify a different SMB share point, enter a UNC path that includes the share point: \\servername\sharename\usershortname

Replace sharename with the name of the share point.

4 From the Hard Drive pop-up menu, choose a drive letter.

The default drive letter is H. Windows uses the drive letter to identify the mounted home directory.

5 Click Save.

6 If the Path field isnt blank, make sure the specified share point contains a folder for the users home folder.

The folders name must match the users first short name and the user must have read and write permission for the folder.

If the Path field is blank, the home directory share point doesnt need to contain a home folder for the user. In this case, Mac OS X Server creates a home folder in the share point specified in the Home pane.

Chapter 7 Setting Up Home Folders 129

Setting Disk Quotas You can limit the disk space users have available to store files in the volume where their home folders reside.

This quota applies to all files that the user stores in the volume where his or her home folder resides, including all files stored in the users drop box. Therefore, when a user places files in another users drop box, it can affect the other users disk quota or have other effects, such as: When you copy a file to a users AFP drop box, the owner of the drop box becomes

the owner of the file. In NFS, when you copy a file to another folder, you remain the owner and the copy

operation reduces your disk quota on a particular partition.

To set up a home folder share point disk quota using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Select the user account you want to work with.

To select an account, connect to the server where the account resides, click the globe icon, choose the directory domain where the user account is stored, click the Users button, and then select the user account.

3 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click Home, specify the disk quota using the Disk Quota field and the adjacent pop-up menu, and then click Save.

5 Make sure disk quotas are enabled for the volume where the share point resides.

6 In Server Admin, select the server hosting home folders and then click File Sharing.

7 Click Volumes and then select the volume that stores home folders.

8 Click Quotas, select Enable quotas on this volume, and then click Save.

WARNING: If you set a disk quota on a user with a mobile account, the quota only affects the users network home folder. There are no quota restrictions on the users local home folder. Setting the quota too low can cause sync issues and data loss. For example, if you set a 250 MB quota and the user uses 500 MB on his or her local home folder, the mobile account doesnt sync entirely. The home folders sync until the 250 MB quota is met, and unsynced files remain local. When the user logs in to another computer and syncs, only 250 MB of data syncs from the network home folder.

130 Chapter 7 Setting Up Home Folders

Setting Disk Quotas for Windows Users to Avoid Data Loss A disk quota that applies to a Windows users roaming profile folder must be large enough to cover the users expected data storage needs for a work session.

A Mac OS X Server PDC enforces quotas on a roaming profile folder only at the end of a work session when the user logs out and the Windows computer copies the local profile to the roaming profile on the server.

If the copied local profile exceeds the quota, the roaming profile wont be updated with changes affecting the local profile since the user logged in.

If enforcing a users disk quota prevents an update of the users roaming profile, and the user later logs in using a different Windows computer, Windows could load and apply the outdated roaming user profile from the server.

The server cant enforce the quota incrementally on the roaming profile folder because the Windows computer updates only the local profile during a work session. (The server enforces a quota incrementally on changes to the home folder.)

A roaming profile folder is subject to the same disk quota as the home directory if both are on the same volume. A users profile directory is not subject to a disk quota if its on a different volume from the users home directory or the home directory is not subject to a disk quota.

Because a quota that covers the roaming profile directory also covers the home directory, make sure the quota is adequate for an entire work session and the users home folder. A users profile folder includes the My Documents folder and the Internet Explorer cache, which often uses a considerable amount of disk space.

The recommended minimum quotas are: 10 MB for a user who logs in only from Windows workstations 20 MB for a user who logs in from Windows and Mac OS X computers

Using Presets to Choose Default Home Folders You can define default home folder settings to use for new users by using a preset to predefine them. For information about defining and using presets, see Using Presets to Create Accounts on page 62.

Moving Home Folders To move a home folder, create a new home folder, copy the contents of the old home folder into the new home folder, and then delete the old home folder.

Deleting Home Folders When you delete a user account, the associated home folder is not deleted. The administrator must delete the home folder manually by moving it to Trash.

8

131

8 Managing Portable Computers

This chapter provides information about tools available to manage portable computers.

Mac OS X Server allows you to create and manage mobile accounts for users of portable computers.

About Mobile Accounts If your organization uses portable computers, assign mobile accounts to users. This allows you to manage their preferences and control their level of access to local and network resources. These mobile accounts, which are designed for portable computers, provide many advantages over local or network accounts.

A mobile account includes both a network home folder and a local home folder. Having these two types of home folders allows users to take advantage of features available for both local and network accounts. You can sync specific folders in these two home folders, creating a portable home directory.

Syncing ensures that users access their most recently updated files when they connect to the network. If a user modifies files on different computers, when he or she connects to the network and syncs, his or her computer retrieves the most recently synced file.

Mobile accounts also cache authentication information and managed preferences. A users authentication information is maintained on the directory server but is cached on the local computer. With cached authentication information, a user can log in using the same user name and password, even if he or she is not connected to the network.

For example, if a student has a mobile account, the students login name, password, and preferences defined for the user account, workgroups, and computer are the same at school and at home. If you change these items, the local versions are updated when the user logs in at school.

132 Chapter 8 Managing Portable Computers

About Portable Home Directories A portable home directory is a synced subset of a users local and network home folders. You can configure which folders to sync and how often to sync them. Users can also initiate syncing. By syncing key folders, a user can work on or off the network and experience the same work environment.

Because the user has a local home folder that only syncs periodically or at login and logout, the mobile account reduces network traffic, expediting server connections for users who need to access the server.

The computer locally caches temporary files. This improves network and individual computer performance because the users computer locally caches files like webpages.

In Mac OS X v10.3, mobile accounts did not sync local and network home folders. Before the introduction of syncing, portable home directories did not exist. When you manage computers with Mac OS X v10.3, you can still assign users mobile accounts, but they do not have synced home folders.

Because GUIDs for the local user account on the users computer and in the network user account on an Open Directory server are the same, file permissions are the same whether the user logs in using the local user account (while disconnected from the network) or the network user account.

You can assign mobile accounts to users with accounts stored in an Active Directory domain. To manage sync settings for these mobile accounts, extend the Active Directory schema to accept and map Open Directory attributes.

There are two ways to create mobile accounts: Use Workgroup Manager to enable syncing of user accounts Allow network users to create mobile accounts themselves

For instructions on using Workgroup Manager to enable syncing, see Creating a Mobile Account on page 202.

Users with network accounts who have administrative access to their computers can create mobile accounts, which also creates a portable home directory. You can manage their sync settings in the Rules panes of Mobility preferences.

To prevent users from creating mobile accounts, you can choose not to show Accounts in their System Preferences. For instructions on denying access to specific System Preferences, see Managing Access to System Preferences on page 224.

You can also manage Mobility preferences so that they cant create mobile accounts. For instructions on managing Mobility preferences, see Preventing the Creation of a Mobile Account on page 203.

Chapter 8 Managing Portable Computers 133

Logging In to Mobile Accounts If a user has created a portable home directory, logging in to a mobile account is similar to logging in to a local account. First, the user selects his or her account and then enters the correct password to complete the login. If the account is not displayed, the user must enter a login name and password. If you enabled login and logout syncing, the users folders sync and the users desktop appears.

If the user does not have a mobile account with a portable home directory, there are a few different steps required after authentication. One of two things occur, depending on mobile account creation settings:

If you deselected Require confirmation before creating mobile account, the computer creates the mobile account.

If you selected Require confirmation before creating mobile account, the user sees a confirmation dialog that allows him or her to create a portable home directory, delay it, or not create a portable home directory and disable the dialog until the user holds down the Option key during login.

You can allow the user to choose which volume stores the users local home folder in Mobility options. Before the mobile account is created, the user must choose where to store the local home folder.

Mobile accounts remain on the computer even when the user logs out or disconnects from the network. Even when disconnected, the user can still log in to that account.

Note: The mobile accounts local home folder is deleted if you set account expiry settings and the account goes unused or if a local administrator deletes it. When the local home folder is deleted, the mobile account user cant log in away from the network.

The login window lists the mobile account based on the following: Login window settings The version of Mac OS X installed on your computers Whether the mobile account has a local home folder on the computer

For more information, see Changing the Appearance of the Login Window on page 189.

An external account is a special type of mobile account that is different from typical mobile accounts in the way users log in. For more information, see the next section.

134 Chapter 8 Managing Portable Computers

Resolving Sync Conflicts When a users files and folders sync, a sync conflict can occur if a file in the users local home folder and the network home folder have two versions of a file and it is not clear which one should be saved. Sync conflicts usually occur when a mobile account user changes files on one or more computers.

When sync conflicts occur, a dialog appears that allows the user to choose which version of a file to sync. The user can keep the files in the local or network home folder or keep both files.

The user can reset the sync history by pressing and holding the Shift and Option keys while logging in. When the sync information is reset and a sync conflict occurs, the sync conflict dialog reappears, asking which version of a file should be synced.

About External Accounts An external account is a mobile account that has its local home folder stored on a volume in an external drive. The portable home directory is created from the local home folder stored on that external drive and the users network home folder.

When the user connects an external drive containing his or her local home folder, the user can log in and use his or her account in the same way as if he or she had a mobile account with a local home folder on the computer. If the login window displays accounts in a list, the user can select his or her account, or if it has a name and password field, the user can enter his or her name and password.

External accounts require Mac OS X v10.5 or later and an external or ejectable volume that is formatted as Mac OS X Extended format (HFS Plus).

If the external account is stored on a portable computer, the user must start target disk mode on the portable computer before connecting it to the client computer. When the portable computer is in target disk mode, all mobile accounts stored on it become external accounts.

After the user logs in, Mac OS X only shows the external account that the user logged in with. When the user views the account list in Accounts System Preferences, the user sees his or her external account but doesnt see other external accounts.

Similarly, the fast user switching menu displays all accounts with local home folders on the client computer. If the user chooses Login Window from the fast user switching menu, all external accounts are shown in the fast user switching login window.

Because their home folder is stored on an external volume, external account users can use File Sharing only when the external volume is present.

Chapter 8 Managing Portable Computers 135

All mobile accounts on Mac OS X v10.5 or later (including external accounts) can use FileVault to encrypt the contents of the local home folder. For more information, see Enabling FileVault for Mobile Accounts on page 205.

For information about creating external accounts, see Creating External Accounts on page 208.

Logging In to External Accounts If a user has a local home folder on an external drive and he or she connects it to a computer that allows the external account, logging in to an external account is like logging into a mobile account.

If there isnt a local home folder on the external drive, or the external account isnt allowed, the user must take a few additional steps before he or she can log in with the external account. If the user has a local home folder on the computer, the user cant create a local home folder on an external drive.

If the user doesnt have a local home folder on an external drive, the location setting in mobile account creation options might give the user the choice of where to store the local home folder: If you set the location to user chooses, a window appears allowing the user to

choose where to store the local home folder. You can limit the choices to store on the computer or on an external drive, or you can choose both. If the user chooses an external drive, a local home folder is created on the external drive.

If you set the location to at path and enter the path to the external drive, the user doesnt choose a location.

For more information about setting up mobile account creation options, see Creating External Accounts on page 208.

After a local home folder is created on the external drive, if the computer is connected to the directory server that holds the mobile account, the user is allowed to log in. If its not connected to the directory server, Mac OS X checks to see if the external account is allowed or denied access to the computer.

If an external account isnt permanently allowed or denied access to a computer, a dialog appears asking if the external account should be allowed or denied access to the computer. To allow access, the user must authenticate as the local computer administrator.

If the external account is allowed access, the user logs in. If the user is denied access, the user is returned to the login window.

The local administrator can permanently allow or deny access to the computer. If a user is permanently denied access, he or she can hold down the Option key while logging in to redisplay the dialog.

136 Chapter 8 Managing Portable Computers

Considerations and Strategies for Deploying Mobile Accounts Before you deploy mobile accounts, carefully weigh the advantages and disadvantages of using mobile accounts and strategize how you will configure them.

When you properly configure mobile accounts, you can create a work environment where users effortlessly access their latest files from several locations, keep their managed preferences while offline, and retrieve file backups if they lose or damage their computers, all while requiring less network traffic than network accounts.

If improperly configured, mobile accounts can overload the server, force users to wait for long periods of time to log in or log out, and potentially cripple client computers by using all available hard disk space.

Advantages of Using Mobile Accounts Mobile accounts have several advantages over using local or network accounts: Applications locally cache temporary files. Mobile accounts create less network traffic than network accounts. You can manage individual mobile accounts. Users can access their accounts and files when disconnected from the network. Users can recover data if their computers or external drives are lost or damaged.

Applications locally cache temporary files When mobile account users run applications, those applications cache temporary files on the local computer. When external account users run applications, those applications cache temporary files on the external drive. When network account users run applications, instead of caching, the applications transfer temporary files over the network.

Because mobile accounts are not repeatedly transferring temporary files, they tend to be faster than other account types and also offer improved application stability. Some applications dont work with network home folders and temporary files that are not cached locally. Using mobile accounts, these applications run as if the user had a local account.

Mobile accounts create less network traffic than network accounts When network account users save files, they transfer the files over the network. When they open files, they also transfer files over the network. With a mobile account, files are stored locally (on the client computer or in an external drive) and are only transferred during syncing.

Syncing only transfers files if the modification time of a local or network file is different than the last time the files synced.

Chapter 8 Managing Portable Computers 137

Mobile accounts cache temporary files locally, improving network and individual computer performance. Locally caching files like webpages helps reduce network traffic.

You can also reduce network traffic by carefully planning user sync settings. For information about how to plan sync settings, see Strategies for Syncing Content on page 139.

You can manage individual mobile accounts Like network accounts, you can use Workgroup Manager to manage preferences and set account attributes for individual mobile accounts.

You can manage users with local accounts only if you add a computer to a computer group. This allows you to set management preferences affecting all local accounts for that computer but it doesnt let you manage individual local accounts. To manage specific local accounts, you must log in to the local computers individually or use Apple Remote Desktop.

Users can access their accounts and files when disconnected from the network Mobile accounts have two key features that allow users to access their accounts and files when disconnected from the network: cached authentication and portable home directories.

When mobile account users disconnect from the network using cached authentication, they can log in to the mobile account using the local home folder stored on the portable computer or on an external drive using the same login name and password they used when the computer or external drive was last connected.

By contrast, network account users cant access their accounts when they disconnect from the network. If you change the password for a user remotely, the next time the user connects to the network, he or she must use the new password to authenticate.

For information about portable home directories, see About Portable Home Directories on page 132.

Users can recover data if their computers or external drives are lost or damaged If a user with a mobile account loses or damages his or her portable computer or external drive and logs in using a new computer, the server restores all previously synced files during the next sync.

Considerations for Using Mobile Accounts Although mobile accounts provide many advantages over local and network accounts, they also have a few specific configuration needs that, if ignored, can create problems for network administrators.

138 Chapter 8 Managing Portable Computers

Consider the following: Improperly set sync settings can cause long delays during login and logout and can

create inconsistent home folders. If multiple users create a mobile account on the same computer, it could cause

excessive proliferation of home folders. Mobile accounts cant restore deleted files through syncing. You cant create mobile accounts when connected to a network through a virtual

private network (VPN) connection.

Improperly set sync settings can cause long delays during login and logout and can create inconsistent home folders If you only sync large files at login and logout, this could significantly increase the amount of time it takes for users to log in and out. If users make changes to large files, they must wait for the files to sync before they can finish logging in or logging out.

If a number of users are making changes to large files and are simultaneously logging in to a wireless network with limited bandwidth, they can overload the network, further delaying their login.

If you do not sync key folders, this can create inconsistent home folders and confuse your users.

For example, as a school administrator, lets say you decide to only sync a students ~/ Documents folder. This means that if students dont save their homework in the ~/ Documents folder, their homework isnt synced. When the students log in on another computer, they cant access their homework. Also, if homework saved in ~/Documents references pictures in ~/Pictures, the references might not work because the ~/Pictures folder is not synced.

If multiple users create a mobile account on the same computer, it could cause excessive proliferation of home folders If you have a shared-access computer like a kiosk or lab computer, every time a user creates his or her mobile account, a local home folder is created. If unmanaged, this could completely fill the computers available hard disk space.

If you set account expiry settings for a mobile account, you can automatically delete the local home folder after a set period of inactivity. If you dont want to automatically delete the home folder, consider using network or generic local accounts, both of which prevent the user from creating local home folders.

If you set up a guest account, the contents of its local home folder are deleted when the user logs out.

Chapter 8 Managing Portable Computers 139

Mobile accounts cant restore deleted files through syncing Although mobile accounts keep user files stored in two locationsin local and network home foldersthey do not eliminate the need for a formal backup system.

When you configure the users portable home directory, you choose a subset of their folders to sync. This syncing affects files that are new, modified, or deleted since the last sync.

If users save files in locations that are not synced, the files remain local. If users delete files and then sync, those files are removed from local and network home folders.

Unlike some formal backup solutions, users cant retrieve older versions of files, such as versions saved prior to the last sync.

You cant create mobile accounts when connected to a network through a virtual private network (VPN) connection You must create mobile accounts while being directly connected to the network. After enabling a mobile account, you can then use VPN to connect to the network and sync your mobile account.

Strategies for Syncing Content Administrators can enable and configure syncing through Workgroup Manager, and users can configure syncing through Accounts preferences. Each method of creating mobile accounts has different sync capabilities: When you create mobile accounts through Workgroup Manager, you can sync any

folder in the users home folder. When a user creates a mobile account through the Accounts System Preferences, he

or she can only sync top-level folders like ~/Desktop or ~/Documents.

A background sync occurs at a frequency set by you, or when the user manually syncs. By default, when you enable background syncing, it occurs every 20 minutes.

If a file in one home folder has been modified and the file in the other home folder has not, the newer file overwrites the older file. If both files have been modified since the last sync, the user is prompted to choose which file to keep.

Do not use background syncing with folders containing files accessed by multiple computers. There are several scenarios where this could cause users to load older, unsynced files:

The user saves a file on one computer and loads the same file on another computer. If that file was not synced to the server since its last save, the user loads an outdated version of the file located on the server.

The file might not exist on the server because it was not synced. If the file was not synced from the server before loading, the user either does not see the file or loads an outdated local version.

140 Chapter 8 Managing Portable Computers

The user uses the same mobile account to log in to two computers simultaneously. This might create sync issues with the two computers, causing the computers to display error messages.

Login and logout syncing should be carefully managed because a users login and logout is delayed while files are syncing. If a user has a slow network connection or is syncing many files or large files, the user must wait for syncing to complete before using the system.

If you want to sync parts of a users ~/Library folder, you must use login and logout syncing. Syncing the ~/Library folder retains users bookmarks and application preferences.

Consider syncing smaller files (such as preference files) at login and logout, while syncing larger files (such as movies) in the background. This reduces login and logout times because only preference files sync, and movies sync throughout a users session (instead of while the user is trying to log out). You can further reduce network traffic by choosing not to sync the movies folder, requiring users to access the movies folder locally.

By balancing login and logout syncing with background syncing, you can reduce the time required for logging in and logging out, while retaining consistent, synced home folders.

Setting Up Mobile Accounts for Use on Portable Computers When distributing portable computers, you face challenges that dont apply when deploying stationary computers.

For example, to ensure your portable computers remain managed while off the network, you must give users mobile accounts and prevent them from creating their own local accounts, or from changing settings to bypass management.

Configuring Portable Computers When you distribute portable computers to users, you must configure those computers to prevent users from circumventing your management scheme.

To set up portable computers for use on your network: 1 Install the operating system, applications, and utilities.

Most computers come with Mac OS X installed. However, to install a newer version, make sure the computer meets the minimum requirements for installing the operating system, applications, and utilities.

2 Create local accounts on Mac OS X computers.

Chapter 8 Managing Portable Computers 141

Create at least one local administrator account and create local user accounts as needed. Make sure the users local account names are not easily confused with the users network names.

By creating an administrator account, you are preventing the user from having administrator access unless you specify it for that user. Administrator access allows the user to override many managed settings.

3 Set up computers and computer groups on your server.

Use Workgroup Manager to create computer accounts for portable computers and then add them to a computer group and enforce preference management for all users of those computers.

Computer group management does not always affect external accounts because external accounts can be used on computers that arent connected to the network.

Allow the creation of mobile accounts for specific computers or computer groups rather than for specific users or groups. Doing so limits the creation of portable home directories only to specific computers. This way you can ensure that users who use several computers do not create portable home directories on each of those computers.

For more information about creating computer groups, see Chapter 6, Setting Up Computers and Computer Groups. For instructions about creating mobile accounts, see Creating a Mobile Account on page 202.

Managing Mobile Clients Without Using Mobile Accounts There are several situations in which you should not use mobile accounts for portable computer users. This section describes those situations and provides alternatives to using mobile accounts that allow you to manage portable computers.

Unknown Mac OS X Portable Computers If a computer is connected to your network but is not in a computer group, it is considered to be an unknown or guest computer. If you can identify the unknown computer by its Ethernet ID, you can create a computer account for it so that its no longer a guest computer.

You can use the guest computer account to manage guest computers on your network. This allows you to manage Mac OS X portable computers joining your directory domain. If guest computer users log in using network or mobile accounts, their user and group managed preferences and account settings apply.

For more information about how managed preferences interact when applied to users, groups, computers, and computer groups, see Understanding Managed Preference Interactions on page 156.

142 Chapter 8 Managing Portable Computers

For more information about setting up a guest computer account for Mac OS X users, see Working with Guest Computers on page 107.

Using Mac OS X Portable Computers with One Primary Local User You can also distribute portable computers with only local accounts and not assign mobile or network accounts to users. This may reduce or eliminate the burden of maintaining dedicated directory domain servers and servers that store home folders.

Even with local accounts, you can still manage users computers when they use your network by adding their computers to a computer group.

When distributing portable computers, you can still retain control over the computer when the user logs in with a local account while off the network. To restrict a user from full use of the computer, do not assign him or her local administrator privileges.

You can also set parental controls to further control the computer while off the network. For more information about how to set parental controls, see Mac Help.

To restrict users from full access to a computer, create a local administrator account and a local user account on the computer. Give the user the login information for the local user account but not the local administrator account. Only administrator accounts allow users to install software and save or delete files outside of the home folder.

If you make a user the local administrator of a computer, you can deny him or her the ability to turn off your computer management. However, in many cases, the local administrator can still override management settings.

If local users want to share files with other users over the network, they can enable File Sharing in the Sharing pane of System Preferences and then use their ~/Public folder to share. Similarly, local users can connect to the computers of other users who have File Sharing enabled.

If users also have network accounts, you might prefer that they log in through their local accounts to reduce network traffic. They can connect to their network accounts through the Connect to Server command in the Finder Go menu.

Using Mac OS X Portable Computers with Multiple Users Although mobile accounts are best suited for portable computers, there are a few situations in which using local accounts provides advantages over using mobile accounts.

For example, a schools wireless mobile lab might consist of 20 to 30 MacBooks, an instructors computer, an AirPort Extreme Base Station, and a printer, all located on a mobile cart. Because all of these computers are on a mobile cart, the school could use this lab for multiple classrooms throughout the campus.

Chapter 8 Managing Portable Computers 143

When using a wireless mobile lab, it is very difficult to control who uses specific computers. Unlike personal portable computers (where you know who uses which computer), or with stationary computers (where you can assign seating charts), it is hard to consistently use a distribution scheme for a wireless mobile lab. You could use stickers to label the computers and control distribution, but teachers would still need to monitor distribution to ensure students dont take the wrong computer.

When users create a portable home directory, they create a local home folder on the computer using some of the computers hard disk space. If several dozen users create local home folders on a computer, you could run out of hard disk space for their files. You might have to set strict account expiry settings, depending on the amount of hard disk space on the computers and how many users use them.

Another consideration when using a wireless mobile lab is that the total network throughput is much more limited than a wired lab. If users have network accounts, any time they open or save files it requires using the network, possibly slowing the network connections of other users.

Although mobile accounts help alleviate these issues, frequent syncing can also slow the network. Creating mobile accounts without synced folders efficiently utilizes the network. However, users must still copy and store files in their network home folders if they want to access their files from other computers.

To manage your carts MacBooks, you might create generic local user accounts on each computer.

For example, you could create identical generic local user accounts on each computer (such as all accounts could have Math as the user name and student as the password), and then create different generic local accounts for each class (such as an account for a history class, one for a biology class, and so on). Each account has a local home folder but does not have administrator privileges.

To perform maintenance tasks and upgrades, install software, and administer local user accounts, you would use a separate local administrator account on each computer to allow server administrators (or other individuals).

If a generic configuration works for all users of a computer, instead of creating several generic local accounts, enable the guest account. To use the guest account, your computers must run Mac OS X v10.5 or later. The guest account is a local account that doesnt require a password and cant be logged into remotely. When a guest user logs out, all information and files in the guest accounts home folder are deleted.

After creating local user accounts or enabling the guest account, you could then add each computer to a computer group and manage preferences for the computer or computer group.

144 Chapter 8 Managing Portable Computers

Because multiple users can store items in the local home folder for a generic account, you might want to periodically clean out that folder as part of your maintenance routine.

You might also recommend that students save files to a network drop box to ensure their files are not deleted, and to allow them to access those files regardless of who uses the computer next.

Instead of using local accounts, you could use external accounts, which would give your users individual accounts (with separate home folders). For external accounts, each student needs an external drive. This eliminates the need for hard-disk-space management on the portable computers, and you dont have to set strict account expiry settings. This also allows you to manage at the level of users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

The biggest issue with using external accounts for a mobile lab cart scenario is sync- over-wireless. If you dont carefully set sync settings, the mobile accounts could sync very large files and overload the wireless network.

Securing Mobile Clients There are several security considerations for mobile clients that do not exist for stationary clients. These considerations are relevant because of the mobility of the users computers. When they are off your network, you can no longer monitor the actions of malicious users, nor can you control the network environment that your users join.

You can use FileVault to secure the local home folder of a mobile account. If an intruder accesses the computer storing the local home folder while the user isnt logged in, the intruder cant access the contents of the local home folder. For more information, see Enabling FileVault for Mobile Accounts on page 205.

Consider taking additional steps to improve your network security and client computer security. For information, see Mac OS X Security Configuration and Mac OS X Server Security Configuration.

Optimizing the File Server for Mobile Accounts In Server Admin, you can enable an option called Server Side File Tracking for Mobile Home Sync, which reduces the strain on a file server that occurs when mobile accounts sync.

When mobile accounts sync, the users computer scans every folder in the local home folder and compares them with all folders in the network home folder. This scanning is unnecessary when only a few folders change and require syncing.

Chapter 8 Managing Portable Computers 145

If you enable the option, a server daemon updates the database of changed files. The users computer scans only the folders in the local home folder that have been modified since the last time the database was updated.

To enable the option, TCP port 2336 must be open on your file servers firewall.

To optimize the file server for mobile accounts: 1 In Server Admin, click the disclosure triangle for the server hosting network home

folders for mobile accounts.

2 If Firewall isnt listed, select the server, click Settings, click Services, select Firewall, and then click Save.

3 Select Firewall, click Settings, and then click Services.

4 Choose the address range for your users computers from the Edit Services for pop-up menu.

5 Select Allow only traffic from ipaddress to any of these ports, select the Allow checkbox for Mobile Account Sync (port 2336), and then click Save.

6 Select the server, click Settings, and then click General.

7 Select Server Side File Tracking for Mobile Home Sync and then click Save.

146 Chapter 8 Managing Portable Computers

9

147

9 Client Management Overview

This chapter provides an introduction to Mac OS X client management.

Client management is the centralized administration of your users computer experience, as shown in the following illustration. Its usually implemented by: Managing access to network printers and to server-resident home folders, group

folders, and other folders. Customizing the computer work environment of users, groups, and computers by

defining preferences for user accounts, group accounts, computers, and computer groups.

This chapter introduces each of these client management topics as they apply to users of Mac OS X computers.

Computers and desktops

Client management

Applications, folders, and files

Printers and volumes

Users and groups

148 Chapter 9 Client Management Overview

Using Network-Visible Resources Mac OS X Server lets you make various resources visible throughout your network so users can access them from different computers and various locations.

There are several key network-visible resources: Network home folders. A home folder, often referred to as a home directory or simply

home, is a place for each Mac OS X user to keep personal files. A user with a record in a shared Open Directory domain may have a home folder that resides on the network, often on the same server where the user account resides. A home folder contains several folderssuch as Desktop, Documents, and Public to help organize information. After logging in, users access their network home folders by clicking the Home icon in the Finder.

Group folders. When you set up a group account for network users, you can associate a group folder with the group. A group folder is a place for group members to exchange information electronically. By default, it contains three folders Documents, Library, and Public. The Public folder contains a Drop Box folder, which allows users to easily share their files. By residing on the server for easy access throughout the network, a group folder can be shown in the Dock for access from wherever a user wants to work on group activities.

Other shared folders. You can set up other folders on the server to provide users access to applications, handouts, announcements, schedules, and other files.

NetBoot and NetInstall images. You can use NetBoot images and NetInstall images on the server to simplify the setup of network users computers. A users computer can start up from a NetBoot image stored on the server. You can use the same computer for a science lab booting from one image and for a French lab booting from a different image. Each time a lab computer restarts, the system reflects the original condition of the selected boot image, regardless of what the previous student may have done on the computer.

A NetInstall image installs preconfigured software on users computers, making it easy to remotely deploy the operating system, additional applications, and even custom computer settings, without user interaction.

Chapter 9 Client Management Overview 149

Customizing the User Experience You manage a network users work environment by defining preferencessettings that customize and control the users computer experience.

There are two panes in Workgroup Manager Preferences: Overview and Details. To manage predefined system preferences, use the Overview pane. To manage preferences for any application or utility that has a preference manifest, use the Details pane.

The Overview pane is identical for users and groups, but additional items (Energy Saver and Time Machine) appear for computers and computer groups.

Many factors, including user responsibilities and security issues, determine what computer work environment is most suitable for a user. In some cases, setting up informal usage guidelines may be sufficient. In other cases, tightly controlling the computer experience may be necessary, with each setting defined and each application controlled. The preferences you define should use Mac OS X capabilities that best support your user and your business requirements.

The Power of Preferences Many preferences, such as Dock and Finder preferences, customize the appearance of the desktop. For example, you can set up Dock and Finder preferences so the users work environment is simplified by including only essential applications and key folders in the Dock.

Other preferences manage what users can access and control. For example, you can set up Media Access preferences to prevent users from burning CDs and DVDs or making changes to a computers internal disk.

The following table summarizes how preferences affect the appearance of the desktop, and the activities a user can perform.

This preference Tailors the work environment

Limits access and control By letting you manage

Applications % Applications a user can open

Classic % Classic environment startup

Dock % Appearance and contents of the Dock

Energy Saver % Startup, shutdown, wake, sleep, and performance settings

Finder % % Appearance of desktop icons and Finder elements

Login % Login experience

Media Access % Ability to use recordable media

Mobility % Creation of mobile accounts

150 Chapter 9 Client Management Overview

Designing the Login Experience An example of the power of preference management is the ability to shape and control the users login experience. You can set up Login preferences for computers and computer groups to control the appearance of the login window.

The following table provides example configurations of the login window and login options to suit your environment.

Network % % Proxy settings for accessing servers through a firewall

Parental Controls % Web access and time limits on computer use

Printing % Printers a user can use, and page footer settings

Software Update % Server to use for updates

System Preferences

% System preferences that are enabled on the users computer

Time Machine % Which volumes are backed up and how long the backup files are retained

Universal Access % Hardware settings for users with special visual, auditory, or other needs

This preference Tailors the work environment

Limits access and control By letting you manage

Environment Desired effect Key login settings

Kiosk The computer should always be logged in as a local or guest account. Users can also log in with their personal accounts (either externally or by using network accounts).

Show Other Dont show Restart or Shut Down buttons Dont show password hint Enable automatic login Dont enable >console login Dont log out inactive users Enable external accounts Enable guest account

Educational lab Users should be able to select their account from a list. People without accounts shouldnt be able to shut down or restart the computer. Inactive users should be automatically logged out.

Message: Welcome to the Math Lab. Show mobile accounts and network users Dont show Restart or Shut Down buttons Dont show password hint Dont enable automatic login Log out inactive users Enable external accounts

Chapter 9 Client Management Overview 151

Choosing a Workgroup In addition to customizing the login window, you can manage login preferences that affect whether users choose workgroups.

If you dont manage login access preferences, after the user authenticates, a list of available workgroups appears (depending on computer settings and if the user belongs to more than one workgroup).

Network account users choose from workgroups in their directory domain but local users access their workgroups from their local directory domain.

Its possible for a user to belong to a group that doesnt appear in the list. The login screen lists only workgroups that are allowed access by the computer group.

Local administrators also have the option not to choose a workgroup and disable preference management.

Users can select Remember my choice, which bypasses the workgroup chooser in future logins and selects a workgroup for the user. Users can still change their workgroup by holding down the Option key while their password is validated.

If the computer or the computer group its associated with supports local-only users, all workgroups that are given access to the computer by the computer group are listed after a local user logs in. The user can select from any of these.

Corporate workstation Users must enter their name and password to log in. Users should be able to work without being logged out. Except for primary users, no one can log in unless they have a network or local account.

Message: If you have issues, contact the IT help desk at ...

Show name and password text fields Show Restart and Shut Down buttons Dont show password hint Dont enable automatic login Dont log out inactive users Dont enable external accounts Dont enable guest account

High security The computer should be as secure as possible, restricting who can use the computer and how they log in.

Message: Unauthorized use prohibited Show name and password text fields Dont show Restart or Shut Down buttons Dont show password hint Dont enable automatic login Dont enable >console login Dont enable fast user switching Log out inactive users Dont enable external accounts Dont enable guest account

Environment Desired effect Key login settings

152 Chapter 9 Client Management Overview

Any preferences associated with the user, the chosen workgroup, parent workgroups, and the computer being used, take effect upon login.

If you manage login access preferences, you can customize the workgroup choosing process. For example, you could: Ensure that the workgroup chooser is always shown (by selecting Always show

workgroup dialog during login, and in login options, deselecting Local administrators may refresh or disable management).

Bypass the workgroup chooser and combine settings from all available workgroups (by selecting Combine available workgroup settings).

Prevent parent group preferences from taking effect (by selecting Ignore workgroup nesting).

For more information, see Customizing the Workgroups Displayed at Login on page 193.

Working with Synced Homes After choosing a workgroup, users with local or network accounts are logged in. If the user has a mobile account, he or she might be prompted to create a synced home, depending on the users mobility settings and whether he or she already has a mobile account.

After the user creates a synced home, he or she might be prompted to choose where to store the home. The user can choose a volume on the local computer, or an external volume, such as external hard drive. If you choose the location for the user (by setting it to the startup volume or a specific path), the user wont need to choose where to create the home.

Like the login preferences set in Workgroup Manager, mobility preferences also affect how users log in and what dialogs are shown, and they dictate the kinds of decisions the user must make when they log in. By managing preferences, you choose what features are available and whether theyre automatically enabled or the user must enable them.

Login and mobility preference management is an example of how preference management allows you to precisely sculpt the user experience.

Improving Workflow You can use preference management to improve workflow by limiting the number of applications and folders that are displayed. You can also make applications and folders more accessible by putting them in the Dock and creating multiple workgroups (groups with managed preferences), each of which has a Dock that is customized to show only the applications used by users in the group.

Chapter 9 Client Management Overview 153

Applications can be stored locally on a computers hard disk or on a server in a share point. If applications are stored locally, users can find them in the Applications folder. If applications are stored in a share point and you dont add the share point as a login item, the user must connect to the server by choosing Go > Connect to Server in the Finder to locate and use applications.

Applications can also be made available through an automounted share point as the /Network/Applications mount record.

To make specific applications easy to find, you can use Dock Items preferences to place an alias for the My Applications folder in the users Dock. The My Applications folder contains aliases for applications.

However, adding the My Applications folder might extend the login time for managed users because Mac OS X must search available disks to build the applications list for every login.

For instructions on creating aliases to My Applications and other folders in a users Dock, see Adding Items to a Users Dock on page 176.

You can manage user access to local applications by creating lists of approved applications in the Applications preferences. To set up a list of approved applications, see Allowing Legacy Users to Open Specific Applications and Folders on page 168. This list determines what users find in the My Applications folder located in the Dock.

To prevent users from opening a Finder window to easily browse to other applications, use Simple Finder. For more information about using Simple Finder, see Setting Up Simple Finder on page 182.

If you created a group folder, you can set up quick access to the folder when a user logs in to the workgroup associated with the folder. Users can use this group folder to facilitate file sharing between group members.

For instructions on creating an alias for the group folder, see Providing Easy Access to Group Folders on page 175. To provide access to the group volume, which contains the /Public folder and a drop box for the group, see Providing Easy Access to the Group Share Point on page 199.

154 Chapter 9 Client Management Overview

10

155

10 Managing Preferences

This chapter provides information about managing preferences for users, workgroups, computers, and computer groups.

By managing preferences for users, workgroups, computers, and computer groups, you can customize the users experience and restrict user access to only the applications and network resources you choose.

To manage preferences, use the Preferences pane in Workgroup Manager.

For an overview of how to use managed preferences to customize the user experience, see The Power of Preferences on page 149, and Designing the Login Experience on page 150.

Using Workgroup Manager to Manage Preferences Workgroup Manager allows you to set and lock certain system settings for users on the network. You can set initial preferences and allow users to change them later or you can keep preferences under administrative control at all times (you can also leave preference settings unmanaged).

Workgroup Manager provides control over most major system and application preferences, as well as various settings for users, groups, computers, and computer groups. The preference editor controls the remainder of the applications that may require management.

These preference panes allow you to manage the following settings:

Preference pane What you can manage

Applications Applications and Dashboard widgets available to users, and if Front Row is enabled. For more information, see Managing Access to Applications on page 164.

Classic Classic startup settings, sleep settings, and the availability of Classic items such as Control Panels. For more information, see Managing Classic Preferences on page 169.

156 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

Understanding Managed Preference Interactions You can define preferences for user accounts, group accounts, computers, and computer groups that are set up in a shared directory domain.

Dock Dock location, behavior, and items. For more information, see Managing Dock Preferences on page 174.

Energy Saver Performance options for Mac OS X client and server computers, battery usage for portable computers, and sleep or wake options. For more information, see Managing Energy Saver Preferences on page 177.

Finder Finder behavior, desktop appearance and items, and availability of Finder menu commands. For more information, see Managing Finder Preferences on page 182.

Login Login window appearance, mounted volumes, access control, scripts and items that automatically open. For more information, see Managing Login Preferences on page 189.

Media Access Settings for optical discs, internal and external disks, and disk images. For more information, see Managing Media Access Preferences on page 200.

Mobility Creation of mobile accounts at login and mobile account options. For more information, see Managing Mobility Preferences on page 202.

Network Configuration of specific proxy servers and settings for hosts and domains to bypass and disabling Internet Sharing, AirPort, and Bluetooth. For more information, see Managing Network Preferences on page 213.

Parental Controls Filter content or limit client computer usage. For more information, see Managing Parental Controls Preferences on page 217.

Printing Available printers, printer access, and page footers. For more information, see Managing Printing Preferences on page 220.

Software Update Specific server to use for software update service. For more information, see Managing Software Update Preferences on page 224.

System Preferences System preferences available to users. For more information, see Managing Access to System Preferences on page 224.

Time Machine Time Machine settings like backup server location, and coverage. For more information, see Managing Time Machine Preferences on page 225.

Universal Access Settings to control mouse and keyboard behavior, enhance display settings, and adjust sound or speech for users with special needs. For more information, see Managing Universal Access Preferences on page 227.

Preference pane What you can manage

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 157

A user whose account has defined preferences is referred to as a managed user. An individual computer, or a computer that is a member of a computer group with defined preferences, is called a managed computer. A group with defined preferences is called a workgroup.

Energy Saver, Time Machine, and Login preferences can be defined only for computers and computer groups, but other preferences can be defined for users, workgroups, computers, and computer groups.

There are three types of managed-preference interactions: Printing, Login, Applications, System Preferences, and some Dock preferences

(involving items that appear in the Dock) are considered combined. For example, if you define Printing preferences for users and computers, a users printer list includes printers set up for both the user and the computer used.

Other preferences defined at more than one level can be overridden at login. The illustration below shows how managed-preferences that override interact when the same preferences are set at multiple levels:

When preferences that override conflict, user preferences override computer, computer group, and group preferences. Computer preferences override computer group and group preferences. Computer group preferences override group preferences.

For example, lets say you have different managed Dock preferences for users, workgroups, computers, and computer groups. The Dock preferences for the user take precedence, overriding and nullifying Dock preferences set for computers, computer groups, or workgroups. If you do not manage Dock preferences for the user, the computer and computer group Dock preferences override and nullify group Dock preferences.

An example of when preferences that override might be useful is in a school environment where you want to prevent students from using recording devices attached to a school computer, except for students who serve as lab assistants.

Group Preferences

Computer Group Preferences

Computer Preferences

User Preferences

158 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

You could set up Media Access preferences for workgroups or computer groups to limit all students access but override these restrictions for lab assistants using Media Access settings at their user account level. You could also designate a specific computer for media recording by overriding the restrictions at the computer level.

Inherited preferences are preferences set at only one level. In some cases, you may find it easier and more useful to set certain preferences at only one level.

For example, you could set printer preferences only for computer groups, set application preferences only for workgroups, and set Dock preferences only for users. In this example, no overriding or combining occurs, and the user inherits the preferences without competition.

The illustration below shows how managed preferences interact when the same preferences are set at multiple levels.

Most of the time youll use workgroup-level and computer-group-level preferences: Workgroup preferences are most useful if you want to customize the work

environment (such as application visibility) for specific groups of users or if you want to use group folders. For example, a student may belong to a group called Class of 2011 for administrative purposes and to a workgroup called Students to limit application choices and provide a group shared folder for turning in homework. Another workgroup may be Teacher Prep, used to provide faculty members with access to folders and applications for their use only.

Computer-group-level preferences are useful when you want to manage preferences for users regardless of group associations. At the computer-group level, you might want to limit access to System Preferences, manage Energy Saver and Time Machine preferences, list particular users in the login window, and prevent the saving of files and applications to recordable discs.

Resulting Relationship

Overridden Inherited

Group

Computer Group

Combined

Computer

User

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 159

Computer group preferences also offer a way to manage the preferences of users who dont have a network account but who can log in to a Mac OS X computer using a local account. (The local account, defined using the Accounts pane of System Preferences, resides on the users computer.)

To manage local accounts, set up a computer group that supports local-only accounts. Preferences associated with the computer group and with any workgroup a user selects during login take effect.

Understanding Hierarchical Preference Management Mac OS X Server v10.5 or later includes managed hierarchical groupsgroups composed of nested groups, and computer groups composed of nested computer groups. By managing preferences for a parent group or computer group, child or computer groups also receive these managed preferences.

Child preferences take precedence and can override parent preferences. For example, Dock settings set for a child override Dock settings set for a parent.

Combined preferences come from the child and parent. For example, if you make a printer available for a parent group and a different printer available to a child group, a user who belongs to the child group can access both printers.

Be careful when creating situations where a child has several parents. If you dont manage an overriding preference for a child, but you have conflicting overriding preferences for several of the childs parents, it is hard to predict which parents preference takes precedence.

Combined preferences work even when children have several parents. The preferences of all parents combine with the childs preferences.

Dont make a child a parent of one of its parents. When you create a loopwhere a child is its own grandparentyou introduce unpredictable behavior.

Setting the Permanence of Management When you define preferences, you can manage them Always or Once. They are set to Never by default: Always causes the preferences to remain in effect until you change them on the

server. When properly designed, a Mac OS X application that conforms to standard preference conventions does not allow a user to modify preferences set to Always. You can use Always to ensure users cant add or remove Dock items. Some applications might allow the user to change the Always managed preference, but the next time the user logs back in, the preference reverts to the managed setting.

160 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

Once is available for some preferences. You can create default preferences, which users can then modify and keep the modifications. These preferences are effectively unmanaged. For example, you could set up a group of computers to display the Dock in a certain way the first time users log in. A user can change these preferences (youve set to Once) and the selected changes always apply to that user.

In the Overview Preference panes, you can set the following preferences to Once: Dock, Finder (Preferences and Views), Login (Login Items), Mobility (Login & Logout Sync and Background Sync panes of Rules), and Universal Access. For all other preferences, you must choose Always or Never.

Never lets a user control his or her preferences. However, some preference settings, such as Accounts and Date & Time, require a local administrators name and password before changes can be made. Never also means that the preferences are not managed at this account level but may be managed at a different account level. For example, even if you set the Dock preference to Never for a user, the Dock preference could still be managed at the group or computer level.

Note: When using the preference editor (the Details view in the Preferences pane), you can set preferences to Often. Often settings are similar to Once settings, but are reapplied at every login. This management setting is useful for training environments. Users can customize their preferences to suit their needs during a session without any risk of affecting a future users work experience. Some applications only respond to preference management set to Often.

Caching Preferences Preferences are cached on Mac OS X computers so they remain in effect even when the computer is off the network. With Mac OS X v10.5 and later, the preferences cache is automatically managed: Computer preferences and preferences for any workgroups that can use the

computer are cached. User preferences are always cached for users who have mobile accounts.

When a computer is off the network, only users with local accounts or network users with mobile accounts on that computer can log in.

Preference Management Basics In Workgroup Manager, information about users, groups, computers, and computer groups is integrated with directory services. After you set up the accounts, you can manage preferences for them.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 161

Managing preferences means you can control settings for certain system preferences in addition to controlling user access to system preferences, applications, printers, and removable media.

Information about settings and preferences in user, group, or computer records is stored in a directory domain accessible to Workgroup Manager, such as an Open Directory domain.

Preferences are stored in a record, which is either a user, group, or computer record. During login, the managed client combines them into a management list that is applied to the user experience.

After user accounts, group accounts, computer accounts, and computer groups are created, you can manage preferences for them using the Preferences pane in Workgroup Manager.

To manage preferences for Mac OS X clients, make sure that each user you want to manage has a network home folder or a local home folder on the server.

For information about how to set up home folders for users, see Chapter 7, Setting Up Home Folders.

Note: When you manage preferences for a user, group, or computer, an arrow icon appears next to the managed preference in the Preferences pane to indicate that youre managing that preference. You can select multiple users, groups, or computers to review managed preferences. If the arrow icon is dimmed, it means managed preference settings are mixed for the selected items.

Managing User Preferences You can manage preferences for users as needed. However, if you have large numbers of users, it may be more efficient to manage most preferences by group and computer. You might want to manage preferences at the user level only for specific individuals, such as directory domain administrators, teachers, or technical staff.

Consider which preferences you want to leave under user control. For example, if you arent concerned about where a user places the Dock, you might want to set Dock Display management to Never or Once.

To manage user preferences: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Click the Users button and select one or more user accounts from the list.

4 Click the icon for the preference you want to manage.

162 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

5 In each Preference pane, select a Manage option.

In Media Access, the management setting applies to all preferences rather than to individual panes.

6 Select preference settings or fill in information you want to use.

Some management settings are not available for some preferences, and some preferences are not available for some types of accounts.

7 When you finish, click Apply Now.

Managing Group Preferences Group preferences are shared among all users in the group. Setting some preferences only for groups instead of for each user can save time, especially when you have large numbers of managed users.

Because users can select a workgroup at login, they can choose a group with managed settings appropriate to the current task, location, or environment. It can be more efficient to set preferences once for a single group instead of setting preferences for each member of the group.

To manage group preferences: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Click the Groups button and select one or more group accounts from the list.

4 Click the icon for the preference you want to manage.

5 In each preference pane, select a Manage option.

In Media Access, the management setting applies to all preferences rather than to individual panes.

6 Select preference settings or fill in information you want to use.

Some management settings are not available for some preferences, and some preferences are not available for some types of accounts.

7 Click Apply Now.

Managing Computer Preferences Computer preferences are preferences set for individual computers.

Energy Saver and Time Machine preferences can be managed for computers and computer groups, but not for users or groups.

To manage computer preferences: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 163

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Click the Computers button and select one or more computers.

4 Click the icon for the preference you want to manage.

5 In each preference pane, select a Manage option.

In Media Access, the management setting applies to all preferences rather than to individual panes.

6 Select preference settings or fill in information you want to use.

Some management settings are not available for some preferences, and some preferences are not available for some types of accounts.

7 Click Apply Now.

Managing Computer Group Preferences Computer preferences are shared among all computers in a computer group. In some cases, it is more useful to manage preferences for computers rather than users or groups.

Energy Saver and Time Machine preferences can be managed for computers and computer groups, but not for users or groups.

To manage computer group preferences: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Click the Computer Groups button and select one or more computer groups.

4 Click the icon for the preference you want to manage.

5 In each preference pane, select a Manage option.

In Media Access, the management setting applies to all preferences rather than to individual panes.

6 Select preference settings or fill in information you want to use.

Some management settings are not available for some preferences, and some preferences are not available for some types of accounts.

7 Click Apply Now.

Disabling Management for Specific Preferences After you set managed preferences for an account, you can turn off management for specific preference panes by changing the management setting to Never.

164 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

You can use the Once setting to create default settings. These are settings that, when saved, take effect the next time users log in. Users can then modify their settings and save their modified settings for future use.

To selectively disable preference management: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click the icon for a preference that is being managed.

5 In the pane with the preferences you no longer want to manage, select Never.

In Media Access, the management setting applies to all preferences rather than to individual panes.

6 Click Apply Now.

Setting the management setting to Never disables management for the current level in the users, computers, or groups hierarchy. Preferences can still be managed at a different level.

When you change the preference management settings, the new settings apply to all items in the active preference pane. To disable all management for an individual preference (for example, Dock), make sure the management setting is set to Never in each pane of that preference.

Managing Access to Applications Use Applications preferences to allow or restrict user access to applications.

Computers identify applications using one of two methods: digital signatures (used in Mac OS X v10.5 or later), and bundle IDs (used in Mac OS X v10.4 or earlier, but can be used in Mac OS X v10.5 or later).

Digital signatures are much more secure because clever users can manipulate bundle IDs. Workgroup Manager supports the use of both methods.

Use the Applications pane to work with digital signatures. Use the Legacy pane to work with bundle IDs.

Application restrictions depend on which pane youre managing and the version of Mac OS X run by client computers: If you manage the Applications pane and your users run Mac OS X v10.5 or later,

Applications settings take effect and Legacy settings are ignored.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 165

If you dont manage the Applications pane, Legacy settings take effect for any version of Mac OS X.

If your users run Mac OS X v10.4 or earlier, only Legacy settings take effect.

You can also use settings in Applications preferences to allow only specific widgets in Dashboard or to disable Front Row.

The table below describes what the settings in each Applications pane can do.

Controlling User Access to Specific Applications and Folders You can use Workgroup Manager to prevent users from launching unapproved applications or applications located in unapproved folders.

In Mac OS X v10.4 or earlier, applications were identified by their bundle IDs. If your users have Mac OS X v10.5 or later installed, you can use digital signatures to identify applications. Digital signatures are much more difficult to circumvent than a bundle ID.

Workgroup Manager can sign applications that arent already signed. When signing an application, you can embed a signature or you can store a detached signature separate from the application.

Embedding a signature has several performance benefits over a detached signature, but with signature embedding you must make sure every computer has the same signed application. For applications that are run from a CD, DVD, or other read-only media, you must use detached signatures.

Workgroup Manager uses the following icons to denote the kind of signature associated with an application.

Applications preference pane What you can control

Applications Access to specific applications and paths to applications using digital signatures (for users of Mac OS X v10.5 or later)

Widgets List of allowed Dashboard widgets for users of Mac OS X v10.5

Front Row Whether Front Row is allowed

Legacy Access to specific applications and paths to applications using bundle IDs (primarily for users of Mac OS X v10.4 or earlier)

Icon Indicates the application has this type of signature

(no icon) Embedded signature

Detached signature

No signature

166 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

Applications that include helper applications are denoted by a disclosure triangle. When you click the disclosure triangle, youll see a list of helper applications. By default, these helper applications are allowed to open.

You can disable individual helper applications, but the application may behave erratically if it requires the helper applications.

To allow or prevent users from launching an application, add the application or application path to one of three lists: Always allow these applications. Add applications that should always be allowed,

regardless of their inclusion in other lists. You can sign applications added to this list. Dont add unsigned applications to this list because they allow users to disguise unapproved applications as approved applications.

Disallow applications within these folders. Add applications and folders containing applications you want to prevent users from opening. All applications in the subfolders of a disallowed folder are also disallowed. Disallowing a folder within an application package can cause the application to behave erratically or fail to load.

Allow applications within these folders. Add applications and folders containing applications you want to allow. All applications in the subfolders of an allowed folder are also allowed. Unlike applications in the Always allow these applications list, applications listed here are not allowed if they or their paths are listed in the Disallow applications within these folders list.

If an application or its folder doesnt appear in these lists, the user cant open the application.

Note: Some applications dont fully support signatures. To make sure a signed application is properly restricted, make a copy of the application, sign it, and move it to a location in the Disallow applications within these folders list (when you try to open the application on a managed computer, it should open because the signature is valid). Next, void the signed applications signature by copying a file into its application package. Now when you try to open the application on a managed computer, it should not open because the signature is void and the application is in a disallowed folder.

To allow users to open specific applications and folders: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Applications and then click the Applications tab.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 167

6 Select Restrict which applications are allowed to launch.

7 Click the Applications tab (within the Applications pane), click the Add (+) button, choose an application you want to always allow, and then click Add.

When you allow an application, you also allow all helper applications included with that application. You can deselect helper applications to disallow them.

8 If youre asked to sign the application, click Sign; if youre asked to authenticate, authenticate as a local administrator.

To add the application to the list as an unsigned application, click Dont Sign.

When you sign the application, Workgroup Manager tries to embed the signature. If you dont have write access to the application, Workgroup Manager creates a detached signature.

9 Click the Folders tab, click the Add (+) button next to Disallow applications within these folders, and then choose folders containing applications you want to prevent users from launching.

10 Click the Add (+) button next to the Allow applications within these folders field and choose folders containing applications you want to allow.

Disallowing folders takes precedence over allowing them. If you allow a folder that is a subfolder of a disallowed folder, the subfolder is still disallowed.

11 Click Apply Now.

Allowing Specific Dashboard Widgets If your users have Mac OS X v10.5 or later installed, you can prevent them from opening unapproved Dashboard widgets by creating a list of approved widgets (which can include widgets included with Mac OS X and third-party widgets). To approve third- party widgets, you must be able to access them from your server.

To allow specific Dashboard widgets: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Applications and then click Widgets.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select Allow only the following Dashboard widgets to run.

7 To allow specific widgets, click the Add (+) button, select the widgets .wdgt file, and then click Add.

The widgets included with Mac OS X are in /Library/Widgets.

168 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

8 To prevent users from opening specific widgets, select the widget and click the Remove () button.

9 Click Apply Now.

Disabling Front Row With Workgroup Manager, you can disable Front Row.

To disable Front Row: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Applications and then click Front Row.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Deselect Allow Front Row.

7 Click Apply Now.

Allowing Legacy Users to Open Specific Applications and Folders To control user access to applications in Mac OS X v10.4 or earlier, you either: Provide access to a set of approved applications that users can open Prevent users from opening a set of unapproved applications

You can also set additional options to further control user access to applications.

When users have access to local volumes, they can access applications on the computers local hard disk. If you dont want to allow this, you can disable local volume access.

Applications use helper applications for tasks they cant complete independently. For example, if a user tries to open a web link in a mail message, the mail application might need to open a web browser to display the webpage.

Disallowing helper applications improves security because an application can designate any other application as a helper application. However, you may want to include common helper applications in the approved applications list. This avoids problems such as users being unable to open and view mail content or attached files.

Occasionally, applications or the operating system might require the use of UNIX tools, such as QuickTime Image Converter. These tools cant be accessed directly, and generally operate in the background without the users knowledge. If you disallow access to UNIX tools, some applications may not work.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 169

Allowing UNIX tools enhances application compatibility and efficient operation, but may decrease security.

If you dont manage Applications settings for computers running Mac OS X v10.5 or later, Legacy settings are used.

To set up a list of accessible applications: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Applications and then click Legacy.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select User can only open these applications or User can open all applications except these.

7 Add items to and remove items from the list.

To select multiple items, hold down the Command key.

8 To allow access to applications stored on the users local hard disk, select User can also open all applications on local volumes.

9 To allow helper applications, select Allow approved applications to launch non- approved applications.

10 To allow use of UNIX tools, select Allow UNIX tools to run.

11 Click Apply Now.

Managing Classic Preferences You use Classic Preferences to set Classic startup options, assign a Classic System Folder, set sleep options for the Classic environment, and make specific Apple menu items available to users.

The Classic System Folder is a Mac OS 9 System Folder that contains the Mac OS 9 operating system. When users run Classic applications, they are running Mac OS 9 from the Classic System Folder.

Classic can be run on Mac OS X v10.4 or earlier.

170 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

The table below describes what settings in each Classic pane can do.

Selecting Classic Startup Options Workgroup Manager provides a number of ways to control how and when the Classic environment starts.

If users often work with applications that run in Classic, it is convenient to have Classic start up immediately when a user logs in. If users rarely need Classic, you can have Classic start only when a user opens a Classic application or a document that requires such an application.

You can also choose to display an alert when Classic starts, giving users the option to cancel Classic startup.

To work with various startup options for Classic: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Classic and then click Startup.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 To start Classic immediately when a user logs in, select Start up Classic at login.

When Classic starts up at login, the startup window is hidden and the user cant cancel Classic startup.

If users rarely use Classic, you can deselect this option and Classic starts up when a user opens a document or an application that requires it. In this case, the Classic startup window is visible to users and they can cancel Classic startup.

7 To show an alert dialog only when Classic starts after a user attempts to open a Classic application or document, select Warn at Classic startup.

If users manually start Classic, or Classic automatically starts up at login, the warning is not shown.

Users can allow Classic startup to continue or they can cancel the process. If you dont want to allow users to interrupt Classic startup, deselect this option.

Classic preference pane What you can control

Startup Which folder is the Classic System Folder and what occurs when Classic starts

Advanced Items in the Apple menu, Classic sleep settings, and the users ability to turn off extensions or rebuild the Classic desktop file during startup

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 171

8 Click Apply Now.

Choosing a Classic System Folder In most cases, there is only one Mac OS 9 System Folder on a computer, and it is on the Mac OS X startup disk. In this case, you dont need to specify a Classic System Folder.

If a computer has multiple Mac OS 9 System Folders on the startup disk and you havent set a specific path to one folder, users receive an error message and cant use Classic.

If there is more than one Mac OS 9 System Folder on a computers startup disk, or if you want to use a Mac OS 9 System Folder on a different disk, enforce the use of a specific folder when Classic is in use. It is important if you specify a path to the folders location that all clients have the Mac OS 9 System Folder in the same relative location on their hard disks.

If multiple Mac OS 9 System Folders are available and you dont enforce settings in the Startup pane of the Classic preference, users can choose from among available Mac OS 9 System Folders (if they have access to the Classic pane of System Preferences).

To choose a specific Classic System Folder: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Classic and then click Startup.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 In the Use this System Folder when Classic starts field, enter the path to the Classic System Folder (for example, /Volumes/VolumeName/System Folder/), or click Choose and then browse to the folder you want.

Make sure the path to the Classic System Folder on the client computer is the same as the path to the Classic System Folder on the administrator computer.

7 Click Apply Now.

Allowing Special Actions During Restart If managed users have access to the Classic pane of System Preferences, they can click the Start/Restart button in the Classic pane to start or restart Classic.

172 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

You can allow users to perform special actions, such as turning off extensions, starting or restarting Classic, or rebuilding the Classic desktop file, from the Advanced pane of Classic system preferences. You might want to allow this for specific users, such as members of your technical staff.

To allow special actions during restart: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Classic and then click Advanced.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select Allow special startup modes.

7 To allow users to rebuild the Classic desktop file, select Allow user to rebuild Desktop.

Deselecting this option disables the Rebuild Desktop button in the Advanced pane of Classic system preferences.

8 Click Apply Now.

Controlling Access to Classic Apple Menu Items Classic managed preference options allow you to control access to certain items in the Classic Apple menu, including Mac OS 9 control panels, the Chooser and Network Browser, and other Apple menu items. You can show or hide all, some, or none of these items in the Apple menu.

If an item is hidden, users cant access that item from the Apple menu. However, there may be alternative methods of access, such as starting the Chooser by navigating to it in the Mac OS 9 System Folder.

If you want to further limit user access to these items, you can use the Applications preferences in Workgroup Manager to specify which applications a user can or cant open. For more information, see Managing Access to Applications on page 164.

Note: Disallowing access to the Chooser can affect what happens when a user attempts to print from Classic (if printer management is also enforced). If users cant access the Chooser, they cant set up new printers or switch between types of printers (such as PostScript and non-PostScript printers).

To hide or show items in the Apple menu: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 173

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Classic.

5 Click Advanced and then set the management setting to Always.

6 To remove the Chooser and Network Browser from the Apple menu, select Hide Chooser and Network Browser.

Deselect this option to show Chooser and Network Browser.

7 To remove Control Panels from the Apple menu, select Hide Control Panels.

Deselect this option to show Control Panels.

8 To hide remaining Apple menu items, select Hide other Apple Menu Items.

This group includes items such as Calculator, Key Caps, and Recent Applications. Deselect this option to show these Apple menu items.

9 Click Apply Now.

Adjusting Classic Sleep Settings When no Classic applications are open, Classic enters sleep mode to reduce the use of system resources. You can adjust the amount of time Classic waits before going to sleep after a user quits the last Classic application. If Classic is in sleep mode, opening a Classic application might take a little longer.

In some circumstances, you might need to use applications that operate in the background without the users interaction or knowledge. If a background application is in use when Classic enters sleep mode, that application suspends its activity. If you want to keep the application running, you can set the Classic sleep setting to Never.

To adjust Classic sleep settings: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Classic.

5 Click Advanced and then set the management setting to Always.

6 Drag the slider to set the length of time Classic waits before going to sleep.

If you dont want Classic to go to sleep at all, drag the slider to Never.

7 Click Apply Now.

174 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

Maintaining Consistent User Preferences for Classic Ordinarily, Classic looks for a users Mac OS 9 preferences data in the Mac OS 9 System Folder. If a user has more than one computer, or if multiple users work on the same computer, make sure Classic uses preferences from the Home folder in ~/Library/ Classic/ so that preferences remain consistent for each user.

If you choose not to use preferences in the users Home folder, a users Mac OS 9 data is stored in the Mac OS 9 System Folder and is not kept separate from other user data. In this case, users share preferences and changes made by the last user are in effect when the next user logs in.

To choose where Classic user preferences are stored: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Classic.

5 Click Advanced and then set the management setting to Always.

6 To maintain consistent Classic preferences, select Use preferences from home folder.

Deselect this option to use the local Mac OS 9 System Folder for all Classic user preferences.

7 Click Apply Now.

Managing Dock Preferences Dock settings allow you to adjust the behavior of the users Dock and specify what items appear in it.

The table below describes what settings in each Dock pane can do.

Controlling the Users Dock Dock settings allow you to adjust the position of the Dock on the desktop and change the Docks size. You can also control animated Dock behaviors.

To set how the Dock looks and behaves: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

Dock preference pane What you can control

Dock Items Items and their position in a users Dock

Dock Display The Docks position and behavior

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 175

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Dock and then click Dock Display.

5 Set the management setting to Once or Always.

6 Drag the Dock Size slider to make the Dock smaller or larger.

7 If you want items in the Dock to be magnified when a user moves the pointer over them, select Magnification and then adjust the slider.

Magnification is useful if you have many items in the Dock.

8 From the Position on screen radio buttons, select whether to place the Dock on the left, right, or bottom of the desktop.

9 From the Minimize using pop-up menu, choose a minimizing effect.

10 If you dont want to use animated icons in the Dock when an application opens, deselect Animate opening applications.

11 If you dont want the Dock to be visible all the time, select Automatically hide and show the Dock.

When the user moves the pointer to the edge of the screen where the Dock is located, the Dock appears.

12 Click Apply Now.

Providing Easy Access to Group Folders After you have set up a group volume, you can make it easy for users to locate the group folder by placing an alias in the users Dock. The group folder contains the groups Library folder, Documents folder, and Public folder (including a drop box). If you need help setting up a group share point, see Creating a Group Folder on page 101.

If the group folder is not available when the user clicks the group folder icon, the user must enter a user name and password to connect to the server and open the directory.

Note: This preference setting applies only to groups. You cant manage this setting for users or computers.

To add a Dock item for a group folder: 1 If you havent set up a group share point, do so before proceeding.

2 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

3 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click the Groups button and select one or more group accounts from the list.

176 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

5 Click Dock and then click Dock Items.

6 Set the management setting to Once or Always.

If you select Once, the group folder icon appears in the users Dock initially, but the user can remove it.

7 Select Add group folder.

8 Click Apply Now.

If you change the location of the group share point, update the Dock item for the group in Workgroup Manager.

Adding Items to a Users Dock You can add applications, folders, or documents to a users Dock for easy access.

Make sure you use consistent paths for items you add in the Dock. This is especially important if you add items in nonstandard locations (for example, putting an application in another folder besides /Applications). If the Dock item cant be found, a question mark replaces the item in the users Dock.

To add items to a users Dock: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Dock and then click Dock Items.

5 Set the management setting to Once or Always.

If you select Once, the user can add and remove Dock items. If you select Always, the user cant remove items from the Dock.

6 To add individual applications, folders, and documents to the Dock, click the Add (+) button to browse and select the item you want.

To remove a Dock item, select it and then click the Remove () button.

You can rearrange Dock items in the list by dragging them into the order in which you want them to appear. Applications are always grouped at one end, while folders and files are grouped at the other. User-added items are located after your listed applications.

7 To add the My Applications folder, select My Applications.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 177

The My Applications folder contains aliases for approved applications listed in the Applications preference pane. If you do not manage the Applications preference, available applications are shown. If you enable Simple Finder, you should display the My Applications folder.

8 To add the Documents folder, select Documents.

The Documents folder is located in the users home folder.

9 To add the Network Home folder, select Network Home.

The Network Home folder is the network home folder for users with network accounts. For users of mobile accounts, selecting Network Home adds the users network home folder (not the users local home folder) to the Dock.

10 To replace the users current Dock with your selected items, deselect Merge with users Dock.

11 After you finish adding Dock items, click Apply Now.

Preventing Users from Adding or Deleting Dock Items Ordinarily, users can add items to their own Docks, but you can prevent this. Users cant remove items you add to the Dock when Always (Manage these settings) is selected.

To prevent users from adding items to their Docks: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Dock and then click Dock Items.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Deselect Merge with users Dock.

7 Click Apply Now.

Managing Energy Saver Preferences Energy Saver preference settings help you save energy and battery power by managing wake, sleep, and restart timing for servers and client computers.

You can configure Energy Saver preferences for desktop and portable computers. Desktop and portable computers differ in that portable computers can run on battery power.

178 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

The table below summarizes what you can control with settings in each Energy Saver pane.

Using Sleep and Wake Settings for Desktop Computers Putting a computer to sleep saves energy because it turns off the display and stops the hard disk from running. Waking up from sleep is faster than starting up your computer.

You can use the Energy Saver preference settings to put computers to sleep after a specified period of inactivity. Other settings enable you to wake or restart the computer when certain events happen.

To set sleep and wake settings: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more computers or computer groups.

4 Click Energy Saver and then click Desktop.

5 From the OS pop-up menu, choose Mac OS X or Mac OS X Server and set the management setting to Always.

6 To adjust sleep settings, choose Sleep from the Settings pop-up menu and do the following:

Energy Saver preference pane What you can control

Desktop Sleep timing for the computer, display, hard disks, and wake and restart options for Mac OS X and Mac OS X Server

Portable Processor performance setting, sleep timing similar to Desktop, and wake and restart options for adapter and battery power sources

Battery Menu Display of the battery status indicator

Schedule Regular schedules for startup or shutdown

To do this Do this

Set the length of time the desktop computer waits to enter sleep mode

Move the Put the computer to sleep when it is inactive for slider. The computer does not enter sleep mode if the slider is set to Never. The default setting for Mac OS X is 10 minutes. The default setting for Mac OS X Server is Never.

Use a different time interval for the computers display

Select Put the display to sleep when the computer is inactive for and move the slider. The interval cant be longer than the computers sleep setting. The default setting for Mac OS X is five minutes. The default setting for Mac OS X Server is 30 minutes.

Put the hard disks to sleep during periods of inactivity

Select Put the hard disk(s) to sleep when possible.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 179

7 To set wake and restart settings, choose Options from the Settings pop-up menu and do the following:

8 Click Apply Now.

To manually wake up a sleeping computer or display, the user can click the mouse or press a key on the keyboard.

Setting Energy Saver Settings for Portable Computers You can use Energy Saver Portable settings to vary sleep and wake responses, in addition to processor performance settings, depending upon what power source a portable computer is using (either an adapter or a battery). You can also set the computer to restart if power suddenly fails.

To manage portable computer settings: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more computers or computer groups.

4 Click Energy Saver and then click Portable.

5 From the Power Source pop-up menu, choose Adapter or Battery and set the management setting to Always.

To do this Do this

Wake the computer when the modem is activated

Select Wake when the modem detects a ring.

Wake the computer when an administrator attempts remote access

Select Wake for Ethernet network administrator access.

Alllow users to press the power button (without holding it down for a prolonged period) to put the computer in sleep mode

(For client computers with Mac OS X v10.3 or later) Select Allow power button to sleep the computer.

Make sure the computer restarts if the power fails

Select Restart automatically after a power failure. Deselect this option to disable automatic restart.

180 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

6 To adjust sleep settings, choose Sleep from the Settings pop-up menu and do the following:

7 To set wake and restart settings, choose Options from the Settings pop-up menu and do the following:

8 Click Apply Now.

To manually wake up a sleeping computer or display, users can click the mouse or press a key on the keyboard.

Displaying Battery Status to Users Portable computers use a battery as a direct power source while disconnected from external power or as a backup power source while connected to external power.

When battery power is too low for the computer to function, the computer puts itself to sleep to conserve energy. When a user reconnects the computer to a functional power source (for example, by inserting a fresh battery or connecting a power adapter), the user can wake the computer and begin working again.

To do this Do this

Set the length of time the desktop computer waits to enter sleep mode

Move the Put the computer to sleep when it is inactive for slider. The computer does not enter sleep mode if the slider is set to Never. The default setting for adapter power supplies is 10 minutes. The default setting for battery power supplies is five minutes.

Use a different time interval for the computers display

Select Put the display to sleep when the computer is inactive for and move the slider. The interval cant be longer than the computers sleep setting. The default setting for battery and adapter power supplies is five minutes.

Put the hard disks to sleep during periods of inactivity

Select Put the hard disk(s) to sleep when possible.

To do this Do this

Wake the computer when the modem is activated

Select Wake when the modem detects a ring.

Wake the computer when an administrator attempts remote access

Select Wake for Ethernet network administrator access.

Make sure the computer restarts if the power fails

Select Restart automatically after a power failure. Deselect this option to disable automatic restart.

Choose the level of processor performance

In the Processor Performance pop-up menu, select Highest, Automatic, or Reduced. For computers using an adapter, the recommended setting is Highest. For computers using a battery, the recommended setting is Automatic.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 181

Users should be encouraged to monitor battery status when not connected to external power and use a power adapter when possible to maintain a fully charged battery.

To show battery status in the menu bar: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more computers or computer groups.

4 Click Energy Saver and then click Battery Menu.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 To display the battery status, select Show battery status in the menu bar; to disable the battery status, deselect this option.

7 Click Apply Now.

Scheduling Automatic Startup, Shutdown, or Sleep You can schedule when computers start up, shut down, or sleep at specific times on specific days of the week. Scheduling shutdown or sleep can help you conserve energy during predictable times of user inactivity, such as after business hours, on weekends, or after a class is finished. Scheduling startup automatically allows you to conveniently prepare a lab or classroom for immediate use.

To schedule automatic actions: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more computers or computer groups.

4 Click Energy Saver and then click Schedule.

5 From the OS pop-up menu, choose Mac OS X or Mac OS X Server and set the management setting to Always.

6 To schedule automatic startup, select Start up the computer, choose a day or range of days (Weekdays, Weekends, or Every Day) from the pop-up menu, and then enter a time in the time field.

To disable scheduled startup, deselect this option.

7 To schedule automatic sleep or shutdown, select the checkbox, choose Sleep or Shut Down from the pop-up menu, choose a day or range of days (Weekdays, Weekends, or Every Day) from the pop-up menu, and then enter a time in the time field.

To disable scheduled sleep or shutdown, deselect this option.

182 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

8 Click Apply Now.

Managing Finder Preferences You can control various aspects of Finder menus and windows, which can help improve or control workflow.

For example, you can simplify the user experience by enabling Simple Finder. You can also prevent users from writing to or ejecting disks.

The table below summarizes what you can do with each Finder preference pane.

Setting Up Simple Finder You can select the normal Finder or Simple Finder as the user environment: The normal Finder looks and acts like the standard Mac OS X desktop. Simple Finder removes the ability to use a Finder window to access applications or

modify files. This limits users access to only what is in the Dock.

If you enable Simple Finder, users cant mount network volumes, create folders, or delete files.

In addition to using Workgroup Manager, you can use System Preferences to set up Simple Finder on a local computer. When you use Workgroup Manager to apply the Simple Finder environment and the feature is not in use on the local computer, only the clients Finder is affected. Dock and Application access settings must be managed separately.

You can set up Simple Finder on the local computer and use the application and Dock management features in Workgroup Manager to add Dock items and application access.

Important: Dont turn on Simple Finder for users who run Mac OS X v10.2 through v10.2.8 and log in to a workgroup with its own group folder. These users cant use applications because Simple Finder prevents access to the group folder.

Finder preference pane What you can control

Preferences Finder window behavior, Simple Finder, whether open items appear on the desktop, filename extension visibility, and the Empty Trash warning.

Commands Whether commands in Finder menus and the Apple menu are available to users. These allow users to perform tasks such as connecting to servers or restarting the computer.

Views Allow you to adjust the arrangement and appearance of items on a users desktop, in Finder windows, and in the top-level folder of the computer.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 183

To turn on Simple Finder: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Finder, click the Preferences tab, and then select a management setting.

If you select Always, choose Use normal Finder or Use Simple Finder.

If you select Once, the account uses only the normal Finder.

5 Click Apply Now.

Keeping Disks and Servers from Appearing on the Users Desktop Normally when a user inserts an external disk, that disks icon appears on the desktop. Icons for local hard disks or disk partitions and mounted server volumes are also visible. If you dont want users to see these items on the desktop, you can hide them.

Disks and servers still appear in the top-level folder when a user clicks the Computer icon in a Finder windows toolbar.

To hide disk and server icons on the desktop: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Finder, click the Preferences tab, and then select a management setting.

5 Under Show these items on the Desktop, deselect the items you want to hide.

6 Click Apply Now.

Controlling the Behavior of Finder Windows You can select which folder appears when a user opens a new Finder window. You can also define how contents are displayed when a user opens folders.

To set Finder window preferences: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

184 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

4 Click Finder, click the Preferences tab, and then select a management setting.

5 Under New Finder window shows, choose the default folder for the Finder window.

Select Home to show items in the users home folder.

Select Computer to show the top-level folder, which includes local disks and mounted volumes.

6 To display folder contents in a separate window when a user opens a folder, select Always open folders in a new window.

Normally, Mac OS X users can browse through a series of folders using a single Finder window.

7 To maintain a consistent view across windows, select Always open windows in column view.

8 Click Apply Now.

Hiding the Alert Message When a User Empties the Trash Normally, a warning appears when a user empties the Trash. If you dont want users to see this message, you can turn it off.

To hide the Trash warning message: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Finder, click the Preferences tab, and then select a management setting.

5 Deselect Show warning before emptying the Trash.

6 Click Apply Now.

Making Filename Extensions Visible A filename extension usually appears at the end of a filename (for example, .txt or .jpg). Applications use the filename extension to identify the file type.

To make filename extensions visible: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Finder, click the Preferences tab, and then select a management setting.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 185

5 Select Always show file extensions.

6 Click Apply Now.

Controlling User Access to Remote Servers Users can connect to a remote server by choosing the Connect to Server command in the Finder Go menu and providing the servers name or IP address. If you dont want users to access this menu item, you can hide the command.

To hide the Connect to Server command: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Finder, click Commands, and then set the management setting to Always.

5 Deselect Connect to Server.

6 Click Apply Now.

Controlling User Access to an iDisk If users want to connect to an iDisk, they can choose the Go to iDisk command in the Finder Go menu. If you dont want users to access this menu item, you can hide the command.

To hide the Go to iDisk command: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Finder, click Commands, and then set the management setting to Always.

5 Deselect Go to iDisk.

6 Click Apply Now.

Preventing Users from Ejecting Discs If you dont want users to be able to eject discs (for example, CDs, DVDs, floppy disks, or FireWire drives), you can hide the Eject command in the Finder File menu.

To hide the Eject command: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

186 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Finder, click Commands, and then set the management setting to Always.

5 Deselect Eject.

6 Click Apply Now.

Hiding the Burn Disc Command in the Finder On computers with appropriate hardware, users can burn discs (write information to recordable CDs or DVDs). If you dont want users to have this ability, you can hide the Burn Disc command in the Finder File menu.

To prevent users from using or burning recordable CDs or DVDs, use settings in the Media Access panes. For more information, see Managing Media Access Preferences on page 200.

Only computers with a CD-RW drive, Combo Drive, or SuperDrive can burn CDs. The Burn Disc command works only with CD-R, CD-RW, or DVD-R discs. Only a SuperDrive can burn DVD-R discs.

To hide the Burn Disc command: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Finder, click Commands, and then set the management setting to Always.

5 Deselect Burn Disc.

6 Click Apply Now.

Controlling User Access to Folders Users can open a specific folder by choosing the Go to Folder command in the Finder Go menu and providing the folders pathname. If you dont want users to have this ability, you can hide the command.

To hide the Go to Folder command: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 187

4 Click Finder, click Commands, and then set the management setting to Always.

5 Deselect Go to Folder.

6 Click Apply Now.

Removing Restart and Shut Down from the Apple Menu If you dont want to allow users to restart or shut down the computer theyre using, you can remove the Restart and Shut Down commands from the Apple menu.

To hide the Restart and Shut Down commands: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Finder, click Commands, and then set the management setting to Always.

5 Deselect Restart and Shut Down.

6 Click Apply Now.

As an additional preventive measure, you can remove the Restart and Shut Down buttons from the login window by using settings in Login preferences. For instructions, see Changing the Appearance of the Login Window on page 189.

Adjusting the Appearance and Arrangement of Desktop Items Items on a users desktop appear as icons. You can control the size of desktop icons and how theyre arranged.

To set preferences for the desktop view: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Finder, click Views, and then select a management setting.

The management setting applies to options in all three views.

5 Click Desktop View and then drag the Icon Size slider to adjust the icon size.

6 To keep items aligned in rows and columns, select Snap to grid.

7 To arrange items by criteria such as name or type (for example, all folders grouped together), select Keep arranged by and then choose a method from the pop-up menu.

188 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

8 Click Apply Now.

Adjusting the Appearance of Finder Window Contents Items in Finder windows can be viewed in a list or as icons. You can control aspects of how these items look, as well as whether to show the toolbar in a Finder window.

Default View settings control the overall appearance of all Finder windows. Computer View settings control the view for the top-level computer folder, showing hard disks and disk partitions, external hard drives, mounted volumes, and removable media (such as CDs or DVDs).

To set preferences for Default and Computer Views: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Finder, click Views, and then set the management setting to Once or Always.

This setting applies to options in all three views.

5 Click Default View or Computer View.

Available settings are similar for both views.

6 Drag the Icon Size slider to adjust the icon size.

7 To keep icons aligned in rows and columns, select Snap to grid.

Arranging icons in a grid prevents icons from overlapping.

8 To sort icons, select Keep arranged by and then choose a method from the pop-up menu.

You can arrange items by name, creation or modification date, size, or kind (for example, all folders grouped together).

9 Adjust List View settings.

If you select Use relative dates, an items creation or modification date is displayed as Today instead of 3/24/05.

If you select Calculate folder sizes, the computer calculates the total size of each folder shown in a Finder window. This can take some time if a folder is very large.

10 Select a size for icons in a list.

11 Click Apply Now.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 189

Managing Login Preferences Use Login preferences to set options for user login, to provide password hints, and to control the users ability to restart and shut down the computer from the login window. You can also mount a group volume or set applications to open when a user logs in.

The table below summarizes what you can do with settings in each Login pane.

Scripts, Login Window, and Options can be managed for computers only, not for users or groups.

Changing the Appearance of the Login Window You can easily change the appearance of a computers login window. These settings include the login windows heading message, which users are listed and how, and the display of the restart and shut down buttons. These settings apply only to computers and computer groups.

When you display a list of users, you can choose which types of users to list. The effect of these settings depend on the version of Mac OS X installed on client computers.

Login preference pane What you can control

Window For computers and computer groups only: The appearance of the login window such as the heading, message, which users are listed if the List of users is specified, and the ability to restart or shut down

Options For computers and computer groups only: Login window options like enabling password hints, automatic login, console, fast user switching, inactivity log out, disabling of management, setting the computer name to match the computer record, external account login

Access For computers and computer groups only: Who can log in, if local users can use workgroup settings, and the combination and selection of workgroups

Scripts For computers and computer groups only: Specify a script to run during login or logout and whether to execute or disable the client computers own LoginHook or LogoutHook scripts

Items Access to the group volume, which applications open automatically for the user; and if users can add or remove login items

List setting Mac OS X version Effect

Show local users 10.4 Lists local accounts and mobile accounts with a local home folder

Show local users 10.5 Lists local accounts

Show mobile accounts 10.4 N/A

190 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

The directory administrator account is considered a network account, and is therefore hidden when you dont show network users. Another way to hide this account would be to set the directory administrator accounts user ID to below 100. For more information, see Modifying User IDs on page 67.

You can customize the login window to suit your needs.

For example, to test a computers ability to access the directory domain you could change the heading to Directory status and display a list of network users.

Or, to prevent unauthorized access, you could create a warning message, display the name and password fields (forcing intruders to know a users name and password), and disable showing the Restart and Shut Down buttons (to help prevent intruders from bypassing the login window).

To change the appearance of the Login Window: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more computers or computer groups.

4 Click Login and then click Window.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 To change the default heading, choose a heading from the Heading pop-up menu.

Users can view other headings by clicking the heading in the login window.

7 To display a message below the login windows heading, enter a message in Message.

8 To require the user to enter his or her user name and password, select Name and password text fields.

9 To allow a user to select his or her name from a list, select List of users able to use these computers.

10 Select categories of users you want to display in the list.

Show mobile accounts 10.5 Lists mobile accounts with a local home folder and external accounts

Show network users 10.4 and 10.5 Lists network accounts and mobile accounts without a local home folder

Show computer administrators 10.4 and 10.5 Lists local system administrators

Show Other... 10.4 and 10.5 Displays name and password text fields, allowing the user to authenticate with a local or network-based account

List setting Mac OS X version Effect

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 191

To ensure that a type of user doesnt show up in the list, deselect the corresponding setting.

To display mobile accounts on client computers with Mac OS X v10.5 or later, select Show mobile accounts.

To display mobile accounts on client computers with Mac OS X v10.4 installed, select Show local users.

To allow unlisted users to log in, select Show Other.

11 To allow the user to restart the computer, select Show Restart button.

If the user has physical access to the computer, he or she can still restart the computer.

12 To allow the user to shut down the computer, select Show Shut Down button.

If the user has physical access to the computer, he or she can still shut down the computer.

You might also want to remove the Restart and Shut Down commands from the Finder. For more information, see Managing Finder Preferences on page 182.

13 Click Apply Now.

Configuring Miscellaneous Login Options You can configure the following login options that dont change the appearance of the login window but affect how users log in.

Option What this does when enabled

Show password hint when needed and available

If the user supplied a password hint and he or she enters an incorrect password three times, the password hint appears.

Enable automatic login If the computers local settings enable Automatic Login, the login window is bypassed when the computer starts up.

Enable >console login Users can log in using the Darwin console (command-line interface). To log in to the console, the user enters >console and no password in the login window. This allows the user to bypass management.

Enable Fast User Switching With Fast User Switching, more than one account is available at the same time on a single computer. The list of current active (authenticated) accounts appears in a menu on the right side of the Finder menu bar, allowing you to switch to a different account by choosing it. A user must authenticate to switch to his or her account, but the previous user does not need to log out first.

Log out users after # minutes of activity

If a client computer has Mac OS X v10.3 or later, when the set time interval has passed, the user is logged out and returned to the login window.

Local administrators may refresh or disable management

When local administrators log in, they have the option not to choose a workgroup and to disable preference management.

192 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

To configure miscellaneous login options: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more computers or computer groups.

4 Click Login and then click Options.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select the options you want to enable and click Apply Now.

Choosing Who Can Log In Workgroup Manager gives you control over who is allowed to access computers. You can choose which network users are allowed to log in and whether local users can log in.

Denying access supersedes allowing access. If you allow computer access to a group of network users, you can deny access to specific members of the group. However, if you deny computer access to a group, you cant allow computer access to specific members of that group.

If you dont list users or groups to allow or deny access to, all network users can log in. If you add users or groups to the list, only the users and groups that are explicitly allowed access can log in.

Set computer name to computer record name

For computers with Mac OS X v10.5 or later: You can set the computer name. This name affects the client computers Bonjour name, which other computers on the local subnet use to access the client computer. The new Bonjour name is name-#.local where name is the computer record name you specify and # uniquely identifies the computer if there are several computers with the same Bonjour name.

Enable external accounts For computers with Mac OS X v10.5 or later: Users can log in using external accounts. If the login window displays a list of user names, the external account is listed as a mobile account. If the login window displays a name and password field, the user must enter the external account name and password.

Enable guest account For computers with Mac OS X v10.5 or later: Users can log in using the guest account. The guest account allows anyone to access the computer without requiring a password. To manage guest users, manage the computers or computer groups with enabled guest accounts.

Option What this does when enabled

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 193

Note: A user with an administrator account in a client computers local directory domain can always log in.

To choose who can log in: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more computers or computer groups.

4 Click Login, click Access, and then set the management setting to Always.

5 To control access for all network users, click the Add Network Users (gear) button.

If you allow access for the Network Users group, you can prevent access for specific users or groups. All other network users and groups are allowed access.

If you deny access for the Network Users group, all network users and groups are denied access even if they are specifically allowed access in the list.

6 To control access for specific users or groups, click the Add (+) button and then drag user or group accounts from the drawer to the list.

To switch the drawers display of user accounts to group accounts or vice-versa, click the Users or Groups button at the top of the drawer.

7 To allow or deny access to a user or group in the Access Control List, choose Allow or Deny from the Access pop-up menu for that user or group.

8 To allow local users to access the computer, select Local-only users may login.

9 Click Apply Now.

Customizing the Workgroups Displayed at Login You can change settings that affect how workgroup preferences and other settings impact a users experience. For example, you can require local users to choose a workgroup.

This makes the users environment the same as if he or she was a member of the workgroup. Or, you can configure how to handle situations where multiple workgroups are available for a user.

194 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

The following access options control workgroup settings at login.

To customize the workgroups displayed at login: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more computers or computer groups.

4 Click Login, click Access, and then set the management setting to Always.

5 Select the workgroup settings to enable them.

6 When you finish enabling workgroup settings, click Apply Now.

Enabling the Use of Login and Logout Scripts You can use login scripts to perform a set of actions when a user logs in or logs out.

Because login or logout scripts run as root, they are very powerful. Test your scripts to make sure they dont negatively impact system settings or damage user files.

You can add a login script to a computer in two ways: Add a LoginHook script to a specific computer Apply a login script to a computer or computer group using Workgroup Manager

Option What this does when enabled

Local-only users use available workgroup settings

For computers with Mac OS X v10.4 or later: Local users must choose a workgroup when logging in. The user can choose from all workgroups that can access the computer. The users environment is the same as if he or she was a member of the workgroup.

Ignore workgroup nesting For computers with Mac OS X v10.5 or later: The user can choose whether to use managed preferences from a parent group or its child group. Only the preferences of the chosen group apply. When disabled, the preferences of parent and child groups apply.

Combine available workgroup settings

For computers with Mac OS X v10.5 or later: The users preferences are based on the combination of preferences from all users workgroups. For local users, all workgroups that can access the computer are combined. When enabled, the user cant select the workgroup to use. When disabled, the user can select which workgroup to use. If the user selects a parent or child group, the preferences of both apply.

Always show workgroup dialog during login

For computers with Mac OS X v10.5 or later: The dialog displaying all available workgroups appears even when there are no workgroups available.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 195

When enabling the use of login and logout scripts, you can set a trust value for the client. Trust values determine the required level of authentication before a client trusts a server enough to run its scripts. Most trust values directly correlate to LDAP security policy settings that are configured in Directory Utility.

The trust value of DHCP doesnt correlate to a security policy. Instead, it correlates to whether Directory Utility is configured to use a DHCP-supplied LDAP server. The trust value of Authenticated requires that you set up trusted binding to an LDAP directory.

For more information about how to use Directory Utility to enable LDAP security policies, using DHCP-supplied LDAP, or setting up trusted binding, see Open Directory Administration.

The following table lists valid trust values and describes their requirements. The table is arranged in order of increasing trust, where the last entry requires the highest level of trust.

To set the minimum required trust level, set the MCXScriptTrust client setting: If the clients MCXScriptTrust setting is a level of trust equal to or less than the trust

value, the client trusts the server and runs its login and logout scripts. If the clients MCXScriptTrust setting is a level of trust more than the trust value, the

client doesnt trust the server and doesnt run its scripts.

The default trust value is FullTrust.

To enable the use of login or logout scripts: 1 Log in to the users computer locally or use Apple Remote Desktop.

2 Open the Sharing pane of System Preferences.

3 Click the lock to authenticate, and enter the name of a local or domain administrator.

Trust value name Requirements

Anonymous The client trusts any directory domain server.

DHCP In Directory Utility, select Add DHCP-supplied LDAP servers to automatic search policies.

Encryption In Directory Utility, select Encrypt all packets (requires SSL or Kerberos).

Authenticated Set up trusted binding between the client computer and the LDAP directory.

PartialTrust In Directory Utility, select Digitally sign all packets (requires Kerberos). Most Active Directory nodes support PartialTrust but not FullTrust.

FullTrust In Directory Utility, select Block man-in-the-middle attacks (requires Kerberos) and Digitally sign all packets (requires Kerberos).

196 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

4 Click Edit.

5 If the local host name contains special nonalphabetic or non-numeric characters such as spaces, dashes, and underscores, remove the special characters and then click OK.

For example, change local host names like Anne-Johnsons-Computer to AnneJohnsonsComputer.

6 Optionally, determine the trust level by entering the following command in Terminal:

dscl localhost -read /LDAPv3/www.apple.com

dsAttrTypeStandard:TrustInformation

Replace www.apple.com with the address of your LDAP directory. Running this command displays a line similar to the following:

TrustInformation: Authenticated FullTrust

In this example, the current trust level is FullTrust. The trust level is also Authenticated. When two trust levels are listed, the higher trust level takes precedence.

7 Set the EnableMCXLoginScripts key in ~root/Library/Preferences/ com.apple.loginwindow.plist to TRUE by entering the following command in Terminal:

sudo defaults write com.apple.loginwindow EnableMCXLoginScripts -bool TRUE

8 To change the trust value from FullTrust, set the MCXScriptTrust key in ~root/Library/ Preferences/com.apple.loginwindow.plist to a valid trust value.

For example, enter the following command in Terminal:

sudo defaults write com.apple.loginwindow MCXScriptTrust -string

PartialTrust

This command sets the trust value to PartialTrust. To set other trust values, replace PartialTrust with other trust values. If you enter an invalid trust value, the trust value is reset to FullTrust.

When you enable login and logout scripts or change the trust value, add login and logout scripts in Workgroup Manager. For more information about how to use Workgroup Manager to add login and logout scripts, see Choosing a Login or Logout Script.

Choosing a Login or Logout Script You can only run login and logout scripts on computers or computer groups. Before adding scripts, you must enable them using login and logout scripts. If you change the trust level for client computers running Mac OS X v10.4, re-add your scripts.

For instructions on enabling login and logout scripts on clients and for more information about trust levels, see Enabling the Use of Login and Logout Scripts on page 194.

If you run login or logout scripts for computers and computer groups, the script for the computer is run first, followed by the script for the computer group, starting with hierarchical groups and ending with parent groups.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 197

You cant run scripts that are larger than 30 KB.

To choose login or logout scripts: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more computers or computer groups.

4 Click Login and then click Scripts.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select Login Script or Log-Out Script, then in the dialog that appears, locate your script and click Open.

7 Click Apply Now.

Automatically Opening Items After a User Logs In You can simplify the user experience by setting frequently used items such as applications, folders, or server connections to open when the user logs in. You can also hide the items to help prevent screen clutter while still making the items easily accessible.

Items open in the order they appear in Login Items preferences (you specify the order). The last item opened becomes the active application. For example, if you specify three items to open (and none are hidden), the user sees the menu bar for the last item opened. If an application has open windows, the windows may overlap windows from other applications.

A user can stop login items from opening by holding down the Shift key during login until the Finder appears on the desktop. You can turn off this feature.

To set an item to open automatically: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Login and then click Items.

5 Select a management setting.

6 To add an item to the list, click the Add (+) button, select the application, folder, or server you want to automatically open, and then click Add.

7 For any item you dont want the user to see right away, select its Hide checkbox.

198 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

The application remains open but its windows and menu bar remain hidden until the user activates the application (for example, by clicking its icon in the Dock).

8 To automatically connect the user to a server, select the server and then select Mount share point with users name and password.

The server must use the same directory domain as the one the user logs in to.

9 If you dont want users to have the ability to add and remove items, deselect User may add and remove additional items.

This option is available only if Login Items preferences are always managed. If you only manage Login Items preferences Once, a user can remove any items added to the login list.

Users cant remove items added to the login items list but they can remove items theyve added themselves.

10 To prevent users from stopping applications that open automatically at login, deselect User may press Shift to keep items from opening.

This option is available only if Login Items preferences are always managed.

11 If you select Once, you can click Merge with users items.

This produces two results, depending on whether the user has items in their login list.

If the user has items listed in their login list, either by the user adding them or by having items previously added through preference management, merging only opens login items that appear on the users list and on your list.

If the users login list does not include items, all managed login items appear.

If you do not select Merge with users items, all login items on either list open.

12 Click Apply Now.

Providing Access to a Users Network Home Folder This setting is used primarily for mobile accounts on computers using Mac OS X v10.3 through Mac OS X v10.3.9. When a user logs in while connected to the network, the share point with the users original home folder (on the server) is mounted on the desktop.

Dont provide access to a users network home folder to users with mobile accounts on Mac OS X v10.4 or later. Mac OS X v10.4 and later include portable home directories, which provide a synced subset of the users local and network home folders.

If a user modifies files in the local and network home folders, when the two home folders sync, the newer modifications take precedence, which could surprise and confuse the user. Additionally, users could be confused by having multiple folders titled with their user names and similarly named folders like Documents, Music, and others.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 199

To automatically mount the Network Home: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select a mobile user account in the account list.

4 Click Login and then click Items.

5 Select a management setting.

6 Select Add network home share point.

7 Click Apply Now.

Providing Easy Access to the Group Share Point After you set up a group share point, you can make it easy for users to locate group folders by automatically connecting to the share point at login.

The connection to the group share point uses the user name and password given at login.

When you manage Finder preferences, you can choose to not show connected servers, which removes the group volume icon from the desktop.

If you change the location of the group share point, update the login item for the group in Workgroup Manager.

For information about setting up a group share point, see Creating a Group Folder on page 101.

Note: This preference setting applies only to groups. You cant manage this setting for users or computers.

To add a login item for the group share point: 1 If you havent set up a group share point and group folder, do so.

2 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

3 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

4 Click the Groups button and select one or more group accounts from the list.

5 Click Login and then click Items.

6 Set the management setting to Always.

7 Select Add group share point.

8 Select the newly added group share point item.

200 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

If you dont want the group share point to appear in the Dock, select the Hide checkbox.

9 Make sure Mount share point with users name and password is selected.

10 Click Apply Now.

Managing Media Access Preferences Media Access preferences let you control settings for and access to CDs, DVDs, the local hard disk, and external disks (for example, floppy disks and FireWire drives).

The table below describes what you can do with the settings in each Media Access pane.

Controlling Access to CDs, DVDs, and Recordable Discs You can control whether users can play or record CDs or DVDs. However, you cant deny access to specific discs or to specific items on a disc.

If a computer has a recordable disc drive, you can control a users ability to burn discsthat is, to write information on a recordable disc such as a CD-R, CD-RW, or DVD-R. Users can burn CDs on computers with a CD-RW drive, Combo Drive, or SuperDrive. Users can burn DVDs only on computers with a SuperDrive.

To control access to disc media: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Media Access and then set the management setting to Always.

This setting applies to all Media Access preference options.

5 Click Disc Media and select the desired options.

If you select Require Authentication, the user must authenticate as a local administrator to use the disc media.

Before you can select Require Authentication, you must first select Allow.

6 Click Apply Now.

Media Access preference pane What you can control

Disc Media Settings for CDs, DVDs, and recordable discs (for example, CD-R, CD-RW, or DVD-R). Computers without appropriate hardware are not affected by these settings.

Other Media Internal hard disks and external disks (other than CDs or DVDs).

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 201

Controlling Access to Hard Drives, Disks, and Disk Images You can control access to internal or external disk drives such as floppy disk drives, Zip drives, and FireWire drives. You can also control access to disk images (files with the .dmg extension).

If you disallow external disks, external disks are not displayed in the Finder. If you disallow disk images, the images are visible in the Finder but users cant open them.

To restrict access to internal and external disks: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Media Access.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

This setting applies to all Media Access preference options.

6 Click Other Media and select desired options.

If you select Require Authentication, the user must authenticate as a local administrator to use the disc media.

If you select Read-Only, users can view the contents of a disk but cant change it or save files on it.

Before you can select Require Authentication or Read-Only, you must first select Allow.

7 Click Apply Now.

Ejecting Removable Media Automatically When a User Logs Out If you allow users to access CDs, DVDs, or external disks such as Zip disks or FireWire drives on shared computers, you can automatically eject removable media when a user logs out.

To automatically eject removable media: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Media Access.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

This setting applies to all Media Access preference options.

202 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

6 In Disc Media or Other Media, select Eject all removable media at logout.

7 Click Apply Now.

Managing Mobility Preferences You can automatically create mobile accounts for users during their next login.

If your computers have Mac OS X v10.5 or later, you can also encrypt the contents of the mobile accounts portable home directory, restrict its size, choose its location, or set an expiration date on the account.

The table below describes what you can do with the settings in each Mobility pane.

For planning information and other considerations for mobile accounts, see Chapter 8, Managing Portable Computers.

Creating a Mobile Account You can use Workgroup Manager to create a mobile account when a user logs in. If you dont enable the creation of mobile accounts, the user logs in using a network account. When you enable mobile accounts, a local home folder is created for the user at first login.

When the users local home folder is created, its based on a template stored on the local computer. The users network home folder is based on a template stored on the server hosting home folders.

When you modify these templates, you change the users default home folder structure and content, and you can modify the ~/Library folder, allowing you to set default bookmarks and application preferences.

You can choose whether local and network home folders initially sync, in which case the network home folder replaces the local home folder.

You must authenticate as root to change the template stored in /System/Library/User Template/language.lproj. Replace language with the language used on the client computer, such as English.

Mobility preference pane What you can control

Account Creation Whether to create mobile accounts when users log in and whether to encrypt contents of the portable home directory, restrict its size, or choose a different location for it

Account Expiry Whether to delete mobile accounts and how soon to do so after the users next login

Rules The folders you want to sync at login and logout (or in the background) and how frequently to sync folders in the background

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 203

Note: When a mobile account is enabled, it appears in the login window and in the Accounts pane of System Preferences with the label Mobile. When the account is selected in the Accounts pane, some settings may appear dimmed.

To create a mobile account using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select a user account, group account, computer, or computer group.

When users log in to a workgroup with mobile-account creation enabled, they are given individual mobile accounts. Similarly, if you enable mobile accounts for a computer or a computer group, when users log in using the computer or a computer in the computer group, users are given individual mobile accounts for that computer.

4 Click Mobility, click Account Creation, and then click Creation.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select Create mobile account when user logs in to network account.

7 If you want the user to decide whether to enable a mobile account at login, select Require confirmation before creating mobile account.

If this option is selected, the user sees a confirmation when logging in. The user can click Create Now to create a local home folder and enable the mobile account, click Dont Create to log in as a network user without enabling the mobile account, or click Cancel Login to return to the login window.

If you select Show Dont ask me again checkbox, the dialog allows the user to prevent the display of the dialog on that computer. If the user selects Dont ask me again and then clicks Dont Create, he or she isnt asked to create a mobile account on that computer. The user can hold down the Option key during login to redisplay the dialog.

8 To initially sync local and network homes so that the network home folder replaces the local home folder, choose Create home with default sync settings. To create the local home folder without syncing, choose Create home with syncing off.

9 Click Apply Now.

Changes are applied to a mobile account the next time the computer connects to the network.

Preventing the Creation of a Mobile Account To prevent the creation of mobile accounts, manage Mobility preferences.

204 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

After a user creates a mobile account, the local home folder for that account stays on the computer until its deleted. You can delete the local home folders to save disk space, or you can set an expiration period on the mobile account so the local home folders are deleted when the account expires.

For instructions, see Manually Removing Mobile Accounts from Computers on page 204, and Setting Expiration Periods for Mobile Accounts on page 209.

To prevent the creation of mobile accounts: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Mobility, click Account Creation, and then click Creation.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Deselect Create mobile account when user logs in to network account.

7 Click Apply Now.

Manually Removing Mobile Accounts from Computers If a user no longer requires a mobile account, you can delete the account. When you delete the account, you can also delete or archive the users local home folder.

To delete a mobile account, you must log in to the computer using an account other than the mobile account. You must also know the name and password of an administrator account on the computer.

If you want to use Workgroup Manager to remove the mobile account remotely, you can set a null expiration period for the account. By doing so, you remove the mobile account from all computers. For more information, see Setting Expiration Periods for Mobile Accounts on page 209.

To remove a mobile account: 1 On the client computer, log in using a different account from the one youre removing

the mobile account of.

2 Open System Preferences.

3 Click Accounts and then click the lock and authenticate as the local administrator.

4 To list all accounts, click the Other Accounts disclosure triangle and then select the mobile account you want to remove.

The mobile account should have the word Mobile listed.

5 Click the Delete () button.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 205

6 Choose one of the following home folder options and then click OK.

Enabling FileVault for Mobile Accounts If your users have computers with Mac OS X v10.5 or later installed, you can use FileVault to encrypt the local home folders for their mobile accounts.

FileVault encrypts the users local home folder using the Advanced Encryption Standard with 128-bit keys (AES-128). The home folder content is safe even if the users computer is stolen or if an intruder attempts to use the computer while the user is not logged in.

The users login password is used to decrypt and give the user access to his or her FileVault-protected account. If the user forgets the login password and a computer administrator has set a master password, the administrator can use the master password to unlock all local accounts.

You can choose whether to require master passwords when enabling FileVault protection for mobile accounts: If you dont require a master password and there is no master password, local

computer administrators cant unlock the account. If you require a master password and there is no master password, the user cant

enable a mobile account. If you select Require confirmation before creating mobile account, the user can log

in with a network account. Network accounts dont have local home folders (preventing intruders from accessing home folder content).

If you enable FileVault, you can restrict the size of the local home folder. When you set a network home disk quota (in the Home pane of a user account), it limits the amount of space available for the users network home folder.

By restricting the size of the local home folder, you prevent the users local home folder from using more space than is available in the users network home folder. This ensures that the home folders can sync without requiring more space than is available in the network home folder.

Option Effect

Save the home folder in a disk image

Removes a user account from the local directory domain but preserves the local home folder in /Users/username.dmg, where username is the short name of the deleted user.

Do not change the home folder Removes a user account from the local directory domain but preserves the local home folder in /Users as username (Deleted), where username is the short name of the deleted user.

Delete the home folder Removes a user account from the local directory domain and permanently deletes the users home folders.

206 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

Additionally, if you make the maximum size of the local home folder smaller than the network home disk quota, you can provide more flexibility for handling files with sync conflicts.

If a mobile account is protected with FileVault, the user must be logged in to share files using File Sharing.

To enable FileVault for mobile accounts: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Mobility, click Account Creation, and then click Creation.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select Create mobile account when user logs in to network account.

This option must be selected to enable a mobile account for the selected account.

7 To allow the user to choose not to create a local home folder (so that instead of a mobile account, the user logs in with a network account), select Require confirmation before creating mobile account.

If you require a master password but the user logs in to computers without master passwords set, selecting this allows the user to log in with a network account.

8 Click Options.

9 Select Encrypt contents with FileVault, then select Use master password, if available or Require computer master password.

If you select Use master password, if available, the mobile account uses FileVault regardless of whether there is a master password already set.

If you select Require computer master password and there is no master password set, the user might be able to log in with a network account, depending on whether you selected Require confirmation before creating mobile account in the Creation pane.

10 To restrict the size of the local home folder, select Restrict size and select to fixed size or to percentage of network home quota; then enter a value that is less than the size of your network home folders disk quota.

If you didnt set a disk quota, select to fixed size.

For more information about setting a disk quota, see Creating a Network Home Folder on page 123.

11 Click Apply Now.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 207

Selecting the Location of a Mobile Account You can select the location of a mobile accounts local home folder or you can let the user select the location. If you select the location, choose from one of the following.

If you choose a location at a specific path, make sure that the folder has the following permissions.

If you choose a location that doesnt exist on the users computer, it is created when the user logs in.

When a location is chosen on an external disk, you create an external account. For more information, see Creating External Accounts on page 208.

To select the location of a mobile account: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

Home folder location Description

on startup volume The local home folder is located on the startup volume in /Users/. This is the default location where the local home folders of mobile accounts on computers with Mac OS X v10.4 and earlier are stored.

at path The local home folder is located at the path you specify. You can specify a different volume by entering /Volumes/ DriveName/Folder/, where DriveName is the name of the volume, and Folder is the folder in the volume. If you dont specify a volume, the location is on the startup volume.

user chooses When users with mobile accounts log in, a window appears that allows them to choose a location for the local home folder. After they choose a location, the window only appears when a mobile account is being created. You can choose which types of volumes the user is allowed to choose from: any volume includes volumes on internal or external hard disks any internal volume includes volumes on internal hard disks any external volume includes volumes on external hard disks

Type Name Privilege

Owner system Read & Write

Group admin Read only

Others Others Read only

208 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

4 Click Mobility, click Account Creation, click Creation, and then set the management setting to Always.

5 Select Create mobile account when user logs in to network account.

This option must be selected to enable a mobile account for the selected account.

6 Click Options and then set the management setting to Always.

7 Select a Home folder location option.

If you select at path, enter the path to a folder on an external drive in the format /Volumes/DriveName/Folder, replacing DriveName with the name of the external drive and Folder with a folder on the external drive. If you dont specify a volume, the location is on the startup volume.

If you select user chooses, choose a type of volume from the pop-up menu to allow the user to store his or her local home folder on that type of volume.

8 Click Apply Now.

Creating External Accounts An external account is a mobile account where the local home folder is stored on an external drive, allowing the user access to his or her account on any computer with Mac OS X v10.5 or later.

The users local home folder is stored entirely on the external drive and leaves no remnants on computers. External accounts also save hard disk space on the computer, which is especially important if you dont set an account expiration or if many users create mobile accounts with local home folders on the same computer.

You can choose one of three ways to determine the location of the external account. All of these ways can be used to set up external accounts: If you set the location to on startup volume, the mobile account doesnt

immediately become an external account. After creating the local home folder, if the user starts target disk mode on the computer and connects it to a client computer, the mobile account then becomes an external account.

If you set the location to at path, you can enter the path for the mobile accounts local home folder. If you enter a path for an external drive, a local home folder is created on the external drive after the user logs in.

If you set the location to user chooses volume, when the user logs in, a window appears allowing the user to choose whether to store the local home folder on the computer or on an external drive. If the user chooses an external drive, a local home folder is created on the external drive.

To create an external account: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 209

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Mobility, click Account Creation, click Creation, and then set the management setting to Always.

5 Select Create mobile account when user logs in to network account.

This option must be selected to enable a mobile account for the selected account.

6 Click Options and then set the management setting to Always.

7 For the home folder location, select either at path or user selects volume.

If you select at path, enter the path to a folder on an external drive in the format /Volumes/DriveName/Folders, replacing DriveName with the name of the external drive and Folders with a folder on the external drive.

If you select user selects volume, choose any external volume or any volume from the pop-up menu. After authenticating at the login window, the user is prompted to choose a location.

If you select any volume, the user can choose either on the local hard disk or on the external hard disk. If the user chooses the external hard disk, the local home folder is stored in /Users/ShortName, where ShortName is the users short name.

8 Click Apply Now.

Setting Expiration Periods for Mobile Accounts When a user enables a mobile account, Mac OS X usually creates a local home folder on the computer he or she is using. If that user enables mobile accounts on several computers, each of those computers has a local home folder for the user. If the user doesnt use those computers, the local home folders are unused and waste disk space.

When you set an expiration period on a mobile account, the mobile account and its local home folder are deleted after a period of inactivity.

You can also set an expiration period of 0 to delete the mobile account and its local home folder as soon as possible. Depending on the account type youre managing, as soon as possible refers to two different events: For users and groups, the mobile account and its local home folder are deleted after

the user logs out. For computers and computer groups, the mobile account and its local home folder

are deleted the next time the login window appears. This doesnt include when the login window appears while using fast user switching.

Expiry settings do not affect external accounts.

210 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

To set an expiration period: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Mobility and then click Account Expiry.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select Delete mobile accounts and enter a number of hours, days, or weeks.

7 To wait until after the users mobile account syncs to delete the local home folder, select Delete only after successful sync.

8 Click Apply Now.

Choosing Folders to Sync at Login and Logout, or in the Background You can use Workgroup Manager to choose which folders to sync at login and logout, or in the background for users with mobile accounts. You can also choose not to sync specific folders.

You should carefully manage login and logout syncing because a users login and logout is delayed while files are syncing. Using background syncing can also cause users to load outdated files from the network, especially when syncing is set to occur at long intervals. Also, you cant sync ~/Library in the background.

For considerations when choosing folders to sync and how to sync them, see Strategies for Syncing Content on page 139.

To choose folders to sync at login and logout, or in the background: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Mobility, click Rules, and then click Login & Logout Sync or Background Sync.

5 Select a management setting.

6 Select Sync at login and logout or Sync in the background (depending on which pane youre in).

7 To add folders, click the Add (+) button for the Sync at login and logout and Sync in the background lists and then enter the path to the folder that you want to sync.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 211

Precede the folder with ~/ to denote the location of the synced folder in the users home folder. For example, to sync the users Documents folder, enter ~/Documents.

8 Alternatively, click the Browse (...) button for the Sync at login and logout and Sync in the background lists to browse to a folder.

Because you are browsing the computer currently running Workgroup Manager, you might choose a folder that is not located in the users account. If you choose a folder that doesnt exist in the users account, no files are synced.

9 To choose not to sync specific files or folders, use the Add (+) button or Browse (...) button to add items to the Skip items that match any of the following list.

To filter for specific items, click the Match field entry for any list item. This allows you to further specify your search.

10 To add synced folders to the folders that the user selects for syncing, select Merge with users settings.

If you sync the same folder in Workgroup Manager as the user chooses in the Accounts pane of System Preferences, merging will cause the Workgroup Manager sync settings to take precedence. If you do not select Merge with users settings, the folders that you sync will replace those chosen by the user.

When used with the Once setting, merging with the users settings is useful for adding folders without disrupting the folders the user has set to sync.

11 Click Apply Now.

Stopping Files from Syncing for a Mobile Account To stop a mobile account from syncing files, you must manage its login and logout and background sync rules. If you leave them unmanaged, the users current sync settings remain in effect and the user can choose his or her own sync settings in the Accounts pane of System Preferences.

To stop files from syncing: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Mobility and then click Rules.

5 Click Login & Logout Sync and then set the management setting to Always.

6 Deselect Sync at login and logout.

7 Click Background Sync and then set the management setting to Always.

8 Deselect Sync in the background.

212 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

9 Click Apply Now.

Setting the Background Sync Frequency You can change the frequency of syncing for background folders. By default, background folders sync every 20 minutes. You can set frequencies from 5 minutes to 8 hours.

If you set the frequency to a long interval, you run a higher risk of users loading older, outdated files. If users save files and log off before the background files sync, when they load the same file on another computer, they might get either an older synced file or no file at all.

To set the frequency for syncing background folders: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Mobility, click Rules, and then click Background Sync.

Make sure Once or Always is selected and that there are items configured to sync in the background.

5 Click Options and then set the management setting to Always.

6 Click Every and drag the slider to set the frequency for background folder sync.

If you want background folders to sync only when users choose to sync, click Manually.

The default frequency is 20 minutes. The frequency you set also affects folders that users configure to sync automatically.

7 Click Apply Now.

Showing Mobile Account Status in the Users Menu Bar If your mobile account users run Mac OS X v10.5 or later, you can add a mobile account status menu to their menu bar. This status menu allows the user to do the following: View when he or she last synced Initiate a sync Change their home sync preferences

Home sync preferences correspond to Mobility preferences in Workgroup Manager. If you manage particular Mobility preferences, users cant change those preferences.

Home sync preferences includes the following settings: Setting the home folder location Enabling FileVault

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 213

Enabling background, login, and logout sync Selecting what is synced Setting the sync frequency Enabling the mobile account status menu

If you disable the mobile account status menu, the user can still configure his or her mobile account in the Accounts pane of System Preferences.

To show mobile account status in the users menu bar: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Mobility, click Rules, and then click Options.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select Show status in menu bar.

7 Click Apply Now.

Managing Network Preferences Use Network preferences to select and configure proxy servers that can be used by users and groups. You can bypass proxy settings for specific hosts and domains. This has the advantage of providing a customized browsing experience for managed users and groups.

You can also disable Internet Sharing, AirPort, or Bluetooth. Disabling these can improve security by removing avenues for attack.

The table below describes what settings in each Network pane can do.

Configuring Proxy Servers by Port You can configure specific types of proxies for a user or group to access and specify the port. The types of proxy servers that are individually modifiable are FTP, Web (HTTP), Secure Web (HTTPS), Streaming (RTSP), SOCKS, Gopher, and Automatic Proxy Configuration.

Network preference pane What you can control

Proxies Access to proxy servers, the ability to bypass proxy settings, and use of passive FTP mode

Sharing & Interfaces Availability of Internet Sharing from the computer, and use of AirPort or Bluetooth

214 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

You must assign a single server for every type of proxy server (for example, you cant have multiple FTP proxy servers).

To configure proxy servers for a user or a group: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Network and then click Proxies.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select the specific type of proxy you want to configure (FTP, Web, and so on).

7 Specify a URL and a port using the form proxyserver.apple.com:8080.

8 Click Apply Now.

Allowing Users to Bypass Proxy Servers for Specific Domains When managing Network preferences for users, you can allow them to bypass proxy settings for specific hosts or domains. Bypassing the proxy server lets users connect directly to specified addresses.

You must set up a proxy server before you can bypass it. For instructions, see Configuring Proxy Servers by Port on page 213.

To choose the domains that users can access directly: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Network and then click Proxies.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 In the Bypass proxy settings for these Hosts & Domains field, enter the addresses of the hosts and domains that you want users to be able to connect to directly.

To enter multiple address, separate the subnet masks with new lines, spaces, semicolons, or commas.

There are several ways to enter addresses:

A subdomain or fully qualified domain name (FQDN) of a target server, such as server1.apple.com or store.apple.com.

The specific IP address of a server, such as 192.168.2.1.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 215

A domain name, such as apple.com. This bypasses apple.com but not subdomains such as store.apple.com.

An entire website including all subdomains, such as *.apple.com. A subnet in Classless Inter-Domain Routing (CIDR) notation. For example, to add a

subnet of 192.168.2.x, you would name that view 192.168.2.0/24. For a detailed description of subnet masks and CIDR notation, see Network Services Administration.

7 Click Apply Now.

Enabling Passive FTP Mode When managing Network preferences, you can require passive FTP mode. Passive FTP mode causes the FTP server to open a connection to the computer on a dynamically determined port. This can be more convenient for computers but it requires that port filters are properly configured on the FTP server.

To enable passive FTP mode: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Network and then click Proxies.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select Use Passive FTP Mode (PASV).

7 Click Apply Now.

Disabling Internet Sharing Although Internet Sharing is a convenient way for computers to share Internet access, turning it on can disrupt your network (because it can cause conflicts with DHCP and NAT services).

To reenable Internet Sharing, you must log in to the computer locally and enable it in the Sharing pane of System Preferences.

To disable Internet Sharing: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more computers or computer groups.

4 Click Network and then click Sharing & Interfaces.

216 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select Disable Internet Sharing.

7 Click Apply Now.

Disabling AirPort If you disable AirPort, it is disabled the next time a computer retrieves managed preferences. If the computer had active AirPort connections, they are immediately disconnected.

To reenable AirPort, you must log in to the computer locally and enable it in the Network pane of System Preferences.

To disable AirPort: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more computers or computer groups.

4 Click Network and then click Sharing & Interfaces.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select Disable AirPort.

7 Click Apply Now.

Disabling Bluetooth Before disabling Bluetooth, make sure your computers dont rely on Bluetooth-enabled input devices like keyboards and mice.

To reenable Bluetooth, you must log in to the computer locally and enable it in the Network pane of System Preferences.

To disable Bluetooth: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more computers or computer groups.

4 Click Network and then click Sharing & Interfaces.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select Disable Bluetooth.

7 Click Apply Now.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 217

Managing Parental Controls Preferences Parental Controls preferences allow you to hide profanity in Dictionary, limit access to websites, or set time limits or other contraints on computer usage. To manage Parental Controls preferences, computers must have Mac OS X v10.5 or later.

The table below describes what settings in each Parental Controls pane can do.

Hiding Profanity in Dictionary You can hide profane terms from the Dictionary application included with Mac OS X v10.5 or later. When you hide profane terms, entirely profane terms are removed from search results. If you search for a profane term that has an alternate nonprofane definition, Dictionary only displays the nonprofane definition.

To hide profanity in Dictionary: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Parental Controls and then click Content Filtering.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select Hide profanity in Dictionary.

7 Click Apply Now.

Preventing Access to Adult Websites You can use Workgroup Manager to help prevent users from visiting adult websites. You can also block access to specific websites while allowing users to access other websites. You can allow or deny access to specific subfolders in the same website.

Instead of preventing access to specific websites, you can allow access only to specific websites. For more information, see Allowing Access Only to Specific Websites on page 218.

To prevent access to specific websites: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

Parental Controls preference pane What you can control

Content Filtering Whether profanity is allowed in Dictionary, and limitations on which websites users can view

Time Limits How long and when users can log in to their accounts

218 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Parental Controls and then click Content Filtering.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select Limit access to websites by and choose trying to limit access to adult websites.

7 To allow access to specific sites, click the Add (+) button next to the Always allow sites at these URLs list and then enter the URL of the site you want to allow.

8 To block access to specific sites, click the Add (+) button next to the Never allow sites at these URLs list and then enter the URL of the site you want to block.

To allow or block a site, including all content stored in its subfolders, enter the highest level URL of the site.

For example, allowing http://www.example.com/ lets the user view all pages in www.example.com. However, blocking http://www.example.com/banned/ prevents the user from viewing content stored in www.example.com/banned/, including all subfolders in /banned/ (but allows the user to view pages in www.example.com that are not in /banned/).

9 Click Apply Now.

Allowing Access Only to Specific Websites You can use Workgroup Manager to allow access only to specific websites on computers with Mac OS X v10.5 or later.

If the user tries to visit a website that he or she is not allowed to access, the web browser loads a webpage that lists all sites the user is allowed to access.

To help direct users to allowed sites, the users bookmarks are replaced by the websites you allow access to. The bookmarks created by allowing access to websites are called managed bookmarks.

If the user syncs bookmarks with .Mac, the first time the user syncs he or she is asked if .Mac should merge or replace its bookmarks with the managed bookmarks. If the user merges bookmarks, the .Mac bookmarks will include the original .Mac bookmarks and the managed bookmarks. If the user replaces bookmarks, the .Mac bookmarks will include only the managed bookmarks.

You can also use Workgroup Manager to block specific websites instead of blocking all websites. For more information, see Preventing Access to Adult Websites on page 217.

To allow access only to specific websites: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 219

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Parental Controls and then click Content Filtering.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select Limit access to websites by and choose allowing access to the following websites only.

7 Use one of the following methods to add websites that you want to allow access to:

In Safari, open the site and then drag the icon from the address bar (of Safari) to the list.

In Safari, choose Bookmarks > Show All Bookmarks, then drag icons from the bookmark list to the list in Workgroup Manager.

If you have a .webloc file of the website you want to allow access to, drag the file into the list.

If you dont have a .webloc file of the website you want to allow access to, click the Add (+) button and enter the URL of the website you want to allow. In the Web site title field, name the website. In the Address field, enter the highest level URL of the site.

For example, allowing http://www.example.com/ lets the user view all pages in www.example.com. Allowing http://www.example.com/allowed/ lets the user view content stored in www.example.com/allowed/, including all subfolders in /allowed/, but not folders located outside of /allowed/.

8 To create folders to organize websites, click the New Folder (folder) button, then double-click the folder to rename it.

To add URLs within a folder, open the folders disclosure triangle, select the folder, and then click the Add (+) button.

To create a subfolder, open a folders disclosure triangle, select the folder, and then click the New Folder (folder) button.

9 To change the name or URL of a website, double-click the website entry; then, to rename a folder, double-click the folder entry.

10 To rearrange websites or folders, drag the websites or folders within the list.

11 Click Apply Now.

Setting Time Limits and Curfews on Computer Usage You can use Workgroup Manager to set time limits and curfews for computer usage on computers with Mac OS X v10.5 or later.

220 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

If you set a time limit for computer usage, users who meet their daily time limits cant log in until the next day when their quota is reset. You can set different time limits for weekdays (Monday through Friday) and weekends (Saturday and Sunday). The time limit can range from 30 minutes to 8 hours.

If you set a curfew, users cant log in during the days and times you specify. If a user is logged in when their curfew starts, the user is immediately logged out. You can set different times for weekdays (denying access Sunday nights through Thursday nights) and weekends (Friday and Saturday nights).

To set time limits and curfews: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Parental Controls and then click Time Limits.

5 Set the management setting to Always and then select Enforce limits.

6 To set time limits, click Allowances, then under Weekdays or Weekends select Limit computer use to and drag the slider to amount of time you want to limit use.

7 To set curfews, click Curfews, select Sunday through Thursday or Friday and Saturday, and then enter the range of time when you want to prevent computer access.

You can highlight the time and replace it with a new time, or you can highlight the time and click the up or down buttons next to the time.

8 Click Apply Now.

Managing Printing Preferences Use Printing preferences to create printer lists and manage access to printers.

The table below describes what the printing settings do.

Printing preference pane What you can control

Printers Available printers, the users ability to add printers or access a printer, and the default printer

Footer Customization of the page footer

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 221

Making Printers Available to Users To give users access to printers, you must first set up a printer list. Then you can allow specific users or groups to use printers in that list. You can also make printers available to computers.

A users list of printers is a combination of printers available to the user, the group selected at login, and the computer used.

To create a printer list for users: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Printing and then click Printers.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Click Printer List.

The Available Printers list is created from the list of available network printers in Print & Fax System Preferences.

7 Select a printer in the Available Printers list and then click Add to List to make that printer available in the users printer list.

If the printer you want doesnt appear in the Available Printers list, click Open Printer Setup and add the printer to the Printer & Fax printer list.

8 Click Apply Now.

Preventing Users from Modifying the Printer List If your users run Mac OS X v10.5 or later, they must authenticate as local administrators to change the list of printers.

If your users run Mac OS X v10.4 or earlier, you can manage preferences so users must authenticate as local administrators to change the list of printers.

To restrict access to the printer list: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Printing and then click Printers.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

222 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

6 Click Printer List.

7 Deselect Allow user to modify the printer list.

8 Click Apply Now.

Restricting Access to Printers Connected to a Computer In some situations, you might want only certain users to print to a printer connected directly to their computer.

For example, if you have a computer in a classroom with a printer attached, you can reserve that printer for teachers by making the teacher an administrator and requiring an administrators user name and password to access the printer.

To restrict access to a printer connected to a specific computer: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Printing and then click Printers.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Click Printer List.

7 If its a network printer you want the client computer to have access to, select the printer and then click Add to List.

8 If you dont want users to access local printers, deselect Allow printers that connect directly to the users computer.

9 To require an administrator password to use the printer, select Require an administrator password.

10 Click Apply Now.

Setting a Default Printer After you set up a printer list, you can specify a printer as the default printer. When a user tries to print a document, this printer is the preferred selection in an applications print dialog.

To set the default printer: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 223

4 Click Printing and then click Printers.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Click Access.

7 Select a printer listed in Users Printer List and then click Make Default.

8 Click Apply Now.

Restricting Access to Printers You can require an administrator user name and password to print to specific printers.

To restrict access to a specific printer: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Printing and then click Printers.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Click Access, select a printer listed in Users Printer List, and then select Require an administrator password.

7 Click Apply Now.

Adding a Page Footer to All Printouts Adding page footers to all printouts can help users identify their printouts from other users printouts. This is especially useful in educational environments where students might print identical or nearly identical assignments.

The footer appears at the bottom left of the page. It overlays existing printed content. If your printouts have footers or very small margins, the managed footer might become garbled.

The footer includes the users long name and the date and time when the user sent the print job. The date and time is based on the users computers date and time, not the servers.

The footer can also include the Ethernet ID of the computer that sent the print job.

For example, heres a footer for a user named Anne Johnson: Anne Johnson Saturday March 3, 2007 5:59:01 PM PT 00:11:22:33:44:55

To add a footer to all printouts: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

224 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Printing and then click Footer.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Select Print page footer (user name and date).

7 To print the Ethernet ID, select Include MAC address.

8 Choose a font for the footer from the Font name pop-up menu.

You can choose from Helvetica, Courier, Lucida Grande, and Times.

9 Enter a font size for the footer.

There is no font size limit for the footer. However, 7 is the default (and recommended) size.

10 Click Apply Now.

Managing Software Update Preferences With Mac OS X Server, you can create your own Software Update server to control updates that are applied to specific users or groups. This is helpful because it reduces external network traffic while also providing more control to server administrators.

By configuring the Software Update server, server administrators can choose which updates to provide.

To manage access to Software Update servers: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Software Update.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 Specify a URL in the form http://someserver.apple.com:8088/index.sucatalog.

7 Click Apply Now.

Managing Access to System Preferences You can specify which preferences to show in System Preferences.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 225

If a user can see a particular preference, it does not mean the user can modify that preference. Some preferences, such as Startup Disk preferences, require an administrator name and password before a user can modify its settings.

The preferences that appear in Workgroup Manager are those installed on the computer youre currently using. If your administrator computer is missing preferences that you want to disable on client computers, install the applications related to those preferences or use Workgroup Manager on a computer that includes those preferences.

To manage access to System Preferences: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click System Preferences.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 For each item you dont want displayed in a users System Preferences, deselect its Show checkbox.

To select all Show checkboxes, click Show All. To deselect all Show checkboxes, click Show None.

7 Click Apply Now.

Managing Time Machine Preferences Time Machine preferences let you control Time Machine, which provides a backup of computer data to network servers. Time Machine backs up all computer data, such as installed applications and their preferences, all local account data, and system files (optionally). To use Time Machine, your computers must run Mac OS X v10.5 or later.

To manage Time Machine, youll need to run file services, such as AFP service. When managed users log in to Mac OS X, their login name and password are used to authenticate them with the file server.

You can back up a computers startup volume or all local volumes. If your users have network accounts, their data isnt backed up through Time Machine (because their data is stored on a network server, not locally).

You can enable Time Machine to perform automatic hourly backups. If you dont use automatic backup, the user can manually back up using Time Machine.

226 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

Time Machine is most appropriate for backing up computers with primarily local accounts. It is also useful if users have administrative control over the computer and can install their own applications.

You can limit the total backup storage per computer. When you limit total backup storage for a computer group, the limit applies to each computer in it. If you limit a computer group to 2 GB, and the computer group has five members, the computer group can use up to 10 GB of backup storage. Backup storage is not preallocated, so the server can run out of space before the computers reach their backup storage limit.

If a user runs out of backup storage, Time Machine stops backing up data. To make sure Time Machine doesnt run out of space, make the limit larger than the expected size of the data being backed up, and dont back up system files.

You can save space on the file server by not backing up system files. System files include files that are created when Mac OS X is installed. If you dont back up system files and system files are corrupted, you must use the Mac OS X Server installation discs to reinstall Mac OS X Server. By not backing up system files, you speed up the initial backup but you dont speed up subsequent backups.

To manage Time Machine preferences: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more computers or computer groups.

4 Click Time Machine.

5 Set the management setting to Always.

6 In the Backup server field, enter the URL of the file server or share point that will store Time Machine backups.

Use the form afp://www.example.com/Backups/.

Replace www.example.com/Backups/ with the URL of the file server or share point. The location you enter must already exist.

7 To select which volumes to back up, select Startup volume only or All local volumes.

8 To back up system files, deselect Skip system files.

9 To use automatic backup, select Back up automatically.

10 To limit backup storage, select Limit total backup storage to: # MB and replace # with the number of MB to limit backup storage.

11 Click Apply Now.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 227

Managing Universal Access Preferences Universal Access settings can help improve the user experience for some users. For example, if a user has difficulty using a computer or wants to work in a different way, you can choose settings that enable the user to work more effectively.

Using Workgroup Manager, you can set up and manage Universal Access settings for specific workgroups or computers dedicated to users with special needs.

The table below describes what the settings in each Universal Access pane can do.

Adjusting the Users Display Settings The Seeing settings in Universal Access preferences alter the appearance of the screen. The user can easily zoom in or out on the desktop using keyboard shortcuts (specific key combinations). Changing to grayscale or white-on-black display can sometimes make it easier to read text on the screen.

Note: If display settings are managed Once, users can switch between the zoom or color options using keyboard shortcuts. If the management setting is Always, users cant switch between options.

To further customize the users display, you can use Finder Views preferences to control the size of icons in Finder windows, and use Dock Display preferences to enlarge or magnify icons in the users Dock. For more information, see Managing Finder Preferences on page 182, and Managing Dock Preferences on page 174.

If you plan to manage dedicated computers, you may be able to use local Display System Preferences to change the resolution and number of colors computers use. After setting the resolution and number of colors, you can prevent changes to the Display System Preferences by removing Display from the list of available System Preferences.

For more information, see Managing Access to System Preferences on page 224.

For more information about enabling assistive devices like screen readers, see Allowing Devices for Users with Special Needs on page 231.

Universal Access preference pane What you can control

Seeing Visual display and desktop zooming

Hearing Visual alert for users

Keyboard How the keyboard responds to keystrokes and key combinations

Mouse How the pointer responds, and whether users can use the numeric keypad instead of a mouse

Options Shortcut key combinations, the use of assistive devices, and whether the computer reads text in the Universal Access preference pane

228 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

To adjust screen appearance: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Universal Access.

5 Click Seeing and then select a management setting.

6 To enable zooming, select Turn on Zoom; to fine-tune zoom settings, click Zoom Options.

Use the sliders to set a maximum and minimum zoom.

To show a preview area, select Show preview rectangle when zoomed out.

To improve the appearance of zoomed graphics, deselect Smooth images.

7 To change the color scheme to white on black or grayscale, select Switch to and then select White on Black or Grayscale.

8 Click Apply Now.

Setting a Visual Alert If users cant hear computer alert sounds (for example, the sound played when new mail arrives or an error occurs), you can flash the screen as an alternative.

To set a flashing alert: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Universal Access.

5 Click Hearing and then select a management setting.

6 Select Flash the screen whenever an alert sound occurs.

7 Click Apply Now.

Adjusting Keyboard Accessibility Options If some users have difficulty pressing keys, you can use Sticky Keys or Slow Keys to help them use the keyboard.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 229

Sticky Keys help users who cant press multiple keys simultaneously. It treats a sequence of modifier keys (Shift, Command, Option, and Control) like a key combination. For example, to press Command-O, users can press Command and then O.

To hold down a key with multiple keystrokes, users can press the key twice. For example, pressing Shift twice is like using Caps Lock, except that it also presses Shift when entering commands. So if youve previously pressed Shift twice, then you press Command and then O, its the same as pressing Shift-Command-O (using Caps Lock instead of pressing Shift twice is like pressing Command-O). Pressing Shift a third time removes the Shift key from the current key combination.

If you set up Sticky Keys, you can make them more useful by enabling these options:

Slow Keys help users who press keys for too long or accidentally press keys. If you enable Slow Keys, you can set a delay when a key is accepted. If the user presses a key for less time than the acceptance delay, the keystroke isnt accepted.

To help users recognize when their keystrokes are accepted, enable the Use click sounds option to play a sound when the user initially presses a key and a different sound when the key is accepted.

Note: If you enable Universal Access Shortcuts, a user can press the Shift key five times to turn Sticky Keys on or off. For more information, see Enabling Universal Access Shortcuts on page 230.

To set the way the keyboard responds to keystrokes: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Universal Access.

5 Click Keyboard and then select a management setting.

6 To activate Sticky Keys, select Sticky Keys On.

Option Effect

Beep when a modifier key is set Setting and holding a modifier key makes distinct typewriter sounds. Removing a key from the current key combination doesnt create a sound.

Display pressed keys onscreen When a modifier key is pressed, a silhouette of the modifier key is shown onscreen. If the modifier key is only active for a single press, its silhouette is dim. If the modifier key is in held-down mode, its silhouette is bright.

230 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

To turn off the key-combination alert, deselect Beep when a modifier key is set.

To turn off onscreen display of keystrokes, deselect Show pressed keys on screen.

7 To activate Slow Keys, select Slow Keys On.

If you dont want audio feedback during keystrokes, deselect Use click key sounds.

Move the slider to adjust the amount of delay between when a key is pressed and when the computer accepts it.

8 Click Apply Now.

Adjusting Mouse and Pointer Responsiveness If some users cant use a mouse (or prefer not to), the Mouse Keys feature allows them to use the numeric keypad instead. Keys on the numeric keypad correspond to directions and mouse actions so the user can move the pointer and hold, release, or click.

Note: If you enable Universal Access Shortcuts, a user can press the Option key five times to turn Mouse Keys on or off.

If the pointer moves too quickly for some users, you can adjust how soon the pointer begins to move and how fast it moves.

To control mouse and pointer settings: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Universal Access.

5 Click Mouse and then select a management setting.

6 To activate Mouse Keys, select Mouse Keys On.

7 To control how long it takes for the pointer to begin moving, adjust the Initial Delay slider.

8 To control how fast the pointer moves, adjust the Maximum Speed slider.

9 Click Apply Now.

Enabling Universal Access Shortcuts Universal Access Shortcuts are key combinations that activate an available access feature, such as onscreen zooming or enabling Sticky Keys.

If you choose not to allow Universal Access shortcuts, users might not be able to use features such as Zoom or turn off activated features such as Sticky Keys.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 231

To allow Universal Access Shortcuts: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click Universal Access.

5 Click Options and then set the management setting to Once or Always.

6 Select Allow Universal Access Shortcuts.

7 Click Apply Now.

Allowing Devices for Users with Special Needs You can allow managed users to turn on assistive devices, such as a text reader.

To allow assistive devices: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more computers or computer groups.

4 Click Universal Access.

5 Click Options and set the management setting to Always.

6 Select Enable access for assistive devices.

7 Click Apply Now.

Using the Preference Editor with Preference Manifests Workgroup Manager includes a preference editor, which you can use to control any Mac OS X application or utility developed using Apple standard conventions for handling preferences.

You can also use it to manage preferences that are not configurable in the Workgroup Manager main preferences interface.

As with the main preferences interface, you can use the preference editor to manage preferences for users, groups, computers, and computer groups.

232 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

For example, in Safari you can disable JavaScript by setting the JavaScript Enabled key to false. If you save this key in the Often group, the user can enable JavaScript during their current login session but JavaScript is disabled when the user logs out and logs in again.

Some application developers provide preference manifests. A preference manifest simplifies modification of preferences by providing names and descriptions of keys that are honored by an application, and tells you how to set them.

Preference manifests are similar to templates. Theyre not required, so you can edit the preference key value of an application even if it doesnt provide a preference manifest. For applications without preference manifests, you can import a preference file from ~/Library/Preferences, or you can import the application (its preference file is found automatically).

Preference manifests can be stored in an application package (a file ending with .manifest, such as com.apple.Safari.manifest, in the packages /Contents/Resources/ folder), or they can be standalone files. If manifests exist for an application, the preference editor loads them when you add the application to the preference editors list.

When you import preferences for an application, keys and values are added based on the applications currently set preferences. This lets you apply your own configuration of applications to users applications. You can add, remove, or edit keys, but some keys might not be well described if the application doesnt have a preference manifest, or if the key youre editing isnt in the preference manifest.

Adding to the Preference Editors List Before you can manage an application in the preference editor, you must add the application or the applications preference file to the preference editors list. The applications preference file is in ~/Library/Preferences/.

You can manage any application that uses Mac OS X preferences. To do this you must set preferences for a local copy of that application stored on the administration computer; then you can add the .plist file for the application stored in ~/Library/Preferences/ to the preference editors list.

You can also import application preferences when you add the application to the preference editors list.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 233

When you use your own application preferences, you can choose the management frequency applied to those preferences:

Some applications use ByHost preferences. These preferences apply to a specific user for a specific computer. For example, if a network user sets screen saver preferences, they are saved as ByHost preferences. The users screen saver preferences are saved for the current computer but are not applied when the user uses other computers.

If your users typically run Mac OS X v10.5 or later, its usually a good idea to import preferences as ByHost preferences. If your users typically run earlier versions of Mac OS X, dont import preferences as ByHost preferences.

Some applications use but dont properly respect ByHost preferences. Test your settings with Import as ByHost preferences selected and deselected to see if the application youre managing respects ByHost preferences.

To add to the preference editors list: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences and then click Details.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click the Add (+) button.

5 Select an application in /Applications, or a .plist file located in ~/Library/Preferences/.

Applications without preference manifests appear in italics.

6 If youve selected an application and set preferences for it, you can select Import my preferences for this application.

7 Choose a management setting from the Manage imported preferences pop-up menu.

If youve selected a preference file located in ~/Library/Preferences/ByHost and youve chosen Once or Often from the Manage imported preferences pop-up menu, you can select Import as ByHost preferences.

Frequency Description

Once Similar to the Once setting in the main interface. Sets a preference but allows the user to change that preference and retain his or her changes.

Often Only available in the preference editor. Allows users to modify their preferences but the preferences revert to your managed setting every time the user begins a new session.

Always Similar to the Always setting in the main interface. Sets a preference and usually does not allow the user to modify the preference.

234 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

8 Click Add.

9 If youre asked to replace the manifest, click Replace to replace the manifest.

Replacing the manifest changes the underlying manifest file for the application but it doesnt change existing managed preferences.

10 If youre asked to replace the managed preferences, click Replace to remove existing managed preferences and replace them with preferences from the application youre adding.

Editing Application Preferences with the Preference Editor You can use the Workgroup Manager preference editor to edit and manage application-specific preferences.

An application that follows Apple standard conventions for handling preferences will respect the settings in a preference manifest. For applications without preference manifests, test your settings to make sure they produce the desired results.

Before using the preference editor to manage application preferences, add the application or its preference file to the preference editors list. For instructions, see Adding to the Preference Editors List on page 232.

The preference editor divides keys by management frequency, as described below.

Note: Always might still allow users to modify preferences. For this reason, Often is usually a better choice for making persistent preference changes.

Important: When you add or modify keys, always test the additions or changes to make sure they work as expected.

To edit application preferences: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences and then click Details.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

Frequency Description

Once Similar to the Once setting in the main interface. Sets a preference but allows the user to change that preference and retain his or her changes.

Often Only available in the preference editor. Allows users to modify their preferences but the preferences revert to your managed setting when a user begins a new session.

Always Similar to the Always setting in the main interface. Sets a preference and usually does not allow the user to modify the preference.

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 235

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Select an item in the list and click the Edit (pencil) button.

5 To locate the keys you want to change, click the disclosure triangles.

6 To add a key to the applications preferences file, click the disclosure triangle for the frequency, select the frequency, click New Key, click the New Item entry that is created, and choose a key from the pop-up menu, or choose Edit and enter a new key.

If you dont click the disclosure triangle and select the frequency, the New Key button is deactivated.

7 To change the keys current settings, click the keys type or value.

If you change the type to a setting that is not by default enabled by the preference manifest, the preference file editing screen indicates the mismatch with an arrow icon. This does not prevent you from changing the key type or value.

8 Click Apply Now and then click Done.

Removing an Applications Managed Preferences in the Preference Editor You can remove all managed preferences for any entry in the preference editors list.

If you added an application without a preference manifest, the application is also removed from the preference editors list when you remove all of its managed preferences.

This action does not delete an applications preference manifest or the applications preferences file. To remove all preference manifests from Workgroup Manager, close Workgroup Manager and delete ~/Library/Preferences/com.apple.mcx.manifests.

To disable management of an applications preferences: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences and then click Details.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Select an entry with managed preferences.

Entries with managed preferences are noted by a cursor icon in the left column.

This can only be done one entry at a time.

5 Click the Remove () button and then click Remove in the confirmation dialog.

236 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

Using the Preference Editor to Manage Core Services You can add several important manifests by adding a single core services bundle. These manifests allow management of many features that are unavailable through the main preference editing interface.

For example, you can disable Bluetooth, lock iTunes parental controls, and set the license number and registration key for all iWork 08 installations.

Core service manifests include:

By default, these manifests dont show keys. You must click the disclosure triangle next to the frequency, select the frequency, and then click New Key. When you click the name of the new key, youll see all available keys for that frequency.

Some keys will only work with certain management frequencies. For example, you can only enable Disable Bluetooth by adding a new key with the frequency Always.

Manifest Examples of things you can change

Bluetooth Enable or disable Bluetooth

Dashboard Enable or disable Dashboard

Desktop Picture Set the Desktop background image

Dock Customize how the Dock looks

Home Sync Fine-tune mobility settings, such as how to resolve conflicts

iCal Change iCal settings such as Kerberos usage, SSL usage, and refresh intervals

iChat Change iChat settings such as account name and info, and SSL and Kerberos usage

Internet Configuration Change Internet settings such as the mail server, mail information, default web browser, and default mail application

iTunes 7 Set iTunes 7 parental controls and enable or disable podcasts and music sharing

iWork Registration Set iWork 08 registration information

Kerberos Login Set Kerberos name and realm

Managed Menu Extras Add nonstandard menus to the menu bar

Mobile Account & Other Options Change mobile account settings like FileVault use, enable sync encryption, set mobile account lifetime, and customize the mobile account creation dialog

Quicktime Pro Key Set QuickTime registration information

Screen Saver Enable or disable screen saver passwords

VPN Settings Change VPN settings such as VPN server information, login name, and authentication type

Chapter 10 Managing Preferences 237

To add the core services bundle to the preference editor list: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences and then click Details.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

4 Click the Add (+) button.

5 Select /System/Library/CoreServices/ManagedClient.app and click Add.

Using the Preference Editor to Manage Safari Safari is a good example of an application that can be managed by editing its preference manifest.

The Safari version included with Mac OS X v10.5 or later is more configurable than previous versions of Safari. It includes more than 30 configurable preferences, including: Home Page Default Font Command-Click Makes Tabs AutoFill Passwords AutoFill Credit Cards Java Enabled JavaScript Enabled Ask Before Submitting Insecure Forms

When you add Safari to the preference editor list, two entries are added. The com.apple.Safari preference manifest includes most configurable preferences, while com.apple.WebFoundation includes a configurable preference for the cookie acceptance policy.

By default, these manifests dont show any keys. You must click the disclosure triangle next to the frequency, then select the frequency and click New Key. When you click the name of the new key, youll see all available keys for that frequency.

To add Safari to the preference editor list: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Preferences and then click Details.

2 Make sure the correct directory is selected and you are authenticated.

To switch directories, click the globe icon. If you are not authenticated, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

3 Select one or more users, groups, computers, or computer groups.

238 Chapter 10 Managing Preferences

4 Click the Add (+) button, select /Applications/Safari, and then click Add.

The preference manifests included with older versions of Safari dont have as many configurable preferences as the Safari version included with Mac OS X v10.5 or later. You can replace old Safari preference manifests by adding the new Safari application, and then clicking Replace in the dialog that appears.

5 To edit Safari preferences, select Safari (with the Preference ID com.apple.Safari), click the Edit (pencil) button, and then add keys youd like to manage.

For more information, see Editing Application Preferences with the Preference Editor on page 234.

11

239

11 Solving Problems

If you encounter problems as you work with Workgroup Manager, you may find a solution in this chapter.

If the answer to your question isnt here, try searching Workgroup Manager Help for new topics. You can also search the Apple Service & Support website for information and solutions at www.apple.com/support/.

Diagnosing Common Network Issues Before you try the solutions in this chapter, make sure your network is properly configured.

In particular, test your Network Time Protocol (NTP), Domain Name System (DNS), and Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) services.

For more information about NTP, DNS, or DHCP, see Network Services Administration.

Testing Your Networks Time and Time Zones The many technologies and services in Mac OS X Server rely on having accurate time settings on all networked computers.

Typically, computers are connected to an NTP server that provides accurate time settings. You should still check your networked computers time settings using Apple Remote Desktop (not included with Mac OS X Server). For more information about Apple Remote Desktop, see www.apple.com/remotedesktop.

You can send the commands in the following procedure using the ssh command. You can also test and correct a computers time settings in System Preferences. Both methods allow you to test and correct one computer at a time, but with Apple Remote Desktop you can test and correct many computers simultaneously.

To test your network computer time and time zones using Apple Remote Desktop: 1 In Apple Remote Desktop, send the following UNIX command to all computers:

sudo systemsetup -gettimezone

240 Chapter 11 Solving Problems

Your computers should be on the same time zone. If they are not on the same time zone, send the following UNIX command:

sudo systemsetup -settimezone US/Pacific

For other time zones, see the man page for systemsetup. For instructions on sending UNIX commands through Apple Remote Desktop, see the Apple Remote Desktop Administrators Guide.

2 In Apple Remote Desktop, send the following UNIX command to all computers:

sudo systemsetup -gettime

Your computers should have times within a few minutes of each other. If they have a wide range of times, send the following UNIX command:

sudo systemsetup -settime current_time

Replace current_time with the current time in 24-hour format, using HH:MM:SS (hour, minute, second) notation.

Testing Your DNS Service Your DNS service should allow you to discover a servers domain name when given an IP address, or to retrieve an IP address when given a domain name. If your computers cant do these tasks, perform further analysis on your DNS service. For a detailed description of DNS and for instructions on configuring DNS, see Network Services Administration.

If you have Apple Remote Desktop installed, you can quickly test your entire network. In Apple Remote Desktop, create a scanner that displays computers with IP addresses in the range distributed by your DHCP server. If a computer is turned on, is not in sleep mode, and is connected to your network, the computer should be in the scanner.

The scanner displays the IP address given to the computer and the computers host name. Computers that are not assigned host names by the DNS service are listed without host names. If a computer is listed and has an appropriate IP address and host name, the computer is receiving DHCP and DNS service.

For more information about how to use scanners in Apple Remote Desktop, see the Apple Remote Desktop Administrators Guide.

If you do not have Apple Remote Desktop installed, you can perform the following task to test a single computers ability to receive DNS service.

To test your networks DNS service on a single computer: 1 On a network computer that is not the server providing DNS service, open Network

Utility.

2 In the Lookup pane of Network Utility, enter the domain name of your Open Directory master server and click Lookup.

Chapter 11 Solving Problems 241

The resulting log should have an answer section, which displays the IP address of your Open Directory master server. If there is no answer section, or if the IP address is incorrect, perform further analysis on your DNS service.

3 In the Lookup pane of Network Utility, enter the IP address of your Open Directory master server and click Lookup.

The resulting log should displays the domain name of your Open Directory master server. If the domain name is incorrect, perform further analysis on your DNS service.

Note: Instead of using Network Utility, you can use the dig tool in Terminal. Enter the following command in Terminal:

dig name_or_address

Replace name_or_address with the domain name or the IP address of your Open Directory master server. The resulting log should have an answer section with the correct IP address or domain name.

Testing Your DHCP Service Your DHCP service should be configured to supply enough IP addresses to serve your network. If a computer does not have a valid IP address, it cant be contacted through your network. For a detailed description of DHCP and for instructions on configuring DHCP, see Network Services Administration.

If you have Apple Remote Desktop installed, you can quickly test your entire network. In Apple Remote Desktop, create a scanner that displays computers with IP addresses in the range distributed by your DHCP server. If a computer is turned on, is not in sleep mode, and is connected to your network, the computer should be in the scanner.

The scanner displays the IP address given to the computer, and the computers host name. Computers that are not assigned host names by the DNS service are listed without host names. If a computer is listed and has an appropriate IP address and host name, the computer is receiving DHCP and DNS service.

For more information about how to use scanners in Apple Remote Desktop, see the Apple Remote Desktop Administrators Guide.

If you do not have Apple Remote Desktop installed, you can perform the following task to test a single computers ability to receive DHCP service.

To test your networks DHCP service on a single computer: 1 In Server Admin, click the disclosure triangle to the left of the server providing DHCP

service.

This displays all of the servers services.

2 Select DHCP and click Subnets.

The Subnets pane lists the addresses your DHCP server supplies.

242 Chapter 11 Solving Problems

3 On a client computer, open Network Utility, click Info, and then select the network interface that connects to your network.

If the displayed IP address is not in your range of supplied addresses, the computer is not receiving an IP address through your DHCP service.

If the IP address is 169.254.x.x, it is a self-assigned IP address. This means your computer is not receiving DHCP service.

If the IP address is not an assigned address and is not 169.254.x.x, the computer is receiving DHCP service from a DHCP server other than yours.

Solving Account Problems Follow the suggestions in this section when problems arise with user and group account administration.

If You Want to Use Earlier Versions of Workgroup Manager If you have administrative applications and tools from Mac OS X Server v10.4 or earlier, do not use them with Mac OS X Server v10.5 or later.

You can use Mac OS X Server v10.5 applications to administer Mac OS X Server v10.4.

If You Cant Edit an Account Using Workgroup Manager Editable domains include the local directory domain, Open Directory domains, and other read/write directory domains.

Before you can edit an account using Workgroup Manager, you must first authenticate as a domain administrator. To authenticate, click the lock near the top of the Workgroup Manager window.

If Users Cant See Their Names in the Login Window When you upgrade Mac OS X and migrate users to a shared directory on the new server, some users might not appear in the login window. The login window does not list system users, but they can still log in by entering their user names and passwords.

The login window lists particular types of users depending on how Login preferences are managed. For more information, see Changing the Appearance of the Login Window on page 189.

If You Cant Unlock an LDAP Directory To make changes in a directory domain, you must authenticate with the name and password of a directory administrator. Therefore, to edit an entry in a shared LDAPv3 directory domain, you must authenticate in Workgroup Manager with the name and password of an administrator account in that LDAPv3 directory domain.

Chapter 11 Solving Problems 243

An administrator account in the computers local directory domain cant be used to authenticate as an administrator of a shared LDAP directory.

If You Cant Modify a Users Open Directory Password To modify the password of a user whose password type is Open Directory, you must be an administrator of the directory domain where the users record resides. In addition, your user account must have a password type of Open Directory.

Setting up an Open Directory master (using Server Assistant or the Open Directory service settings in Server Admin) creates a directory administrator account with an Open Directory password. This account can be used to set up other user accounts as directory domain administrators with Open Directory passwords.

If You Cant Change a Users Password Type to Open Directory To change a users password type to Open Directory authentication, you must be an administrator of the directory domain where the users record resides. In addition, your user account must be configured for Open Directory authentication.

When the Open Directory master was set up (using the Open Directory service settings in Server Admin) the initial user account is a domain administrator account with an Open Directory password. This account can be used to set up other user accounts as domain administrators with Open Directory passwords.

If You Cant Assign Server Administrator Privileges To assign server administrator privileges to a user on a particular server, connect to the server in Workgroup Manager and authenticate in the directory domain. Select the users account (or create an account for the user), and then select User can administer this server in the Basic pane.

If Users Cant Log In or Authenticate If a user cant log in or authenticate to his or her account, a number of approaches might be required to determine whether the source of the authentication problem is configuration-related or due to the password. Try these techniques: Reset the password to a known value and then determine whether there is still a

problem. Try using a 7-bit ASCII password, which is supported by most clients. Make sure the password contains characters supported by the authentication

protocol. Leading, embedded, and trailing spaces, as well as special characters (such as pressing Option-8 to form a bullet), are not supported by some protocols. For example, leading spaces work with POP and AFP, but not IMAP.

Make sure the users keyboard can generate all characters in the users password. Crypt passwords dont support many authentication methods. To increase the

probability that a users client applications are supported, set the users password type to Open Directory or suggest that the user try a different application.

244 Chapter 11 Solving Problems

If the users account resides in a directory domain that is not available, create a user account in a directory domain that is available.

Make sure the client software encodes the password so it is recognized correctly. For example, Open Directory recognizes UTF-8 encoded strings, which may not be sent by some clients.

Make sure the users current application and operating system support the users password length. For example, Windows applications that use the LAN Manager authentication method support only 14-character passwords, so a password longer than 14 characters causes an authentication failure even though Windows service supports longer passwords.

If you disabled authentication methods for Open Directory or shadow passwords (such as APOP or LAN Manager) the users applications cant authenticate using the disabled methods. After enabling or disabling Open Directory Password Server or shadow password authentication methods, you might need to reset the users password.

For information about enabling and disabling authentication methods, see Open Directory Administration.

For Kerberos troubleshooting tips, see If Users Cant Authenticate Using Single Sign- On or Kerberos on page 245.

If a Mac OS v8.18.6 computer fails to authenticate for Apple file service, the computers AppleShare Client software may need upgrading: Mac OS v8.6 computers should use AppleShare Client v3.8.8. Mac OS v8.18.5 computers should use AppleShare Client v3.8.6. Mac OS v8.18.6 computers that have file server volumes mount during startup

should use AppleShare Client v3.8.3 with DHX UAM (User Authentication Module) installed. DHX UAM is included with the AppleShare Client v3.8.3 installation software.

If Users Relying on a Password Server Cant Log In If your network has a server with Mac OS X Server v10.2, it could receive authentication from an Open Directory Password Server hosted by another server. If the Password Servers computer disconnects from your networkfor example, because you unplug the cable from the computers Ethernet portusers whose passwords are validated using the Password Server cant log in because their servers IP address isnt accessible.

Users can log in to Mac OS X Server if you reconnect the Password Servers computer to the network. Alternately, while the Password Servers computer is offline, users can log in with user accounts whose password type is crypt or shadow password.

Chapter 11 Solving Problems 245

If Users Cant Log In with Accounts in a Shared Directory Domain Users cant log in using accounts in a shared directory domain if the server hosting the directory isnt accessible. A server can become inaccessible due to a problem with the network, the server software, or the server hardware.

Problems with the server hardware or software affect users trying to log in to Mac OS X computers and users trying to log in to the Windows domain of a Mac OS X Server primary domain controller (PDC). Network problems can affect some users but not others, depending on where the network problem is.

Users with mobile user accounts can still log in to the Mac OS X computers they used previously. Users affected by these problems can log in using a local user account defined on the computer, such as the user account created during setup after installing Mac OS X.

If Users Cant Access Their Home Folders Make sure users can access the share point where their home folders are located, and make sure they can access their home folders. Users need Read access to the share point and Read & Write access to home folders.

If Users Cant Change Their Passwords Users who have accounts in the servers LDAP directory with a crypt password cant change passwords after logging in.

These users can change passwords if you use the Advanced pane to change their accounts User Password Type setting to Open Directory. When you make this change, you must also enter a new password. Then you should instruct users to log in using this new password and change it in the Accounts pane of System Preferences.

If Users Cant Authenticate Using Single Sign-On or Kerberos There are several ways to remedy Kerberos authentication failures. You can find these solutions, as well as a full description of how to reconfigure a servers computer record for single sign-on and Kerberos authentication, in Open Directory Administration.

Problems with a Primary or Backup Domain Controller Problems with a primary domain controller (PDC) or backup domain controller (BDC) can have several causes.

If a Windows User Cant Log in to the Windows Domain Verify the following: Make sure the user account has a password type of Open Directory. Make sure the workstation has joined the Windows domain of Mac OS X Server.

246 Chapter 11 Solving Problems

If a Windows User Has No Home Folder If a users home folder isnt mounted in Windows, verify the following: Make sure the correct home folder location is selected in the Home pane of

Workgroup Manager. Make sure the home folder path is correct in the Windows pane of Workgroup

Manager. It should be blank to use the home folder specified in the Home pane. Using Server Admin, connect to the server where the users home folder resides. In

the Servers list, select SMB, click Advanced, and then make sure Enable virtual share points is selected.

If the drive letter chosen for the user might be conflicting with a drive letter thats in use on the Windows workstation, change the drive letter setting in the Windows pane of Workgroup Manager or the mappings of other drive letters on the workstation.

If a Windows Users Profile Settings Revert to Defaults There are several reasons why a users profile settings may revert to default: If the user profile location is not blank in the Windows pane of Workgroup Manager,

the default share point for user profiles is not used. In this case, the user profile location must specify a valid SMB share point. Make sure the user profile location specifies an existing share point. For more information, see Setting Up an SMB Share Point on page 119.

Make sure the home folder is specified correctly in the Windows and Home panes of Workgroup Manager. These panes should be configured in one of the following ways: If the home folder path in the Windows pane is blank, make sure the correct home

folder location is selected in the Home pane. If the home folder path is not blank in the Windows pane, make sure the home

folder path specifies a valid SMB share point. If the drive letter chosen for the user might be conflicting with a drive letter in use

on the Windows workstation, change the drive letter setting in the Windows pane of Workgroup Manager or change the mappings of other drive letters on the workstation.

If a Windows User Loses the Contents of the My Documents Folder Verify the following: Make sure the correct home folder location is selected in the Home pane of

Workgroup Manager. Make sure the user profile path is correct in the Windows pane of Workgroup

Manager. If the user profile path is blank, the default profile folder is used. The contents of My Documents are stored in the user profile.

Chapter 11 Solving Problems 247

If the drive letter chosen for the user might be conflicting with a drive letter in use on the Windows workstation, change the drive letter setting in the Windows pane of Workgroup Manager or change the mappings of other drive letters on the workstation.

Solving Preference Management Problems This section describes problems you might encounter while using Workgroup Manager to set up accounts or manage Mac OS X clients. It also provides troubleshooting tips and possible solutions.

If your problem is not addressed here, check Workgroup Manager Help or consult the Apple Service & Support website (www.apple.com/support/).

Testing Your Managed Client Settings If your managed computers use Mac OS X v10.5 or later, you can view managed settings in System Profiler on the computers.

Settings are organized by preference. For example, all managed Finder settings are listed in com.apple.finder.

To view managed client settings in System Profiler: 1 On a client computer, open System Profiler.

2 Open the Software disclosure triangle and then choose Managed Client.

If Users Dont See a List of Workgroups at Login If a user with a network account doesnt see a list of workgroups at login: The user may not be in a group or may be in only one group. Hold down the Option

key during login to show the list of workgroups. The users computer may not have its login preferences managed. In the Access pane

of login preferences, select Always show workgroup dialog during login. This preference is only available for clients with Mac OS X v10.5 or later.

Your client computers must use Mac OS X v10.4 or later to select from workgroups. For more information about how to set login window access settings, see Customizing the Workgroups Displayed at Login on page 193.

If Users Cant Open Files Ordinarily, when users double-click a file in the Finder, or choose a file to open from the File menu in Finder, an appropriate default application opens the file for them. If the user is in a managed environment, this method might not always work.

248 Chapter 11 Solving Problems

For example, suppose the default application for viewing PDF files is Preview. A user logs in and double-clicks a PDF file on his or her desktop. If the management settings that apply to the user dont provide access to Preview, the file does not open. If the user has access to a different application that can handle PDF files, the user can open that application first and then open the file.

To make sure commonly used applications are available to users, groups, or lists of computers, use Workgroup Manager to add the application to the list of permitted applications in the Applications pane of Preferences.

For more information, see Controlling User Access to Specific Applications and Folders on page 165.

If Users Cant Add Printers to a Printer List If you manage Printing preferences, you can allow users to add printers to the list of printers in Print & Fax System Preferences. In Printing preferences, select Allow user to modify the printer list. If you dont select this, an administrator name and password is required to add or remove printers in Print & Fax System Preferences.

Note: When a user tries to print a document from an application, the printer the user added does not appear in the list of available printers.

For more information, see Preventing Users from Modifying the Printer List on page 221.

You can also make printers available or unavailable to specific users, groups, or lists of computers by using the Printer List pane of Printing preferences.

For more information, see Making Printers Available to Users on page 221.

If Login Items Added by a User Dont Open In Workgroup Manager, you can use the Items pane of login preferences to specify items that open when a user logs in. The items that open at login are a combination of items specified for the user, the computer being used, and the group chosen at login.

If your management frequency setting is Always, when you select User may add and remove additional items, a user can add additional login items. Selecting Always removes existing items from the users login items list and replaces them with the items you list. It also prevents the user from disabling the items you list.

If your management frequency setting is Once, you can select Merge with users items, which causes one of two effects: If the user has items in their login list (either he or she added them or they were

added through preference management), merging only opens login items that appear on both the users list and your list.

Chapter 11 Solving Problems 249

If the users login list does not include any items, all managed login items will open. If you do not select Merge with users items, all login items on either list will open. If you select Once, a user can remove any items added to their login list.

For details about managing automatically opened items, see Automatically Opening Items After a User Logs In on page 197.

If Items Placed in the Dock by a User Are Missing In Workgroup Manager, you can use the Dock Items pane of Dock preferences to specify items that appear in a users Dock. The set of items in a users Dock is a combination of items specified for the user, the computer being used, and the group chosen at login.

If you deselect Merge with users Dock, all Dock items you place will override users Dock items settings. Users cant add items to their Docks if you select Always and deselect Merge with users Dock.

If you select Always, users cant remove items from their Docks.

For more information about how to add Dock items, see Adding Items to a Users Dock on page 176.

If a Users Dock Has Duplicate Items When you use Workgroup Manager to set up the same Dock item preferences for more than one account type (user, group, computer, or computer group), a managed users Dock can contain duplicate items. For example, an application icon may appear more than once in the users Dock.

Duplicate applications or folders work as expected when you open them. To correct duplicate Dock items, try removing Dock item preferences for all account types that affect the user, then carefully configure the Dock item preferences for the account types.

If Users See a Question Mark in the Dock You can use Workgroup Manager to control what items a user sees in his or her Dock. Items in the Dock are aliases to original items stored elsewhere, such as on the computers hard disk or on a remote server.

If you add items to a users Dock that are not on the users hard disk or other volume mounted on the users computer, the items appear as question mark icons. Clicking these icons does not open the items.

If you add an item that is on both the server and the users computer, clicking the icon opens the item on the users computer or mounted volume.

250 Chapter 11 Solving Problems

If Users See a Message About an Unexpected Error When you manage Classic preferences and try to use the Extensions Manager, File Sharing, or Software Update control panels, you might see a message that says The operation could not be completed. An unexpected error occurred (error code 1016).

This message indicates that an administrator has restricted access to the item the user attempted to use, such as an application the user is not allowed to open.

Users cant access the control panels mentioned above when Classic preferences are managed. Users may also see this message if you select Hide Chooser and Network Browser and they attempt to use the Chooser.

The message also appears when a user tries to open an unapproved application (one not listed in the Items pane of the Applications preference in Workgroup Manager) in the Classic environment or in Mac OS X.

If You Cant Manage Network Views Mac OS X Server v10.5 doesnt support managed network views.

To manage network views hosted on servers running Mac OS X Server v10.4, use the Workgroup Manager included with Mac OS X Server v10.4.

251

A pp

en di

x

Importing and Exporting Account Information

Use Workgroup Manager to import and export accounts, or use the dsimport command-line tool to import accounts.

You can quickly import or export user, group, computer, and computer group accounts using Workgroup Manager. You can also use the dsimport command-line tool to import user and group accounts.

Understanding What You Can Import and Export You can import all record types that are tracked in Workgroup Manager. Common record types include users, groups, computers, and computer groups. Starting with Mac OS X Server v10.4, you can even import partial attributes of individual records, and combine attributes from different records.

When importing from custom files, the only attribute a record must have is a record name.

For a list of attributes, open Terminal and enter man DirectoryServiceAttributes. Alternately, if you have Xcode installed, you can view a list of attributes with improved formatting and more detailed descriptions by opening: /System/Library/Frameworks/DirectoryService.framework/Headers/DirServicesConst.h

You cant use an import file to change the following predefined users: daemon, root, nobody, unknown, or www. In addition, you cant use an import file to change the following predefined groups: admin, bin, daemon, dialer, mail, network, nobody, nogroup, operator, staff, sys, tty unknown, utmp, uucp, wheel, or www. However, you can add users to the wheel and admin groups.

You can use the dsimport tool to import records from a text-delimited file.

For descriptions of common record types and attributes, see Open Directory Administration. For a more complete list of attributes, enter man DirectoryServiceAttributes, or view the DirServicesConst.h file.

252 Appendix Importing and Exporting Account Information

Limitations for Importing and Exporting Passwords When creating or overwriting records, you must reset passwords for user accounts with Open Directory or shadow passwords. Importing passwords generally works if the password is a plain-text string in the import file.

Additionally, you must set the AuthMethod attribute so Workgroup Manager can import the password. Encrypted passwords in hash format in the import file cant be recovered.

Passwords cant be exported using Workgroup Manager or any other method. If you import user accounts from an export file, remember to manually set passwords or set default passwords to a known value.

Before exporting user accounts (or after importing them), you can set up a password policy that requires users to change their password at first login. For instructions on configuring password options, see Choosing a Password Type and Setting Password Options on page 74.

Maintaining GUIDs When Importing from Earlier Versions of Mac OS X Server Globally unique identifiers (GUIDs) are used to verify user and group identity for ACL permissions and to manage user membership in groups and hierarchical groups. When you use Workgroup Manager or the dsimport tool to import users and groups created on versions of Mac OS X Server earlier than v10.4, GUIDs are automatically assigned.

After upgrading or migrating your server to Mac OS X Server v10.5, back up your accounts by exporting user and group accounts to ensure that all your accounts have GUIDs.

If you need to restore user or group accounts in the future, the generated export file enables you to import users and groups with their GUIDs (as well as file permissions and group memberships) intact.

If you lose user accounts and create new accounts with the same UID, GID, and short names as the lost accounts, the replacement accounts have new GUIDs assigned. A users new GUID wont match the previous GUID, so the user wont retain prior ACL permissions or group memberships.

Similarly, if you import users or groups from a file that doesnt include the GUID attribute, Mac OS X Server assigns new GUIDs to every imported user and group.

To make sure that GUIDs and their relationship to specific users and groups remain the same if you need to re-import users and groups, create a new export file on Mac OS X Server v10.5 and use this file instead of the export file created with an earlier server version.

Appendix Importing and Exporting Account Information 253

Archiving the Open Directory Master Instead of exporting and importing records as a backup of directory data, you can archive and restore the Open Directory masters directory and authentication data. By archiving a copy of the Open Directory masters directory, you can later restore the directory with passwords intact.

For more information and instructions on archiving the Open Directory master, see Open Directory Administration.

Using Workgroup Manager to Import Accounts You can use Workgroup Manager to import user, group, computer, and computer group accounts into an Open Directory domain. When a file is imported, Workgroup Manager identifies the record format.

Before trying to import accounts using Workgroup Manager, create a character- delimited or XML file containing the accounts to import and place it in a location accessible by the computer from which you use Workgroup Manager.

An Open Directory domain supports files with up to 200,000 records.

Important: Workgroup Manager can only import files that use UNIX line breaks. When editing import files, use a text editor that supports UNIX line breaks.

You can also use the dsimport tool to import records from a text-delimited file. For more information, see Command-Line Administration.

For information about how to create import files using previous versions of Mac OS X Server, see: Using XML Files Created with Mac OS X Server v10.1 or Earlier on page 255 Using XML Files Created with AppleShare IP 6.3 on page 256

For information about how to create a character-delimited file by hand or by using a database or spreadsheet application, see Command-Line Administration.

To import accounts using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Make sure that the directory services of the Mac OS X Server computer youre using are configured to access the directory domain.

For instructions, see Open Directory Administration.

3 Click the globe icon and choose the domain where you want to import accounts.

4 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

5 Choose Server > Import and select an import file.

254 Appendix Importing and Exporting Account Information

6 To indicate what to do when the short name of an account being imported matches that of an existing account, select one of the Duplicate Handling options:

Overwrite existing record overwrites any existing record in the directory domain. Ignore new record ignores an account in the import file. Add to empty fields merges data from the import file into the existing account

when the data is for an attribute that has no value. Append to existing record appends data to existing data for a particular multivalue

attribute in the existing account. Duplicates are not created. This option could be used when importing members into an existing group.

Dont check for duplicates disables checking for duplicates, but it can cause misconfigured records and unexpected results. Make sure there are no duplicates before choosing this option. When you enable this option, it can decrease the time required to import.

7 To enable presets for a user or a group, select Preset for Users or Preset for Groups and choose presets from the two pop-up menus.

If a setting is specified in both the preset and an import file, the value in the file is used. If a setting is specified in the preset but not in the import file, the value in the preset is used.

For more information about how to create presets, see Creating a Preset for User Accounts on page 61 and Creating a Preset for Group Accounts on page 92.

8 In the First User ID field, enter a user ID for new user accounts without user IDs in the import file.

New User IDs are then sequentially assigned for other accounts without listed user IDs.

9 In the Primary Group ID field, enter the group ID to assign to new user accounts for users that have no primary group ID in the import file.

10 Choose the level of detail for the log from the Logging Detail pop-up menu.

Every time you import, a new log is created in ~/Library/Logs/ImportExport/.

11 Click Import.

Using Workgroup Manager to Export Accounts You can use Workgroup Manager to export user, group, computer, and computer group accounts from an Open Directory domain into a character-delimited file that you can import into a different LDAP directory domain.

You can also use the dsexport tool to export records to a text-delimited file. For more information, see Command-Line Administration.

Appendix Importing and Exporting Account Information 255

To export accounts using Workgroup Manager: 1 In Workgroup Manager, click Accounts.

2 Make sure that the directory services of the Mac OS X Server youre using are configured to access the desired directory domain.

For instructions, see Open Directory Administration.

3 Click the globe icon and then choose the domain where you want to import accounts.

4 To authenticate, click the lock and enter the name and password of a directory domain administrator.

5 Select the accounts to export.

To choose multiple accounts to export, select the accounts while holding the Command or Shift key.

6 Choose Server > Export.

7 Specify the name to assign to the export file and where you want to create it.

To browse to a location for storing the export file, click the disclosure triangle.

8 Click Export.

Using XML Files Created with Mac OS X Server v10.1 or Earlier You can use Server Admin in Mac OS X Server v10.1 or earlier to create an export file and import that file into an Open Directory domain using Workgroup Manager or dsimport.

The following user account attributes are exported into the XML files. An error occurs when you import a file with missing required attributes: Indication of whether user can log in Indication of whether user is a server administrator User ID (required) Primary group ID (required) Shell Comment Short name (required) Long name (required) Password format (required) and password text (required) Apple mail data ARA (Apple Remote Accessthis data is ignored)

256 Appendix Importing and Exporting Account Information

The following group account attributes might be present in the XML files: Group name (required) Group ID (required) One members short name (required) Other members short names

Using XML Files Created with AppleShare IP 6.3 You can use the Web & File Admin application on an AppleShare IP 6.3 server to create an export file and then use Workgroup Manager or dsimport to import that file into an Open Directory domain.

The following user account attributes are exported into the XML files. An error occurs when you import a file with missing required attributes. Name (required, mapped to a long name) InetAlias (mapped to a short name) Comment Indication of whether user can log in Password format (required) and password text (required) Apple mail data Indicator for whether the user is a server administrator, password change data, and

indicator for forcing a password to change (this data is ignored)

The dsimport tool generates user IDs when you import this XML file, using the -s parameter to determine the user ID to start with and incrementing each subsequent imported accounts user ID by one. It generates primary group IDs using the -r parameter.

When you import using Workgroup Manager, user IDs and primary group IDs are generated as you indicate in the dialog provided.

The following group account attributes might be present in these XML files: Group name (required) One members short name (required) Other members short names

The dsimport tool generates group IDs when you import this XML file, using the -r parameter to determine the group ID to start with, and incrementing each subsequent imported groups ID by one.

When you import using Workgroup Manager, group IDs are generated using the information you provide for group IDs in the import dialog.

257

G lo

ss ar

yGlossary

This glossary defines terms and spells out abbreviations you may encounter while working with online help or the various reference manuals for Mac OS X Server. References to terms defined elsewhere in the glossary appear in italics.

access control list See ACL.

ACE Access Control Entry. An entry within the ACL that controls access rights. See ACL.

ACL Access Control List. A list, maintained by a system, that defines the rights of users and groups to access resources on the system.

Active Directory The directory and authentication service of Microsoft Windows 2000 Server, Windows Server 2003, and Windows Server 2003 R2.

administrator A user with server or directory domain administration privileges. Administrators are always members of the predefined admin group.

administrator computer A Mac OS X computer onto which youve installed the server administration applications from the Mac OS X Server Admin CD.

AFP Apple Filing Protocol. A client/server protocol used by Apple file service to share files and network services. AFP uses TCP/IP and other protocols to support communication between computers on a network.

Apple Filing Protocol See AFP.

automount To make a share point appear automatically on a client computer. See also mount.

blog A webpage that presents chronologically ordered entries. Often used as an electronic journal or newsletter.

BSD Berkeley Software Distribution. A version of UNIX on which Mac OS X software is based.

child A computer that gets configuration information from the shared directory domain of a parent.

258 Glossary

computer account A computer account stores data that allows Mac OS X Server to identify and manage an individual computer. You create a computer account for each computer that you intend to add to a computer group. See also computer group.

computer group A set of computers and computer groups, which all receive the managed preference settings defined for the group. New in Mac OS X Server version 10.5. See also computer list.

computer list A set of computers that all receive the managed preference settings defined for the list, and that are all available to a particular set of users and groups. A computer can be a member of only one computer list. Computer lists are created in Mac OS X Server version 10.4 or earlier. See also computer group.

DHCP Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol. A protocol used to dynamically distribute IP addresses to client computers. Each time a client computer starts up, the protocol looks for a DHCP server and then requests an IP address from the DHCP server it finds. The DHCP server checks for an available IP address and sends it to the client computer along with a lease periodthe length of time the client computer may use the address.

directory domain A specialized database that stores authoritative information about users and network resources; the information is needed by system software and applications. The database is optimized to handle many requests for information and to find and retrieve information quickly. Also called a directory node or simply a directory.

directory domain hierarchy A way of organizing local and shared directory domains. A hierarchy has an inverted tree structure, with a root domain at the top and local domains at the bottom.

directory node See directory domain.

directory services Services that provide system software and applications with uniform access to directory domains and other sources of information about users and resources.

disc Optical storage media, such as a CD or DVD.

disk A rewritable data storage device. See also disk drive, logical disk.

disk drive A device that contains a disk and reads and writes data to the disk.

disk image A file that, when opened, creates an icon on a Mac OS X desktop that looks and acts like an actual disk or volume. Using NetBoot, client computers can start up over the network from a server-based disk image that contains system software. Disk image files have a filename extension of either .img or .dmg. The two image formats are similar and are represented with the same icon in the Finder. The .dmg format cannot be used on computers running Mac OS 9.

Glossary 259

DNS Domain Name System. A distributed database that maps IP addresses to domain names. A DNS server, also known as a name server, keeps a list of names and the IP addresses associated with each name.

drop box A shared folder with privileges that allow other users to write to, but not read, the folders contents. Only the owner has full access. Drop boxes should be created only using AFP. When a folder is shared using AFP, the ownership of an item written to the folder is automatically transferred to the owner of the folder, thus giving the owner of a drop box full access to and control over items put into it.

everyone Any user who can log in to a file server: a registered user or guest, an anonymous FTP user, or a website visitor.

export In the Network File System (NFS), a way of sharing a folder with clients on a network.

external account A mobile account whose local home folder is stored on an external volume. When the user connects the external volume to a computer, the user can access the external account. When the external volume is disconnected, the user cant access the external account.

filter A screening method to control access to a server. A filter is made up of an IP address and a subnet mask, and sometimes a port number and access type. The IP address and the subnet mask determine the range of IP addresses that the filter applies to.

firewall Software that protects the network applications running on your server. IP firewall service, which is part of Mac OS X Server software, scans incoming IP packets and rejects or accepts these packets based on a set of filters you create.

FTP File Transfer Protocol. A protocol that allows computers to transfer files over a network. FTP clients using any operating system that supports FTP can connect to a file server and download files, depending on their access privileges. Most Internet browsers and a number of freeware applications can be used to access an FTP server.

full name See long name.

globally unique identifier See GUID.

group A collection of users who have similar needs. Groups simplify the administration of shared resources.

group folder A folder that organizes documents and applications of special interest to group members and allows group members to pass information among themselves.

guest computer A computer that doesnt have a computer account.

guest user A user who can log in to your server without a user name or password.

260 Glossary

GUID Globally unique identifier. A hexadecimal string that uniquely identifies a user account, group account, or computer list. Also used to provide user and group identity for access control list (ACL) permissions, and to associate particular users with group and nested group memberships. GUIDs are 128-bit values, which makes the generation of duplicate GUIDs extremely unlikely.

home directory See home folder.

home folder A folder for a users personal use. Mac OS X also uses the home folder to store system preferences and managed user settings for Mac OS X users. Also known as a home directory.

HTML Hypertext Markup Language. The set of symbols or codes inserted in a file to be displayed on a web browser page. The markup tells the web browser how to display a webpages words and images for the user.

HTTP Hypertext Transfer Protocol. The client/server protocol for the World Wide Web. HTTP provides a way for a web browser to access a web server and request hypermedia documents created using HTML.

idle user A user who is connected to a server but hasnt used the server volume for a period of time.

IP Internet Protocol. Also known as IPv4. A method used with Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) to send data between computers over a local network or the Internet. IP delivers data packets and TCP keeps track of data packets.

IP address A unique numeric address that identifies a computer on the Internet.

IP subnet A portion of an IP network, which may be a physically independent network segment, that shares a network address with other portions of the network and is identified by a subnet number.

ISP Internet service provider. A business that sells Internet access and often provides web hosting for e-commerce applications as well as mail services.

Kerberos A secure network authentication system. Kerberos uses tickets, which are issued for a specific user, service, and period of time. After a user is authenticated, its possible to access additional services without retyping a password (called single sign- on) for services that have been configured to take Kerberos tickets. Mac OS X Server uses Kerberos v5.

LDAP Lightweight Directory Access Protocol. A standard client-server protocol for accessing a directory domain.

load balancing The process of distributing client computers requests for network services across multiple servers to optimize performance.

Glossary 261

local directory domain A directory of identification, authentication, authorization, and other administrative data thats accessible only on the computer where it resides. The local directory domain isnt accessible from other computers on the network.

local domain A directory domain that can be accessed only by the computer it resides on.

local home directory See local home folder.

local home folder A home folder that resides on disk on the computer a user is logged in to. Its accessible only by logging directly in to the computer where it resides, unless you log in to the computer using SSH.

local hostname A name that designates a computer on a local subnet. It can be used without a global DNS system to resolve names to IP addresses. It consists of lowercase letters, numbers, or hyphens (except as the last characters), and ends with .local (For example, bills-computer.local). Although the default name is derived from the computer name, a user can specify this name in the Sharing pane of System Preferences. It can be changed easily, and can be used anywhere a DNS name or fully qualified domain name is used. It can only resolve on the same subnet as the computer using it.

logical disk A storage device that appears to a user as a single disk for storing files, even though it might actually consist of more than one physical disk drive. An Xsan volume, for example, is a logical disk that behaves like a single disk even though it consists of multiple storage pools that are, in turn, made up of multiple LUNs, each of which contains multiple disk drives. See also physical disk.

long name The long form of a user or group name. See also user name.

managed client A user, group, or computer whose access privileges and/or preferences are under administrative control.

managed preferences System or application preferences that are under administrative control. Workgroup Manager allows administrators to control settings for certain system preferences for Mac OS X managed clients.

mobile account An account with both a local and a network home folder. Mobile accounts cache authentication information and managed preferences. In Mac OS X v10.4 and later, a mobile account includes a portable home directory, which is a synced subset of the local and network home folders.

mount (verb) To make a remote directory or volume available for access on a local system. In Xsan, to cause an Xsan volume to appear on a clients desktop, just like a local disk.

262 Glossary

multicast DNS A protocol developed by Apple for automatic discovery of computers, devices, and services on IP networks. Called Bonjour (previously Rendezvous) by Apple, this proposed Internet standard protocol is sometimes referred to as ZeroConf or multicast DNS. For more information, visit www.apple.com or www.zeroconf.org. To see how this protocol is used in Mac OS X Server, see local hostname.

name server A server on a network that keeps a list of names and the IP addresses associated with each name. See also DNS.

NetBIOS Network Basic Input/Output System. A program that allows applications on different computers to communicate within a local area network.

NetBoot server A Mac OS X server youve installed NetBoot software on and have configured to allow clients to start up from disk images on the server.

NetInfo An older Apple protocol for accessing a directory domain.

NFS Network File System. A client/server protocol that uses Internet Protocol (IP) to allow remote users to access files as though they were local. NFS can export shared volumes to computers based on IP address, and also supports single sign-on (SSO) authentication through Kerberos.

NTP Network Time Protocol. A network protocol used to synchronize the clocks of computers across a network to some time reference clock. NTP is used to ensure that all the computers on a network are reporting the same time.

Open Directory The Apple directory services architecture, which can access authoritative information about users and network resources from directory domains that use LDAP, Active Directory protocols, or BSD configuration files, and network services.

Open Directory master A server that provides LDAP directory service, Kerberos authentication service, and Open Directory Password Server.

owner The owner of an item can change access permissions to the item. The owner may also change the group entry to any group the owner is a member of. By default, the owner has Read & Write permissions.

parent A computer whose shared directory domain provides configuration information to another computer.

password An alphanumeric string used to authenticate the identity of a user or to authorize access to files or services.

PDC Primary domain controller. In Windows networking, a domain controller that has been designated as the primary authentication server for its domain.

physical disk An actual, mechanical disk. Compare with logical disk.

Glossary 263

POP Post Office Protocol. A protocol for retrieving incoming mail. After a user retrieves POP mail, its stored on the users computer and is usually deleted automatically from the mail server.

portable home directory A portable home directory provides a user with both a local and network home folder. The contents of these two home folders, as well as the user's directory and authentication information, can be automatically kept in sync.

POSIX Portable Operating System Interface for UNIX. A family of open system standards based on UNIX, which allows applications to be written to a single target environment in which they can run unchanged on a variety of systems.

predefined accounts User accounts that are created automatically when you install Mac OS X. Some group accounts are also predefined.

preference manifest A file that describes the structure of and default values for an applications preferences (for example, what the various preference keys do). Workgroup Managers preferences editor uses these files to make it easier for an administrator to edit an applications managed preferences.

preferences cache A storage place for computer preferences and preferences for groups associated with that computer. Cached preferences help you manage local user accounts on portable computers.

presets Default attributes you specify for accounts you create using Workgroup Manager. You can use presets only during account creation.

primary domain controller See PDC.

primary group A users default group. The file system uses the ID of the primary group when a user accesses a file he or she doesnt own.

primary group ID A unique number that identifies a primary group.

print queue An orderly waiting area where print jobs wait until a printer is available. The print service in Mac OS X Server uses print queues on the server to facilitate management.

privileges The right to access restricted areas of a system or perform certain tasks (such as management tasks) in the system.

proxy server A server that sits between a client application, such as a web browser, and a real server. The proxy server intercepts all requests to the real server to see if it can fulfill the requests itself. If not, it forwards the request to the real server.

264 Glossary

scope A group of services. A scope can be a logical grouping of computers, such as all computers used by the production department, or a physical grouping, such as all computers located on the first floor. You can define a scope as part or all of your network.

search path See search policy.

search policy A list of directory domains searched by a Mac OS X computer when it needs configuration information; also, the order in which domains are searched. Sometimes called a search path.

security identifier See SID.

share point A folder, hard disk (or hard disk partition), or optical disc thats accessible over the network. A share point is the point of access at the top level of a group of shared items. Share points can be shared using AFP, SMB, NFS (an export), or FTP.

short name An abbreviated name for a user. The short name is used by Mac OS X for home folders, authentication, and email addresses.

SID Security identifier. A unique value that identifies a user, group, or computer account in a Windows NT-compatible domain.

Simple Finder A user environment featuring panels and large icons that provide novice users with an easy-to-navigate interface. Mounted volumes or media to which users are allowed access appear in panels instead of on the standard desktop.

SLP DA Service Location Protocol Directory Agent. A protocol that registers services available on a network and gives users easy access to them. When a service is added to the network, the service uses SLP to register itself on the network. SLP DA uses a centralized repository for registered network services.

SMB Server Message Block. A protocol that allows client computers to access files and network services. It can be used over TCP/IP, the Internet, and other network protocols. SMB services use SMB to provide access to servers, printers, and other network resources.

SSL Secure Sockets Layer. An Internet protocol that allows you to send encrypted, authenticated information across the Internet. More recent versions of SSL are known as TLS (Transport Level Security).

subnet A grouping on the same network of client computers that are organized by location (for example, different floors of a building) or by usage (for example, all eighth- grade students). The use of subnets simplifies administration. See also IP subnet.

Glossary 265

TCP Transmission Control Protocol. A method used with the Internet Protocol (IP) to send data in the form of message units between computers over the Internet. IP handles the actual delivery of the data, and TCP keeps track of the units of data (called packets) into which a message is divided for efficient routing through the Internet.

UID User ID. A number that uniquely identifies a user within a file system. Mac OS X computers use the UID to keep track of a users folder and file ownership.

URL Uniform Resource Locator. The address of a computer, file, or resource that can be accessed on a local network or the Internet. The URL is made up of the name of the protocol needed to access the resource, a domain name that identifies a specific computer on the Internet, and a hierarchical description of a file location on the computer.

user name The long name for a user, sometimes referred to as the users real name. See also short name.

user profile The set of personal desktop and preference settings that Windows saves for a user and applies each time the user logs in.

virtual user An alternate email address (short name) for a user. Similar to an alias, but it involves creating another user account.

VPN Virtual Private Network. A network that uses encryption and other technologies to provide secure communications over a public network, typically the Internet. VPNs are generally cheaper than real private networks using private lines, but they rely on having the same encryption system at both ends. The encryption may be performed by firewall software or by routers.

weblog See blog.

wiki A website that allows users to collaboratively edit pages and easily access previous pages using a web browser.

workgroup A set of users for whom you define preferences and privileges as a group. Any preferences you define for a group are stored in the group account.

XML An extensible markup language, similar to HTML but more formal and more flexible.

266 Glossary

267

In de

xIndex

A access

ACLs 27, 29 Apple menu 172, 187 application 149, 153, 164, 165, 168, 177 control process 27, 32 disk 183, 185, 201 file 28, 247 folder 28, 38, 153, 186, 245 group 28, 103, 153, 199 guest 117 login 192, 194, 199 media 149, 186, 200, 201, 202 mobile account 134, 135, 136 preferences 149 printing 81, 82, 83, 84, 220, 221, 222, 223 server 183, 185 share point 117, 199 user 23, 24, 70 website 98, 217, 218 Windows users 29 workgroup 193, 247 Workgroup Manager 23 See also LDAP; permissions; Universal Access

access control entries. See ACEs access control lists. See ACLs accessibility preferences. See Universal Access accounts

administrator 22, 23, 42, 56, 132, 142 backing up 252 creating 57 directory domains 46, 48 editing 51, 242 lists of 46, 48, 49 overview 22 predefined 56, 90, 251 preferences 139 types 56 See also computer accounts; group accounts; importing; mobile accounts; user accounts

ACEs (access control entries) 27, 29 ACLs (access control lists) 27, 29

Active Directory 29, 35, 37, 57, 132 addresses. See IP addresses admin group 23 administrator

accounts for 22, 23, 42, 56, 132, 142 directory services 23 domain 38, 72 groups for 90, 91 mobile accounts 132 passwords for 39 privileges of 23, 38, 68, 70, 243 server 68 setup 38, 41, 42 system 56

administrator computer 32, 41, 98 adult websites, access control 217 AFP (Apple Filing Protocol) service 114, 117, 123 AirPort 216 Always setting for preferences 159 anonymous users. See guest accounts Apple Filing Protocol service. See AFP Apple menu, Classic 172, 187 Apple Remote Desktop 239, 241 AppleShare IP migration utility 256 applications

access control 149, 153, 164, 165, 177 legacy access 168 preference editor 231, 232, 234, 235 See also specific applications

archiving, Open Directory master 253 ARD. See Apple Remote Desktop assistive devices 227, 228, 229, 231 attributes, types of 251 authentication

directory domains 32, 43 imported accounts 252, 253 Kerberos 245 mobile accounts 131 overview 26, 55 troubleshooting 242, 243, 245 See also login; passwords

automountable share points 117, 118, 123, 125

268 Index

B background synchronization 139, 212 backup

account 252 Time Machine 150, 157, 225 vs. synchronization 139

backup domain controller. See BDC batch editing 51 batteries 177, 180 BDC (backup domain controller) 55, 57, 114, 245 Bluetooth 216 boot process. See startup browsers, Safari 237 bundle IDs 164 Burn Disc command 186

C calendar service. See iCal service CDs, preferences 200 child groups 25, 159 Classic preferences

Apple menu access 172, 187 overview 149 restart options 172 sleep settings 173 startup options 170 System Folder 169, 171 user preferences location 174

client computers 21, 33 clients

customizing for 149, 150, 151, 152 management overview 147 mobile 144 network-visible resources 148 preferences overview 149 workflow improvement 152 See also group accounts; users

combined managed preferences 157, 159 command-line tools

domain name lookup 241 exporting 254 folders 103, 123 importing 251 overview 22 sharing 118 ssh access 103, 239 user accounts 42, 58, 59

comments on user accounts 76 computer accounts

creating 106 guest 26, 107 mobile 141 overview 13, 25, 105 preferences 157, 162 Windows computers 107

Workgroup Manager layout 149 computer groups

adding to 111 creating 108, 109 deleting 112 editing 51 mobile 142 overview 13, 26, 108 preferences 157, 158, 163 presets 50, 109, 110 removing computers 111 upgrading from lists 112 vs. computer lists 108 Workgroup Manager layout 149

computer lists 108, 112 computer name 105, 192 computers

administrator 32, 41, 98 client 21, 33 guest 26, 107 hierarchical groups 109 view settings 188 See also portable computers

configuration administrator 38, 41, 42 domains 31, 43 earlier Mac OS X versions 42 home folders 36, 37, 79 login options 191 overview 31 portable computers 140 Server Admin 20 Server Preferences 21 share points 116 users 31

controllers BDC 55, 57, 114, 245 PDC 55, 57, 114, 245

core services bundle 236 CreateGroupFolder tool 103 createhomedir tool 123 crypt passwords 74, 244 curfews on computer use 220

D Dashboard 165, 167 Default View settings 188 desktop view 187 Details pane 149 DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) service 195, 240, 241 Dictionary, hiding profanity in 217 digital signatures 164, 165 dig tool 241

Index 269

directories. See directory services; domains, directory; folders directory domain administrator 38, 72 directory services

Active Directory 29, 35, 37, 57, 132 administrators for 23 preferences 160 requirements 35 See also domains, directory; Open Directory

Directory Utility 195 disk images 21, 22, 148, 201 disks

access control 183, 185, 201 ejecting 185 quotas 36, 80, 128, 129, 130, 205 storage requirements 35 target disk mode 134

display settings 227 DNS (Domain Name System) service 45, 240, 241 Dock 149, 174, 175, 176, 249 documentation 18 Domain Name System. See DNS domains, directory

Active Directory 29, 35, 37, 57, 132 administration of 23, 38, 41, 72 connections 43 control over 70 group accounts 90 guest computers 107 home folder storage 115 local 35, 46, 57, 122 login 245 mobile accounts 132 proxy server settings 213, 214 purpose of 26 read-only 59 search policies 47 security 32, 43 setup 31, 43 shared 31, 245 user accounts in 46, 47, 48, 57, 58 See also LDAP; Open Directory

drives. See disks drop boxes 129 dscl tool 42, 58, 59 dsexport tool 254 dsimport tool 251 duplication of settings. See presets DVDs, preferences 200 Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol. See DHCP

E Energy Saver

desktop settings 177 management limitations 157

overview 149 portable settings 177, 179, 180 scheduling computer activity 181 sleep/wake settings 177

error messages 250 See also troubleshooting

Everyone user category 28, 59 exporting

accounts 53, 254 groups 254 overview 251 passwords 252 users 254 XML files 255, 256 See also importing

eXtensible Markup Language. See XML external accounts 134, 144, 192, 208

F fast user switching 191 file name extensions, visibility of 184 files

accessing 28, 247 caching of 132, 136 exporting XML 255, 256 extensions for 184 importing XML 255, 256 inheritance of permissions 93

file services AFP 114, 117, 123 FTP 215 NFS 78, 114, 118, 123 See also share points

file sharing, portable computers 142 File Transfer Protocol. See FTP FileVault 144, 205 Finder

desktop view 187 disc burning access 186 disk access 183, 185 ejecting disks 185 file name extensions 184 folder access 186 overview 149, 182 remote server access 185 restart control 187 server access 183 shutdown control 187 Simple Finder 182 Trash alert message 184 window behavior 183, 188

finding users and groups 45, 49, 75 folders

accessing 28, 38, 153, 186, 245 client setup 114, 148

270 Index

command-line tools 103, 123 My Applications 177 synchronization of 210, 212 System 169, 171 See also group folders; home folders

Front Row 165, 168 FTP (File Transfer Protocol) service 215 full name. See long name

G GID (group ID) 27, 96 globally unique identifier. See GUID group accounts

creating 91, 93 deleting 95 editing 51, 92 exporting 254 finding 90 group ID 27, 96 importing 253 login picture 97 member settings 89, 99 naming 66, 95 Open Directory 90 overview 25, 89 predefined 90, 251 presets 50, 92 read-only 94 search policies 98 web services 98 Windows 90, 99 See also groups

group folders access control 153 definition 25, 148 preferences 175 server requirements 36 settings 100, 101, 103 share points 101, 199 Windows users 101

group ID. See GID groups

access control 28, 103, 153, 199 adding users 78, 99 admin group 23 administrator 90, 91 finding 50 folder settings 100, 101, 103 hierarchical 25, 93, 94, 99, 109, 159 legacy 94 membership 77, 78, 79 naming 95 permissions 77, 91 preferences 157, 162 primary 28, 77, 89

removing users 79, 100 sorting 50 See also computer groups

Groups folder 101 guest accounts

AFP access 117 creating 59 definition 24 login options 192 mobile 141 permissions 59 share point access 117

guest computers 26, 107 GUID (globally unique identifier) 27, 28, 87, 252

H helper applications 168 hierarchical groups

computers 109 preferences management 159 users 25, 93, 94, 99

home folders creating 122 customizing 124 default 130 deleting 130 disk quotas for 129, 130 distributing across servers 115 Dock preferences 177 hosting for clients 114 local user 36, 122 login controls 198 management of 121 mobile accounts 37, 121, 132, 133, 134, 135, 138, 152, 202, 204, 205, 207 moving 130 naming 64, 114, 128 network 36, 114, 123, 148, 198 no home folder status 121 overview 113 portable home directories 37, 132 securing 38, 144, 205 server requirements 36 setup 36, 37, 79 share points 32, 79, 115, 116, 117, 118, 120, 123, 125 synchronization 152 troubleshooting 245, 246 users 36, 37, 87, 152 Windows users 87, 114, 120, 127, 130

hosts. See servers hybrid computer group 108

I iCal service 72

Index 271

iDisk 185 images, disk. See disk images; NetBoot; NetInstall importing

accounts 53, 68 authentication 252, 253 command-line tools 251 groups 253 GUID maintenance 252 overview 251 passwords 68, 252 users 253 XML files 255, 256 See also exporting

Info settings 84 inheritance, file permission 93 inherited preferences 158 install images. See NetInstall Internet sharing 215 IP addresses 241

K Kerberos 245 keyboard preferences 229 keywords 75

L LDAP (Lightweight Directory Access Protocol) service

creating accounts 55, 57 domain privileges 70, 72 identifying directories 35 password types 74 troubleshooting 242

Legacy preferences 165, 168 limited administrator privileges 38, 70 local directory domain 35, 46, 57, 122 local home folder 36, 122 local mobile accounts 136, 142 login

access control 192, 194, 199 automatic 191 configuration 191 directory domain 245 frequently used items 197 group share point access 199 home folders 198 management limitations 157 mobile accounts 133, 134, 135, 140, 198, 202 passwords 27, 74 picture for user 69, 97 preferences overview 149, 150, 189 process of 26 scripts 194, 196 troubleshooting 242, 243, 248 window appearance 189

workgroup access 193 Workgroup Manager 43

long name 63, 95 See also short name; user names

M Mac OS 9 169, 171, 172, 187

See also Classic preferences Mac OS X Server

hierarchical groups 93, 94 importing from earlier versions 255 working with earlier versions 42, 89

mail service 60, 80, 81 managed computer 157 managed preferences

Applications 149 caching 160 combined 157, 159 Dashboard 165, 167 desktop 187 disabling 164 Dock 149, 174, 175, 176 editing 51, 231, 232, 234, 235, 237 Front Row 165, 168 group folders 175 hierarchy 159 introduction 149 Legacy 165, 168 Media Access 149, 200, 201, 202 Network 150, 213, 214, 215, 217 overriding 157 overview 155 Parental Controls 150, 217, 218 permanence settings 159 Software Update 150, 224 System Preferences 150, 182, 225, 227 Time Machine 150, 157, 225 See also Classic preferences; Energy Saver; Finder; print service; Universal Access

managed user 157 manifests, preference 232, 236 master password 205 media, streaming. See streaming media media access control. See Ethernet ID Media Access preferences 149, 200, 201, 202 mixed-state preference settings 51 mobile accounts

accessing 134, 135, 136 administrator 132 advantages 136 creating 202 deployment 136 directory domains 132 disadvantages 138 disk quotas 129

272 Index

expiration periods 209 external accounts 134, 208 home folders 37, 121, 132, 133, 134, 135, 138, 152, 202, 204, 205, 207 local 136, 142 login 133, 134, 135, 140, 198, 202 overview 13, 131 portable home directories 37, 132 preferences overview 149, 152, 202 removing 204 security 131, 144, 205 setup 140 synchronization 131, 132, 136, 138, 139, 210, 212 wireless considerations 143 See also portable computers

mouse preferences 230 multiple-account editing 51 My Applications folder 177 MySQL Server account 56

N name server 45, 240, 241 naming conventions

computer name 105, 192 group accounts 66, 95 guest computers 107 home folders 64, 114, 128 presets 62 user names 63, 64, 65, 66, 67, 254

NetBios name 105 NetBoot service 21, 148 NetInstall 21, 148 Network File System. See NFS network home folders 36, 114, 123, 148, 177, 198 networks

preferences 150, 213, 214, 215, 217 time and time zones 239 views troubleshooting 250 wired vs. wireless mobile 143

network services DHCP 195, 240, 241 DNS 45, 240 IP addresses 241 VPN 139

network users 31, 136 Never setting for preferences 160 NFS (Network File System) 78, 114, 118, 123 nodes, directory. See domains, directory

O Often setting for preferences 160 Once setting for preferences 160, 164 Open Directory

creating accounts 57 group accounts 90

modifying accounts 58 passwords 74, 244 requirements 35 troubleshooting 242, 243, 244 See also Active Directory; domains, directory

Open Directory master 253 Open Directory Password Server 244 opportunistic locking (oplocks) 121 Overview pane 149 Owner user category 28

P PackageMaker 22 Parental Controls 150, 217, 218 parent groups 25, 93, 159 passive FTP mode 215 passwords

administrator 39 assigning 68 crypt 74, 244 FileVault 205 hints 191 imported accounts 68, 252 login process 27, 74 Open Directory 74, 244 shadow 74 troubleshooting 242, 243, 244, 245 types 74

Password Server. See Open Directory Password Server PDC (primary domain controller) 55, 57, 114, 245 permissions

access 28, 29 administrator 23, 38, 68, 70, 243 files 93 group 77, 91 guest 59 inheritance 93 mobile accounts 207 root 39 simultaneous login 73 sshd privilege separation 56 troubleshooting 243 user 70

picture, user login 69, 97 pointer preferences 230 portable computers

directory synchronization 37 Energy Saver settings 177, 179, 180 FileVault 144, 205 guest 141 multiple local accounts 142 setup 140 See also mobile accounts

portable home directories 37, 132

Index 273

ports, proxy server 213, 214 POSIX (Portable Operating System Interface) 28, 29 power settings. See Energy Saver predefined accounts 56, 90, 251 preferences

account 139 appearance 227 assistive devices 227, 228, 229, 231 browser 237 CDs 200 computer accounts 157, 162 computer groups 157, 158, 163 directory services 160 DVDs 200 group 157, 159, 162, 175 inherited 158 keyboard 229 mail 80 manifests 232, 236 mixed-state 51 mouse 230 overview 149, 152 server 21 streaming media 149 user 149, 157, 161, 174 web 237 Workgroup Manager 45, 155, 160 workgroups 151, 158, 194 See also managed preferences

presets computer groups 50, 109, 110 group accounts 50, 92 user accounts 50, 61, 62

primary domain controller. See PDC primary group, user's 28, 77, 89 print service

access control 81, 82, 83, 84, 220, 221, 222, 223 default printer setting 222, 223 footers on printouts 223 overview 150, 220 printer problems 248

privileges, administrator 23, 38, 68, 70, 243 See also permissions

problems. See troubleshooting profanity, hiding 217 protocols

AFP 114, 117, 123 DHCP 195, 240, 241 FTP 215 SMB 29, 114, 119, 127 See also LDAP

proxy server settings 213, 214

Q quotas, disk space 36, 80, 128, 129, 130, 205

R read-only accounts 59, 94 real name. See long name remote servers 185, 239, 241 removable media, accessing 186, 200, 202 restart, controlling 172, 187 roaming user profiles 85, 114, 128, 130 root permissions 39

S Safari 237 screen display settings 227 searching users and groups 45, 49, 75 search policies 26, 47, 98 security

ACLs 27, 29 directory domains 32, 43 home folders 38, 144, 205 mobile clients 131, 144, 205 SID 29 See also access; authentication; passwords; permissions

security identifier. See SID Seeing settings 227 Server Admin 20 server administrator 23 Server Assistant 39 Server Message Block. See SMB Server Preferences 21 servers

accessing 183, 185 connections 185 group requirements 36 home folders 36, 115 proxy 213, 214 remote 185, 239, 241 requirements 35

setup procedures. See configuration shadow passwords 74 shared directory domain 31, 245

See also LDAP shared files. See file sharing share points

automountable 117, 118, 123, 125 group folders 101, 199 guest access 117 home folders 32, 79, 115, 116, 117, 118, 120, 123, 125 local users 122 mounting 117, 118 setup 116 Windows users 120

sharing tool 118 shortcuts, command 230 short name 64, 65, 66, 96, 254

274 Index

shutdown, controlling 181, 187 SID (Security Identifier) 29 Simple Finder 182 simultaneous login privileges 73 single sign-on authentication 245 sleep settings 173, 177, 181 Slow Keys 229 SMB (Server Message Block) protocol service 29, 114, 119, 127 Software Update 150, 224 sshd privilege separation 56 ssh tool 103, 239 startup 21, 148, 170, 181 Sticky Keys 229 streaming media 149 synchronization

directories 37 home folders 152 mobile account data 131, 132, 136, 138, 139, 210, 212

System Administrator account 56 System Folder, Classic 169, 171 System Image Utility 21, 22 System Preferences 150, 182, 225, 227 System Services account 56

T target disk mode 134 temporary files, caching of 132, 136 time and time zone settings 239 time limits on computer use 220 Time Machine 150, 157, 225 Trash alert message 184 troubleshooting

administrator privileges 243 authentication 245 BDC 245 DHCP service 241 DNS service 240 Dock items 249 editing accounts 242 error messages 250 file access 247 home folder access 245, 246 LDAP directory 242 login 242, 243, 248 network views 250 Open Directory 242, 243, 244 passwords 242, 243, 244, 245 PDC 245 printers 248 time and time zones 239 Windows user problems 245, 246 workgroup access 247

trust services 195

U UIDs (user IDs) 28, 56, 67, 87, 164 Universal Access

assistive devices 231 display settings 227 keyboard options 229 mouse options 230 overview 150, 227 shortcuts 230 visual alert 228

UNIX 114, 168 Unknown User account 56 Unprivileged User account 56 updating software 150, 224 upgrading, computer lists to computer groups 112 user accounts

advanced settings 72 basic settings 63 calendar settings 72 command-line tools 42, 58, 59 comments 76 creating 57 deleting 60 directory domains 46, 47, 48, 57, 58 disabling 60 editing 51, 58, 59 exporting 254 importing 53, 68, 253 keywords 75 lists 46, 48, 49 local 122 mail settings 80 organization of 26, 55 overview 22, 24 passwords 68 predefined 56, 251 preferences 139 presets 50, 61, 62 read-only 59 troubleshooting 242 types 56 user names 63, 64, 65, 66, 67, 242 Windows 55, 60 See also administrator; group accounts; guest accounts; users

user ID. See UID user names 63, 64, 65, 66, 67, 242, 254 users

access control 23, 24, 70 categories 28, 59 customizing for 149 finding 45, 49, 75 identities 28, 56, 67, 87, 164 limited admin control 38, 70 login design 150

Index 275

mail service 80, 81 network 31, 136 overview 55 permissions 70 planning for 34, 35 preferences control 149, 157, 161, 174 primary group for 28, 77, 89 print service 81, 82, 83, 84, 220, 221, 222, 223 remote 185, 239, 241 searching for 45, 49, 75 setup 31 sorting 75 tools overview 19 workgroup choice 151 See also clients; groups; home folders; managed preferences; user accounts; Windows users

V view settings 187, 227, 250 visual preferences 228 VPN (Virtual Private Network) 139

W wake settings 179, 180 web services

accessing 98, 217, 218 account 56 browser 237

websites, accessing 98, 217, 218 widgets in Dashboard 165, 167 window behavior 183, 188 Windows users

access control 29 accounts 55, 60 computer accounts 107 creating accounts 57 disk quotas 130 group accounts 90, 99 group folders 101

home folders 87, 114, 120, 127, 130 login 86 modifying accounts 60 profile location 85 roaming profiles 85, 114, 128, 130 share points 120 troubleshooting 245, 246

wireless mobile lab 143 Workgroup Manager

access control 23 account lists 46, 48, 49 administrator setup 41, 42 batch editing 51 directory domains 43 earlier Mac OS X versions 42 exporting accounts 53, 254 importing accounts 53, 253 login 43 overview 13, 19 panes 149 preferences 45, 155, 160 presets 50 searching users 49 synchronization 139 tasks overview 44 troubleshooting 247 See also managed preferences

workgroups access control 193, 247 definition 25, 89, 157 group folders 100 multiple 152 preferences 151, 158, 194 troubleshooting 247 See also Workgroup Manager

<

Manualsnet FAQs

If you want to find out how the Mac OS X Server Apple works, you can view and download the Apple Mac OS X Server v30 User's Guide on the Manualsnet website.

Yes, we have the User's Guide for Apple Mac OS X Server as well as other Apple manuals. All you need to do is to use our search bar and find the user manual that you are looking for.

The User's Guide should include all the details that are needed to use a Apple Mac OS X Server. Full manuals and user guide PDFs can be downloaded from Manualsnet.com.

The best way to navigate the Apple Mac OS X Server v30 User's Guide is by checking the Table of Contents at the top of the page where available. This allows you to navigate a manual by jumping to the section you are looking for.

This Apple Mac OS X Server v30 User's Guide consists of sections like Table of Contents, to name a few. For easier navigation, use the Table of Contents in the upper left corner.

You can download Apple Mac OS X Server v30 User's Guide free of charge simply by clicking the “download” button in the upper right corner of any manuals page. This feature allows you to download any manual in a couple of seconds and is generally in PDF format. You can also save a manual for later by adding it to your saved documents in the user profile.

To be able to print Apple Mac OS X Server v30 User's Guide, simply download the document to your computer. Once downloaded, open the PDF file and print the Apple Mac OS X Server v30 User's Guide as you would any other document. This can usually be achieved by clicking on “File” and then “Print” from the menu bar.